Home | History | Annotate | Line # | Download | only in bfd
elf.c revision 1.6
      1  1.1     skrll /* ELF executable support for BFD.
      2  1.1     skrll 
      3  1.6  christos    Copyright (C) 1993-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
      4  1.1     skrll 
      5  1.1     skrll    This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
      6  1.1     skrll 
      7  1.1     skrll    This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
      8  1.1     skrll    it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
      9  1.1     skrll    the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
     10  1.1     skrll    (at your option) any later version.
     11  1.1     skrll 
     12  1.1     skrll    This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
     13  1.1     skrll    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
     14  1.1     skrll    MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
     15  1.1     skrll    GNU General Public License for more details.
     16  1.1     skrll 
     17  1.1     skrll    You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
     18  1.1     skrll    along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
     19  1.1     skrll    Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
     20  1.1     skrll    MA 02110-1301, USA.  */
     21  1.1     skrll 
     22  1.1     skrll 
     23  1.1     skrll /*
     24  1.1     skrll SECTION
     25  1.1     skrll 	ELF backends
     26  1.1     skrll 
     27  1.1     skrll 	BFD support for ELF formats is being worked on.
     28  1.1     skrll 	Currently, the best supported back ends are for sparc and i386
     29  1.1     skrll 	(running svr4 or Solaris 2).
     30  1.1     skrll 
     31  1.1     skrll 	Documentation of the internals of the support code still needs
     32  1.1     skrll 	to be written.  The code is changing quickly enough that we
     33  1.1     skrll 	haven't bothered yet.  */
     34  1.1     skrll 
     35  1.1     skrll /* For sparc64-cross-sparc32.  */
     36  1.1     skrll #define _SYSCALL32
     37  1.1     skrll #include "sysdep.h"
     38  1.1     skrll #include "bfd.h"
     39  1.1     skrll #include "bfdlink.h"
     40  1.1     skrll #include "libbfd.h"
     41  1.1     skrll #define ARCH_SIZE 0
     42  1.1     skrll #include "elf-bfd.h"
     43  1.1     skrll #include "libiberty.h"
     44  1.1     skrll #include "safe-ctype.h"
     45  1.6  christos #include "elf-linux-psinfo.h"
     46  1.1     skrll 
     47  1.3  christos #ifdef CORE_HEADER
     48  1.3  christos #include CORE_HEADER
     49  1.3  christos #endif
     50  1.3  christos 
     51  1.1     skrll static int elf_sort_sections (const void *, const void *);
     52  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *);
     53  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean prep_headers (bfd *);
     54  1.6  christos static bfd_boolean swap_out_syms (bfd *, struct elf_strtab_hash **, int) ;
     55  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean elf_read_notes (bfd *, file_ptr, bfd_size_type) ;
     56  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size,
     57  1.1     skrll 				    file_ptr offset);
     58  1.1     skrll 
     59  1.1     skrll /* Swap version information in and out.  The version information is
     60  1.1     skrll    currently size independent.  If that ever changes, this code will
     61  1.1     skrll    need to move into elfcode.h.  */
     62  1.1     skrll 
     63  1.1     skrll /* Swap in a Verdef structure.  */
     64  1.1     skrll 
     65  1.1     skrll void
     66  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (bfd *abfd,
     67  1.1     skrll 			 const Elf_External_Verdef *src,
     68  1.1     skrll 			 Elf_Internal_Verdef *dst)
     69  1.1     skrll {
     70  1.1     skrll   dst->vd_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_version);
     71  1.1     skrll   dst->vd_flags   = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags);
     72  1.1     skrll   dst->vd_ndx     = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx);
     73  1.1     skrll   dst->vd_cnt     = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt);
     74  1.1     skrll   dst->vd_hash    = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash);
     75  1.1     skrll   dst->vd_aux     = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux);
     76  1.1     skrll   dst->vd_next    = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_next);
     77  1.1     skrll }
     78  1.1     skrll 
     79  1.1     skrll /* Swap out a Verdef structure.  */
     80  1.1     skrll 
     81  1.1     skrll void
     82  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_out (bfd *abfd,
     83  1.1     skrll 			  const Elf_Internal_Verdef *src,
     84  1.1     skrll 			  Elf_External_Verdef *dst)
     85  1.1     skrll {
     86  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_version, dst->vd_version);
     87  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags, dst->vd_flags);
     88  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx, dst->vd_ndx);
     89  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt, dst->vd_cnt);
     90  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash, dst->vd_hash);
     91  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux, dst->vd_aux);
     92  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_next, dst->vd_next);
     93  1.1     skrll }
     94  1.1     skrll 
     95  1.1     skrll /* Swap in a Verdaux structure.  */
     96  1.1     skrll 
     97  1.1     skrll void
     98  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (bfd *abfd,
     99  1.1     skrll 			  const Elf_External_Verdaux *src,
    100  1.1     skrll 			  Elf_Internal_Verdaux *dst)
    101  1.1     skrll {
    102  1.1     skrll   dst->vda_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_name);
    103  1.1     skrll   dst->vda_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_next);
    104  1.1     skrll }
    105  1.1     skrll 
    106  1.1     skrll /* Swap out a Verdaux structure.  */
    107  1.1     skrll 
    108  1.1     skrll void
    109  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_out (bfd *abfd,
    110  1.1     skrll 			   const Elf_Internal_Verdaux *src,
    111  1.1     skrll 			   Elf_External_Verdaux *dst)
    112  1.1     skrll {
    113  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_name, dst->vda_name);
    114  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_next, dst->vda_next);
    115  1.1     skrll }
    116  1.1     skrll 
    117  1.1     skrll /* Swap in a Verneed structure.  */
    118  1.1     skrll 
    119  1.1     skrll void
    120  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (bfd *abfd,
    121  1.1     skrll 			  const Elf_External_Verneed *src,
    122  1.1     skrll 			  Elf_Internal_Verneed *dst)
    123  1.1     skrll {
    124  1.1     skrll   dst->vn_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_version);
    125  1.1     skrll   dst->vn_cnt     = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt);
    126  1.1     skrll   dst->vn_file    = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_file);
    127  1.1     skrll   dst->vn_aux     = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux);
    128  1.1     skrll   dst->vn_next    = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_next);
    129  1.1     skrll }
    130  1.1     skrll 
    131  1.1     skrll /* Swap out a Verneed structure.  */
    132  1.1     skrll 
    133  1.1     skrll void
    134  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_out (bfd *abfd,
    135  1.1     skrll 			   const Elf_Internal_Verneed *src,
    136  1.1     skrll 			   Elf_External_Verneed *dst)
    137  1.1     skrll {
    138  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_version, dst->vn_version);
    139  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt, dst->vn_cnt);
    140  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_file, dst->vn_file);
    141  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux, dst->vn_aux);
    142  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_next, dst->vn_next);
    143  1.1     skrll }
    144  1.1     skrll 
    145  1.1     skrll /* Swap in a Vernaux structure.  */
    146  1.1     skrll 
    147  1.1     skrll void
    148  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (bfd *abfd,
    149  1.1     skrll 			  const Elf_External_Vernaux *src,
    150  1.1     skrll 			  Elf_Internal_Vernaux *dst)
    151  1.1     skrll {
    152  1.1     skrll   dst->vna_hash  = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash);
    153  1.1     skrll   dst->vna_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags);
    154  1.1     skrll   dst->vna_other = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_other);
    155  1.1     skrll   dst->vna_name  = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_name);
    156  1.1     skrll   dst->vna_next  = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_next);
    157  1.1     skrll }
    158  1.1     skrll 
    159  1.1     skrll /* Swap out a Vernaux structure.  */
    160  1.1     skrll 
    161  1.1     skrll void
    162  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_out (bfd *abfd,
    163  1.1     skrll 			   const Elf_Internal_Vernaux *src,
    164  1.1     skrll 			   Elf_External_Vernaux *dst)
    165  1.1     skrll {
    166  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash, dst->vna_hash);
    167  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags, dst->vna_flags);
    168  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_other, dst->vna_other);
    169  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_name, dst->vna_name);
    170  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_next, dst->vna_next);
    171  1.1     skrll }
    172  1.1     skrll 
    173  1.1     skrll /* Swap in a Versym structure.  */
    174  1.1     skrll 
    175  1.1     skrll void
    176  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_versym_in (bfd *abfd,
    177  1.1     skrll 			 const Elf_External_Versym *src,
    178  1.1     skrll 			 Elf_Internal_Versym *dst)
    179  1.1     skrll {
    180  1.1     skrll   dst->vs_vers = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers);
    181  1.1     skrll }
    182  1.1     skrll 
    183  1.1     skrll /* Swap out a Versym structure.  */
    184  1.1     skrll 
    185  1.1     skrll void
    186  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_versym_out (bfd *abfd,
    187  1.1     skrll 			  const Elf_Internal_Versym *src,
    188  1.1     skrll 			  Elf_External_Versym *dst)
    189  1.1     skrll {
    190  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers, dst->vs_vers);
    191  1.1     skrll }
    192  1.1     skrll 
    193  1.1     skrll /* Standard ELF hash function.  Do not change this function; you will
    194  1.1     skrll    cause invalid hash tables to be generated.  */
    195  1.1     skrll 
    196  1.1     skrll unsigned long
    197  1.1     skrll bfd_elf_hash (const char *namearg)
    198  1.1     skrll {
    199  1.1     skrll   const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
    200  1.1     skrll   unsigned long h = 0;
    201  1.1     skrll   unsigned long g;
    202  1.1     skrll   int ch;
    203  1.1     skrll 
    204  1.1     skrll   while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
    205  1.1     skrll     {
    206  1.1     skrll       h = (h << 4) + ch;
    207  1.1     skrll       if ((g = (h & 0xf0000000)) != 0)
    208  1.1     skrll 	{
    209  1.1     skrll 	  h ^= g >> 24;
    210  1.1     skrll 	  /* The ELF ABI says `h &= ~g', but this is equivalent in
    211  1.1     skrll 	     this case and on some machines one insn instead of two.  */
    212  1.1     skrll 	  h ^= g;
    213  1.1     skrll 	}
    214  1.1     skrll     }
    215  1.1     skrll   return h & 0xffffffff;
    216  1.1     skrll }
    217  1.1     skrll 
    218  1.1     skrll /* DT_GNU_HASH hash function.  Do not change this function; you will
    219  1.1     skrll    cause invalid hash tables to be generated.  */
    220  1.1     skrll 
    221  1.1     skrll unsigned long
    222  1.1     skrll bfd_elf_gnu_hash (const char *namearg)
    223  1.1     skrll {
    224  1.1     skrll   const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
    225  1.1     skrll   unsigned long h = 5381;
    226  1.1     skrll   unsigned char ch;
    227  1.1     skrll 
    228  1.1     skrll   while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
    229  1.1     skrll     h = (h << 5) + h + ch;
    230  1.1     skrll   return h & 0xffffffff;
    231  1.1     skrll }
    232  1.1     skrll 
    233  1.1     skrll /* Create a tdata field OBJECT_SIZE bytes in length, zeroed out and with
    234  1.1     skrll    the object_id field of an elf_obj_tdata field set to OBJECT_ID.  */
    235  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
    236  1.1     skrll bfd_elf_allocate_object (bfd *abfd,
    237  1.1     skrll 			 size_t object_size,
    238  1.3  christos 			 enum elf_target_id object_id)
    239  1.1     skrll {
    240  1.1     skrll   BFD_ASSERT (object_size >= sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata));
    241  1.1     skrll   abfd->tdata.any = bfd_zalloc (abfd, object_size);
    242  1.1     skrll   if (abfd->tdata.any == NULL)
    243  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
    244  1.1     skrll 
    245  1.1     skrll   elf_object_id (abfd) = object_id;
    246  1.6  christos   if (abfd->direction != read_direction)
    247  1.6  christos     {
    248  1.6  christos       struct output_elf_obj_tdata *o = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof *o);
    249  1.6  christos       if (o == NULL)
    250  1.6  christos 	return FALSE;
    251  1.6  christos       elf_tdata (abfd)->o = o;
    252  1.6  christos       elf_program_header_size (abfd) = (bfd_size_type) -1;
    253  1.6  christos     }
    254  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
    255  1.1     skrll }
    256  1.1     skrll 
    257  1.1     skrll 
    258  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
    259  1.3  christos bfd_elf_make_object (bfd *abfd)
    260  1.1     skrll {
    261  1.3  christos   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
    262  1.1     skrll   return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata),
    263  1.3  christos 				  bed->target_id);
    264  1.1     skrll }
    265  1.1     skrll 
    266  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
    267  1.1     skrll bfd_elf_mkcorefile (bfd *abfd)
    268  1.1     skrll {
    269  1.1     skrll   /* I think this can be done just like an object file.  */
    270  1.6  christos   if (!abfd->xvec->_bfd_set_format[(int) bfd_object] (abfd))
    271  1.6  christos     return FALSE;
    272  1.6  christos   elf_tdata (abfd)->core = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*elf_tdata (abfd)->core));
    273  1.6  christos   return elf_tdata (abfd)->core != NULL;
    274  1.1     skrll }
    275  1.1     skrll 
    276  1.3  christos static char *
    277  1.1     skrll bfd_elf_get_str_section (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
    278  1.1     skrll {
    279  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
    280  1.1     skrll   bfd_byte *shstrtab = NULL;
    281  1.1     skrll   file_ptr offset;
    282  1.1     skrll   bfd_size_type shstrtabsize;
    283  1.1     skrll 
    284  1.1     skrll   i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
    285  1.1     skrll   if (i_shdrp == 0
    286  1.1     skrll       || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd)
    287  1.1     skrll       || i_shdrp[shindex] == 0)
    288  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
    289  1.1     skrll 
    290  1.1     skrll   shstrtab = i_shdrp[shindex]->contents;
    291  1.1     skrll   if (shstrtab == NULL)
    292  1.1     skrll     {
    293  1.1     skrll       /* No cached one, attempt to read, and cache what we read.  */
    294  1.1     skrll       offset = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_offset;
    295  1.1     skrll       shstrtabsize = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size;
    296  1.1     skrll 
    297  1.1     skrll       /* Allocate and clear an extra byte at the end, to prevent crashes
    298  1.1     skrll 	 in case the string table is not terminated.  */
    299  1.1     skrll       if (shstrtabsize + 1 <= 1
    300  1.6  christos 	  || bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
    301  1.6  christos 	  || (shstrtab = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc (abfd, shstrtabsize + 1)) == NULL)
    302  1.1     skrll 	shstrtab = NULL;
    303  1.1     skrll       else if (bfd_bread (shstrtab, shstrtabsize, abfd) != shstrtabsize)
    304  1.1     skrll 	{
    305  1.1     skrll 	  if (bfd_get_error () != bfd_error_system_call)
    306  1.1     skrll 	    bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
    307  1.6  christos 	  bfd_release (abfd, shstrtab);
    308  1.1     skrll 	  shstrtab = NULL;
    309  1.1     skrll 	  /* Once we've failed to read it, make sure we don't keep
    310  1.1     skrll 	     trying.  Otherwise, we'll keep allocating space for
    311  1.1     skrll 	     the string table over and over.  */
    312  1.1     skrll 	  i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size = 0;
    313  1.1     skrll 	}
    314  1.1     skrll       else
    315  1.1     skrll 	shstrtab[shstrtabsize] = '\0';
    316  1.1     skrll       i_shdrp[shindex]->contents = shstrtab;
    317  1.1     skrll     }
    318  1.1     skrll   return (char *) shstrtab;
    319  1.1     skrll }
    320  1.1     skrll 
    321  1.1     skrll char *
    322  1.1     skrll bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (bfd *abfd,
    323  1.1     skrll 				 unsigned int shindex,
    324  1.1     skrll 				 unsigned int strindex)
    325  1.1     skrll {
    326  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
    327  1.1     skrll 
    328  1.1     skrll   if (strindex == 0)
    329  1.1     skrll     return "";
    330  1.1     skrll 
    331  1.1     skrll   if (elf_elfsections (abfd) == NULL || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
    332  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
    333  1.1     skrll 
    334  1.1     skrll   hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
    335  1.1     skrll 
    336  1.6  christos   if (hdr->contents == NULL)
    337  1.6  christos     {
    338  1.6  christos       if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB && hdr->sh_type < SHT_LOOS)
    339  1.6  christos 	{
    340  1.6  christos 	  /* PR 17512: file: f057ec89.  */
    341  1.6  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler (_("%B: attempt to load strings from a non-string section (number %d)"),
    342  1.6  christos 			      abfd, shindex);
    343  1.6  christos 	  return NULL;
    344  1.6  christos 	}
    345  1.6  christos 
    346  1.6  christos       if (bfd_elf_get_str_section (abfd, shindex) == NULL)
    347  1.6  christos 	return NULL;
    348  1.6  christos     }
    349  1.1     skrll 
    350  1.1     skrll   if (strindex >= hdr->sh_size)
    351  1.1     skrll     {
    352  1.1     skrll       unsigned int shstrndx = elf_elfheader(abfd)->e_shstrndx;
    353  1.1     skrll       (*_bfd_error_handler)
    354  1.1     skrll 	(_("%B: invalid string offset %u >= %lu for section `%s'"),
    355  1.1     skrll 	 abfd, strindex, (unsigned long) hdr->sh_size,
    356  1.1     skrll 	 (shindex == shstrndx && strindex == hdr->sh_name
    357  1.1     skrll 	  ? ".shstrtab"
    358  1.1     skrll 	  : bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shstrndx, hdr->sh_name)));
    359  1.3  christos       return NULL;
    360  1.1     skrll     }
    361  1.1     skrll 
    362  1.1     skrll   return ((char *) hdr->contents) + strindex;
    363  1.1     skrll }
    364  1.1     skrll 
    365  1.1     skrll /* Read and convert symbols to internal format.
    366  1.1     skrll    SYMCOUNT specifies the number of symbols to read, starting from
    367  1.1     skrll    symbol SYMOFFSET.  If any of INTSYM_BUF, EXTSYM_BUF or EXTSHNDX_BUF
    368  1.1     skrll    are non-NULL, they are used to store the internal symbols, external
    369  1.1     skrll    symbols, and symbol section index extensions, respectively.
    370  1.1     skrll    Returns a pointer to the internal symbol buffer (malloced if necessary)
    371  1.1     skrll    or NULL if there were no symbols or some kind of problem.  */
    372  1.1     skrll 
    373  1.1     skrll Elf_Internal_Sym *
    374  1.1     skrll bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (bfd *ibfd,
    375  1.1     skrll 		      Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
    376  1.1     skrll 		      size_t symcount,
    377  1.1     skrll 		      size_t symoffset,
    378  1.1     skrll 		      Elf_Internal_Sym *intsym_buf,
    379  1.1     skrll 		      void *extsym_buf,
    380  1.1     skrll 		      Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *extshndx_buf)
    381  1.1     skrll {
    382  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *shndx_hdr;
    383  1.1     skrll   void *alloc_ext;
    384  1.1     skrll   const bfd_byte *esym;
    385  1.1     skrll   Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *alloc_extshndx;
    386  1.1     skrll   Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *shndx;
    387  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Sym *alloc_intsym;
    388  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
    389  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Sym *isymend;
    390  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
    391  1.1     skrll   size_t extsym_size;
    392  1.1     skrll   bfd_size_type amt;
    393  1.1     skrll   file_ptr pos;
    394  1.1     skrll 
    395  1.1     skrll   if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
    396  1.1     skrll     abort ();
    397  1.1     skrll 
    398  1.1     skrll   if (symcount == 0)
    399  1.1     skrll     return intsym_buf;
    400  1.1     skrll 
    401  1.1     skrll   /* Normal syms might have section extension entries.  */
    402  1.1     skrll   shndx_hdr = NULL;
    403  1.6  christos   if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd) != NULL)
    404  1.6  christos     {
    405  1.6  christos       elf_section_list * entry;
    406  1.6  christos       Elf_Internal_Shdr **sections = elf_elfsections (ibfd);
    407  1.6  christos 
    408  1.6  christos       /* Find an index section that is linked to this symtab section.  */
    409  1.6  christos       for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
    410  1.6  christos 	if (sections[entry->hdr.sh_link] == symtab_hdr)
    411  1.6  christos 	  {
    412  1.6  christos 	    shndx_hdr = & entry->hdr;
    413  1.6  christos 	    break;
    414  1.6  christos 	  };
    415  1.6  christos 
    416  1.6  christos       if (shndx_hdr == NULL)
    417  1.6  christos 	{
    418  1.6  christos 	  if (symtab_hdr == & elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd))
    419  1.6  christos 	    /* Not really accurate, but this was how the old code used to work.  */
    420  1.6  christos 	    shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)->hdr;
    421  1.6  christos 	  /* Otherwise we do nothing.  The assumption is that
    422  1.6  christos 	     the index table will not be needed.  */
    423  1.6  christos 	}
    424  1.6  christos     }
    425  1.1     skrll 
    426  1.1     skrll   /* Read the symbols.  */
    427  1.1     skrll   alloc_ext = NULL;
    428  1.1     skrll   alloc_extshndx = NULL;
    429  1.1     skrll   alloc_intsym = NULL;
    430  1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
    431  1.1     skrll   extsym_size = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
    432  1.1     skrll   amt = symcount * extsym_size;
    433  1.1     skrll   pos = symtab_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * extsym_size;
    434  1.1     skrll   if (extsym_buf == NULL)
    435  1.1     skrll     {
    436  1.1     skrll       alloc_ext = bfd_malloc2 (symcount, extsym_size);
    437  1.1     skrll       extsym_buf = alloc_ext;
    438  1.1     skrll     }
    439  1.1     skrll   if (extsym_buf == NULL
    440  1.1     skrll       || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
    441  1.1     skrll       || bfd_bread (extsym_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
    442  1.1     skrll     {
    443  1.1     skrll       intsym_buf = NULL;
    444  1.1     skrll       goto out;
    445  1.1     skrll     }
    446  1.1     skrll 
    447  1.1     skrll   if (shndx_hdr == NULL || shndx_hdr->sh_size == 0)
    448  1.1     skrll     extshndx_buf = NULL;
    449  1.1     skrll   else
    450  1.1     skrll     {
    451  1.1     skrll       amt = symcount * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
    452  1.1     skrll       pos = shndx_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
    453  1.1     skrll       if (extshndx_buf == NULL)
    454  1.1     skrll 	{
    455  1.3  christos 	  alloc_extshndx = (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *)
    456  1.3  christos               bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
    457  1.1     skrll 	  extshndx_buf = alloc_extshndx;
    458  1.1     skrll 	}
    459  1.1     skrll       if (extshndx_buf == NULL
    460  1.1     skrll 	  || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
    461  1.1     skrll 	  || bfd_bread (extshndx_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
    462  1.1     skrll 	{
    463  1.1     skrll 	  intsym_buf = NULL;
    464  1.1     skrll 	  goto out;
    465  1.1     skrll 	}
    466  1.1     skrll     }
    467  1.1     skrll 
    468  1.1     skrll   if (intsym_buf == NULL)
    469  1.1     skrll     {
    470  1.3  christos       alloc_intsym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *)
    471  1.3  christos           bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Sym));
    472  1.1     skrll       intsym_buf = alloc_intsym;
    473  1.1     skrll       if (intsym_buf == NULL)
    474  1.1     skrll 	goto out;
    475  1.1     skrll     }
    476  1.1     skrll 
    477  1.1     skrll   /* Convert the symbols to internal form.  */
    478  1.1     skrll   isymend = intsym_buf + symcount;
    479  1.3  christos   for (esym = (const bfd_byte *) extsym_buf, isym = intsym_buf,
    480  1.3  christos            shndx = extshndx_buf;
    481  1.1     skrll        isym < isymend;
    482  1.1     skrll        esym += extsym_size, isym++, shndx = shndx != NULL ? shndx + 1 : NULL)
    483  1.1     skrll     if (!(*bed->s->swap_symbol_in) (ibfd, esym, shndx, isym))
    484  1.1     skrll       {
    485  1.1     skrll 	symoffset += (esym - (bfd_byte *) extsym_buf) / extsym_size;
    486  1.1     skrll 	(*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B symbol number %lu references "
    487  1.1     skrll 				 "nonexistent SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX section"),
    488  1.1     skrll 			       ibfd, (unsigned long) symoffset);
    489  1.1     skrll 	if (alloc_intsym != NULL)
    490  1.1     skrll 	  free (alloc_intsym);
    491  1.1     skrll 	intsym_buf = NULL;
    492  1.1     skrll 	goto out;
    493  1.1     skrll       }
    494  1.1     skrll 
    495  1.1     skrll  out:
    496  1.1     skrll   if (alloc_ext != NULL)
    497  1.1     skrll     free (alloc_ext);
    498  1.1     skrll   if (alloc_extshndx != NULL)
    499  1.1     skrll     free (alloc_extshndx);
    500  1.1     skrll 
    501  1.1     skrll   return intsym_buf;
    502  1.1     skrll }
    503  1.1     skrll 
    504  1.1     skrll /* Look up a symbol name.  */
    505  1.1     skrll const char *
    506  1.1     skrll bfd_elf_sym_name (bfd *abfd,
    507  1.1     skrll 		  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
    508  1.1     skrll 		  Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
    509  1.1     skrll 		  asection *sym_sec)
    510  1.1     skrll {
    511  1.1     skrll   const char *name;
    512  1.1     skrll   unsigned int iname = isym->st_name;
    513  1.1     skrll   unsigned int shindex = symtab_hdr->sh_link;
    514  1.1     skrll 
    515  1.1     skrll   if (iname == 0 && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
    516  1.1     skrll       /* Check for a bogus st_shndx to avoid crashing.  */
    517  1.1     skrll       && isym->st_shndx < elf_numsections (abfd))
    518  1.1     skrll     {
    519  1.1     skrll       iname = elf_elfsections (abfd)[isym->st_shndx]->sh_name;
    520  1.1     skrll       shindex = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx;
    521  1.1     skrll     }
    522  1.1     skrll 
    523  1.1     skrll   name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shindex, iname);
    524  1.1     skrll   if (name == NULL)
    525  1.1     skrll     name = "(null)";
    526  1.1     skrll   else if (sym_sec && *name == '\0')
    527  1.1     skrll     name = bfd_section_name (abfd, sym_sec);
    528  1.1     skrll 
    529  1.1     skrll   return name;
    530  1.1     skrll }
    531  1.1     skrll 
    532  1.1     skrll /* Elf_Internal_Shdr->contents is an array of these for SHT_GROUP
    533  1.1     skrll    sections.  The first element is the flags, the rest are section
    534  1.1     skrll    pointers.  */
    535  1.1     skrll 
    536  1.1     skrll typedef union elf_internal_group {
    537  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr;
    538  1.1     skrll   unsigned int flags;
    539  1.1     skrll } Elf_Internal_Group;
    540  1.1     skrll 
    541  1.1     skrll /* Return the name of the group signature symbol.  Why isn't the
    542  1.1     skrll    signature just a string?  */
    543  1.1     skrll 
    544  1.1     skrll static const char *
    545  1.1     skrll group_signature (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *ghdr)
    546  1.1     skrll {
    547  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
    548  1.1     skrll   unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
    549  1.1     skrll   Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
    550  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Sym isym;
    551  1.1     skrll 
    552  1.1     skrll   /* First we need to ensure the symbol table is available.  Make sure
    553  1.1     skrll      that it is a symbol table section.  */
    554  1.1     skrll   if (ghdr->sh_link >= elf_numsections (abfd))
    555  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
    556  1.1     skrll   hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd) [ghdr->sh_link];
    557  1.1     skrll   if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
    558  1.1     skrll       || ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, ghdr->sh_link))
    559  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
    560  1.1     skrll 
    561  1.1     skrll   /* Go read the symbol.  */
    562  1.1     skrll   hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
    563  1.1     skrll   if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, hdr, 1, ghdr->sh_info,
    564  1.1     skrll 			    &isym, esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
    565  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
    566  1.1     skrll 
    567  1.1     skrll   return bfd_elf_sym_name (abfd, hdr, &isym, NULL);
    568  1.1     skrll }
    569  1.1     skrll 
    570  1.1     skrll /* Set next_in_group list pointer, and group name for NEWSECT.  */
    571  1.1     skrll 
    572  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
    573  1.1     skrll setup_group (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *newsect)
    574  1.1     skrll {
    575  1.1     skrll   unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
    576  1.1     skrll 
    577  1.1     skrll   /* If num_group is zero, read in all SHT_GROUP sections.  The count
    578  1.1     skrll      is set to -1 if there are no SHT_GROUP sections.  */
    579  1.1     skrll   if (num_group == 0)
    580  1.1     skrll     {
    581  1.1     skrll       unsigned int i, shnum;
    582  1.1     skrll 
    583  1.1     skrll       /* First count the number of groups.  If we have a SHT_GROUP
    584  1.1     skrll 	 section with just a flag word (ie. sh_size is 4), ignore it.  */
    585  1.1     skrll       shnum = elf_numsections (abfd);
    586  1.1     skrll       num_group = 0;
    587  1.1     skrll 
    588  1.6  christos #define IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER(shdr, minsize)	\
    589  1.1     skrll 	(   (shdr)->sh_type == SHT_GROUP		\
    590  1.6  christos 	 && (shdr)->sh_size >= minsize			\
    591  1.1     skrll 	 && (shdr)->sh_entsize == GRP_ENTRY_SIZE	\
    592  1.1     skrll 	 && ((shdr)->sh_size % GRP_ENTRY_SIZE) == 0)
    593  1.1     skrll 
    594  1.1     skrll       for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
    595  1.1     skrll 	{
    596  1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
    597  1.1     skrll 
    598  1.6  christos 	  if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
    599  1.1     skrll 	    num_group += 1;
    600  1.1     skrll 	}
    601  1.1     skrll 
    602  1.1     skrll       if (num_group == 0)
    603  1.1     skrll 	{
    604  1.1     skrll 	  num_group = (unsigned) -1;
    605  1.1     skrll 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
    606  1.1     skrll 	}
    607  1.1     skrll       else
    608  1.1     skrll 	{
    609  1.1     skrll 	  /* We keep a list of elf section headers for group sections,
    610  1.1     skrll 	     so we can find them quickly.  */
    611  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_size_type amt;
    612  1.1     skrll 
    613  1.1     skrll 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
    614  1.3  christos 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **)
    615  1.3  christos               bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_group, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
    616  1.1     skrll 	  if (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr == NULL)
    617  1.1     skrll 	    return FALSE;
    618  1.1     skrll 
    619  1.1     skrll 	  num_group = 0;
    620  1.1     skrll 	  for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
    621  1.1     skrll 	    {
    622  1.1     skrll 	      Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
    623  1.1     skrll 
    624  1.6  christos 	      if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
    625  1.1     skrll 		{
    626  1.1     skrll 		  unsigned char *src;
    627  1.1     skrll 		  Elf_Internal_Group *dest;
    628  1.1     skrll 
    629  1.1     skrll 		  /* Add to list of sections.  */
    630  1.1     skrll 		  elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[num_group] = shdr;
    631  1.1     skrll 		  num_group += 1;
    632  1.1     skrll 
    633  1.1     skrll 		  /* Read the raw contents.  */
    634  1.1     skrll 		  BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (*dest) >= 4);
    635  1.1     skrll 		  amt = shdr->sh_size * sizeof (*dest) / 4;
    636  1.3  christos 		  shdr->contents = (unsigned char *)
    637  1.3  christos                       bfd_alloc2 (abfd, shdr->sh_size, sizeof (*dest) / 4);
    638  1.1     skrll 		  /* PR binutils/4110: Handle corrupt group headers.  */
    639  1.1     skrll 		  if (shdr->contents == NULL)
    640  1.1     skrll 		    {
    641  1.1     skrll 		      _bfd_error_handler
    642  1.6  christos 			(_("%B: corrupt size field in group section header: 0x%lx"), abfd, shdr->sh_size);
    643  1.1     skrll 		      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
    644  1.6  christos 		      -- num_group;
    645  1.6  christos 		      continue;
    646  1.1     skrll 		    }
    647  1.1     skrll 
    648  1.1     skrll 		  memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
    649  1.1     skrll 
    650  1.1     skrll 		  if (bfd_seek (abfd, shdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
    651  1.1     skrll 		      || (bfd_bread (shdr->contents, shdr->sh_size, abfd)
    652  1.1     skrll 			  != shdr->sh_size))
    653  1.6  christos 		    {
    654  1.6  christos 		      _bfd_error_handler
    655  1.6  christos 			(_("%B: invalid size field in group section header: 0x%lx"), abfd, shdr->sh_size);
    656  1.6  christos 		      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
    657  1.6  christos 		      -- num_group;
    658  1.6  christos 		      /* PR 17510: If the group contents are even partially
    659  1.6  christos 			 corrupt, do not allow any of the contents to be used.  */
    660  1.6  christos 		      memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
    661  1.6  christos 		      continue;
    662  1.6  christos 		    }
    663  1.1     skrll 
    664  1.1     skrll 		  /* Translate raw contents, a flag word followed by an
    665  1.1     skrll 		     array of elf section indices all in target byte order,
    666  1.1     skrll 		     to the flag word followed by an array of elf section
    667  1.1     skrll 		     pointers.  */
    668  1.1     skrll 		  src = shdr->contents + shdr->sh_size;
    669  1.1     skrll 		  dest = (Elf_Internal_Group *) (shdr->contents + amt);
    670  1.6  christos 
    671  1.1     skrll 		  while (1)
    672  1.1     skrll 		    {
    673  1.1     skrll 		      unsigned int idx;
    674  1.1     skrll 
    675  1.1     skrll 		      src -= 4;
    676  1.1     skrll 		      --dest;
    677  1.1     skrll 		      idx = H_GET_32 (abfd, src);
    678  1.1     skrll 		      if (src == shdr->contents)
    679  1.1     skrll 			{
    680  1.1     skrll 			  dest->flags = idx;
    681  1.1     skrll 			  if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL && (idx & GRP_COMDAT))
    682  1.1     skrll 			    shdr->bfd_section->flags
    683  1.1     skrll 			      |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
    684  1.1     skrll 			  break;
    685  1.1     skrll 			}
    686  1.1     skrll 		      if (idx >= shnum)
    687  1.1     skrll 			{
    688  1.1     skrll 			  ((*_bfd_error_handler)
    689  1.1     skrll 			   (_("%B: invalid SHT_GROUP entry"), abfd));
    690  1.1     skrll 			  idx = 0;
    691  1.1     skrll 			}
    692  1.1     skrll 		      dest->shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[idx];
    693  1.1     skrll 		    }
    694  1.1     skrll 		}
    695  1.1     skrll 	    }
    696  1.6  christos 
    697  1.6  christos 	  /* PR 17510: Corrupt binaries might contain invalid groups.  */
    698  1.6  christos 	  if (num_group != (unsigned) elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group)
    699  1.6  christos 	    {
    700  1.6  christos 	      elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
    701  1.6  christos 
    702  1.6  christos 	      /* If all groups are invalid then fail.  */
    703  1.6  christos 	      if (num_group == 0)
    704  1.6  christos 		{
    705  1.6  christos 		  elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
    706  1.6  christos 		  elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group = -1;
    707  1.6  christos 		  (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: no valid group sections found"), abfd);
    708  1.6  christos 		  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
    709  1.6  christos 		}
    710  1.6  christos 	    }
    711  1.1     skrll 	}
    712  1.1     skrll     }
    713  1.1     skrll 
    714  1.1     skrll   if (num_group != (unsigned) -1)
    715  1.1     skrll     {
    716  1.1     skrll       unsigned int i;
    717  1.1     skrll 
    718  1.1     skrll       for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
    719  1.1     skrll 	{
    720  1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
    721  1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Group *idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
    722  1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
    723  1.1     skrll 
    724  1.1     skrll 	  /* Look through this group's sections to see if current
    725  1.1     skrll 	     section is a member.  */
    726  1.1     skrll 	  while (--n_elt != 0)
    727  1.1     skrll 	    if ((++idx)->shdr == hdr)
    728  1.1     skrll 	      {
    729  1.1     skrll 		asection *s = NULL;
    730  1.1     skrll 
    731  1.1     skrll 		/* We are a member of this group.  Go looking through
    732  1.1     skrll 		   other members to see if any others are linked via
    733  1.1     skrll 		   next_in_group.  */
    734  1.1     skrll 		idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
    735  1.1     skrll 		n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
    736  1.1     skrll 		while (--n_elt != 0)
    737  1.1     skrll 		  if ((s = (++idx)->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
    738  1.1     skrll 		      && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
    739  1.1     skrll 		    break;
    740  1.1     skrll 		if (n_elt != 0)
    741  1.1     skrll 		  {
    742  1.1     skrll 		    /* Snarf the group name from other member, and
    743  1.1     skrll 		       insert current section in circular list.  */
    744  1.1     skrll 		    elf_group_name (newsect) = elf_group_name (s);
    745  1.1     skrll 		    elf_next_in_group (newsect) = elf_next_in_group (s);
    746  1.1     skrll 		    elf_next_in_group (s) = newsect;
    747  1.1     skrll 		  }
    748  1.1     skrll 		else
    749  1.1     skrll 		  {
    750  1.1     skrll 		    const char *gname;
    751  1.1     skrll 
    752  1.1     skrll 		    gname = group_signature (abfd, shdr);
    753  1.1     skrll 		    if (gname == NULL)
    754  1.1     skrll 		      return FALSE;
    755  1.1     skrll 		    elf_group_name (newsect) = gname;
    756  1.1     skrll 
    757  1.1     skrll 		    /* Start a circular list with one element.  */
    758  1.1     skrll 		    elf_next_in_group (newsect) = newsect;
    759  1.1     skrll 		  }
    760  1.1     skrll 
    761  1.1     skrll 		/* If the group section has been created, point to the
    762  1.1     skrll 		   new member.  */
    763  1.1     skrll 		if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL)
    764  1.1     skrll 		  elf_next_in_group (shdr->bfd_section) = newsect;
    765  1.1     skrll 
    766  1.1     skrll 		i = num_group - 1;
    767  1.1     skrll 		break;
    768  1.1     skrll 	      }
    769  1.1     skrll 	}
    770  1.1     skrll     }
    771  1.1     skrll 
    772  1.1     skrll   if (elf_group_name (newsect) == NULL)
    773  1.1     skrll     {
    774  1.1     skrll       (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: no group info for section %A"),
    775  1.1     skrll 			     abfd, newsect);
    776  1.6  christos       return FALSE;
    777  1.1     skrll     }
    778  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
    779  1.1     skrll }
    780  1.1     skrll 
    781  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
    782  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_setup_sections (bfd *abfd)
    783  1.1     skrll {
    784  1.1     skrll   unsigned int i;
    785  1.1     skrll   unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
    786  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean result = TRUE;
    787  1.1     skrll   asection *s;
    788  1.1     skrll 
    789  1.1     skrll   /* Process SHF_LINK_ORDER.  */
    790  1.1     skrll   for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
    791  1.1     skrll     {
    792  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr = &elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr;
    793  1.1     skrll       if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
    794  1.1     skrll 	{
    795  1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int elfsec = this_hdr->sh_link;
    796  1.1     skrll 	  /* FIXME: The old Intel compiler and old strip/objcopy may
    797  1.1     skrll 	     not set the sh_link or sh_info fields.  Hence we could
    798  1.1     skrll 	     get the situation where elfsec is 0.  */
    799  1.1     skrll 	  if (elfsec == 0)
    800  1.1     skrll 	    {
    801  1.1     skrll 	      const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
    802  1.1     skrll 	      if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
    803  1.1     skrll 		bed->link_order_error_handler
    804  1.1     skrll 		  (_("%B: warning: sh_link not set for section `%A'"),
    805  1.1     skrll 		   abfd, s);
    806  1.1     skrll 	    }
    807  1.1     skrll 	  else
    808  1.1     skrll 	    {
    809  1.3  christos 	      asection *linksec = NULL;
    810  1.1     skrll 
    811  1.1     skrll 	      if (elfsec < elf_numsections (abfd))
    812  1.1     skrll 		{
    813  1.1     skrll 		  this_hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec];
    814  1.3  christos 		  linksec = this_hdr->bfd_section;
    815  1.1     skrll 		}
    816  1.1     skrll 
    817  1.1     skrll 	      /* PR 1991, 2008:
    818  1.1     skrll 		 Some strip/objcopy may leave an incorrect value in
    819  1.1     skrll 		 sh_link.  We don't want to proceed.  */
    820  1.3  christos 	      if (linksec == NULL)
    821  1.1     skrll 		{
    822  1.1     skrll 		  (*_bfd_error_handler)
    823  1.1     skrll 		    (_("%B: sh_link [%d] in section `%A' is incorrect"),
    824  1.1     skrll 		     s->owner, s, elfsec);
    825  1.1     skrll 		  result = FALSE;
    826  1.1     skrll 		}
    827  1.1     skrll 
    828  1.3  christos 	      elf_linked_to_section (s) = linksec;
    829  1.1     skrll 	    }
    830  1.1     skrll 	}
    831  1.1     skrll     }
    832  1.1     skrll 
    833  1.1     skrll   /* Process section groups.  */
    834  1.1     skrll   if (num_group == (unsigned) -1)
    835  1.1     skrll     return result;
    836  1.1     skrll 
    837  1.1     skrll   for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
    838  1.1     skrll     {
    839  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
    840  1.6  christos       Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
    841  1.6  christos       unsigned int n_elt;
    842  1.6  christos 
    843  1.6  christos       /* PR binutils/18758: Beware of corrupt binaries with invalid group data.  */
    844  1.6  christos       if (shdr == NULL || shdr->bfd_section == NULL || shdr->contents == NULL)
    845  1.6  christos 	{
    846  1.6  christos 	  (*_bfd_error_handler)
    847  1.6  christos 	    (_("%B: section group entry number %u is corrupt"),
    848  1.6  christos 	     abfd, i);
    849  1.6  christos 	  result = FALSE;
    850  1.6  christos 	  continue;
    851  1.6  christos 	}
    852  1.6  christos 
    853  1.6  christos       idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
    854  1.6  christos       n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
    855  1.1     skrll 
    856  1.1     skrll       while (--n_elt != 0)
    857  1.1     skrll 	if ((++idx)->shdr->bfd_section)
    858  1.1     skrll 	  elf_sec_group (idx->shdr->bfd_section) = shdr->bfd_section;
    859  1.1     skrll 	else if (idx->shdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA
    860  1.1     skrll 		 || idx->shdr->sh_type == SHT_REL)
    861  1.1     skrll 	  /* We won't include relocation sections in section groups in
    862  1.1     skrll 	     output object files. We adjust the group section size here
    863  1.1     skrll 	     so that relocatable link will work correctly when
    864  1.1     skrll 	     relocation sections are in section group in input object
    865  1.1     skrll 	     files.  */
    866  1.1     skrll 	  shdr->bfd_section->size -= 4;
    867  1.1     skrll 	else
    868  1.1     skrll 	  {
    869  1.1     skrll 	    /* There are some unknown sections in the group.  */
    870  1.1     skrll 	    (*_bfd_error_handler)
    871  1.1     skrll 	      (_("%B: unknown [%d] section `%s' in group [%s]"),
    872  1.1     skrll 	       abfd,
    873  1.1     skrll 	       (unsigned int) idx->shdr->sh_type,
    874  1.1     skrll 	       bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd,
    875  1.1     skrll 						(elf_elfheader (abfd)
    876  1.1     skrll 						 ->e_shstrndx),
    877  1.1     skrll 						idx->shdr->sh_name),
    878  1.1     skrll 	       shdr->bfd_section->name);
    879  1.1     skrll 	    result = FALSE;
    880  1.1     skrll 	  }
    881  1.1     skrll     }
    882  1.1     skrll   return result;
    883  1.1     skrll }
    884  1.1     skrll 
    885  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
    886  1.1     skrll bfd_elf_is_group_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, const asection *sec)
    887  1.1     skrll {
    888  1.1     skrll   return elf_next_in_group (sec) != NULL;
    889  1.1     skrll }
    890  1.1     skrll 
    891  1.6  christos static char *
    892  1.6  christos convert_debug_to_zdebug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
    893  1.6  christos {
    894  1.6  christos   unsigned int len = strlen (name);
    895  1.6  christos   char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 2);
    896  1.6  christos   if (new_name == NULL)
    897  1.6  christos     return NULL;
    898  1.6  christos   new_name[0] = '.';
    899  1.6  christos   new_name[1] = 'z';
    900  1.6  christos   memcpy (new_name + 2, name + 1, len);
    901  1.6  christos   return new_name;
    902  1.6  christos }
    903  1.6  christos 
    904  1.6  christos static char *
    905  1.6  christos convert_zdebug_to_debug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
    906  1.6  christos {
    907  1.6  christos   unsigned int len = strlen (name);
    908  1.6  christos   char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
    909  1.6  christos   if (new_name == NULL)
    910  1.6  christos     return NULL;
    911  1.6  christos   new_name[0] = '.';
    912  1.6  christos   memcpy (new_name + 1, name + 2, len - 1);
    913  1.6  christos   return new_name;
    914  1.6  christos }
    915  1.6  christos 
    916  1.1     skrll /* Make a BFD section from an ELF section.  We store a pointer to the
    917  1.1     skrll    BFD section in the bfd_section field of the header.  */
    918  1.1     skrll 
    919  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
    920  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
    921  1.1     skrll 				 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
    922  1.1     skrll 				 const char *name,
    923  1.1     skrll 				 int shindex)
    924  1.1     skrll {
    925  1.1     skrll   asection *newsect;
    926  1.1     skrll   flagword flags;
    927  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
    928  1.1     skrll 
    929  1.1     skrll   if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
    930  1.3  christos     return TRUE;
    931  1.1     skrll 
    932  1.1     skrll   newsect = bfd_make_section_anyway (abfd, name);
    933  1.1     skrll   if (newsect == NULL)
    934  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
    935  1.1     skrll 
    936  1.1     skrll   hdr->bfd_section = newsect;
    937  1.1     skrll   elf_section_data (newsect)->this_hdr = *hdr;
    938  1.1     skrll   elf_section_data (newsect)->this_idx = shindex;
    939  1.1     skrll 
    940  1.1     skrll   /* Always use the real type/flags.  */
    941  1.1     skrll   elf_section_type (newsect) = hdr->sh_type;
    942  1.1     skrll   elf_section_flags (newsect) = hdr->sh_flags;
    943  1.1     skrll 
    944  1.1     skrll   newsect->filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
    945  1.1     skrll 
    946  1.1     skrll   if (! bfd_set_section_vma (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_addr)
    947  1.1     skrll       || ! bfd_set_section_size (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_size)
    948  1.1     skrll       || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, newsect,
    949  1.1     skrll 				      bfd_log2 (hdr->sh_addralign)))
    950  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
    951  1.1     skrll 
    952  1.1     skrll   flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
    953  1.1     skrll   if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
    954  1.1     skrll     flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
    955  1.1     skrll   if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
    956  1.1     skrll     flags |= SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE;
    957  1.1     skrll   if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
    958  1.1     skrll     {
    959  1.1     skrll       flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
    960  1.1     skrll       if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
    961  1.1     skrll 	flags |= SEC_LOAD;
    962  1.1     skrll     }
    963  1.1     skrll   if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) == 0)
    964  1.1     skrll     flags |= SEC_READONLY;
    965  1.1     skrll   if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
    966  1.1     skrll     flags |= SEC_CODE;
    967  1.1     skrll   else if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
    968  1.1     skrll     flags |= SEC_DATA;
    969  1.1     skrll   if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_MERGE) != 0)
    970  1.1     skrll     {
    971  1.1     skrll       flags |= SEC_MERGE;
    972  1.1     skrll       newsect->entsize = hdr->sh_entsize;
    973  1.1     skrll       if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_STRINGS) != 0)
    974  1.1     skrll 	flags |= SEC_STRINGS;
    975  1.1     skrll     }
    976  1.1     skrll   if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP)
    977  1.1     skrll     if (!setup_group (abfd, hdr, newsect))
    978  1.1     skrll       return FALSE;
    979  1.1     skrll   if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0)
    980  1.1     skrll     flags |= SEC_THREAD_LOCAL;
    981  1.3  christos   if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE) != 0)
    982  1.3  christos     flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
    983  1.1     skrll 
    984  1.1     skrll   if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
    985  1.1     skrll     {
    986  1.1     skrll       /* The debugging sections appear to be recognized only by name,
    987  1.1     skrll 	 not any sort of flag.  Their SEC_ALLOC bits are cleared.  */
    988  1.1     skrll       if (name [0] == '.')
    989  1.1     skrll 	{
    990  1.5  christos 	  const char *p;
    991  1.5  christos 	  int n;
    992  1.5  christos 	  if (name[1] == 'd')
    993  1.5  christos 	    p = ".debug", n = 6;
    994  1.5  christos 	  else if (name[1] == 'g' && name[2] == 'n')
    995  1.5  christos 	    p = ".gnu.linkonce.wi.", n = 17;
    996  1.5  christos 	  else if (name[1] == 'g' && name[2] == 'd')
    997  1.5  christos 	    p = ".gdb_index", n = 11; /* yes we really do mean 11.  */
    998  1.5  christos 	  else if (name[1] == 'l')
    999  1.5  christos 	    p = ".line", n = 5;
   1000  1.5  christos 	  else if (name[1] == 's')
   1001  1.5  christos 	    p = ".stab", n = 5;
   1002  1.5  christos 	  else if (name[1] == 'z')
   1003  1.5  christos 	    p = ".zdebug", n = 7;
   1004  1.5  christos 	  else
   1005  1.5  christos 	    p = NULL, n = 0;
   1006  1.5  christos 	  if (p != NULL && strncmp (name, p, n) == 0)
   1007  1.1     skrll 	    flags |= SEC_DEBUGGING;
   1008  1.1     skrll 	}
   1009  1.1     skrll     }
   1010  1.1     skrll 
   1011  1.1     skrll   /* As a GNU extension, if the name begins with .gnu.linkonce, we
   1012  1.1     skrll      only link a single copy of the section.  This is used to support
   1013  1.1     skrll      g++.  g++ will emit each template expansion in its own section.
   1014  1.1     skrll      The symbols will be defined as weak, so that multiple definitions
   1015  1.1     skrll      are permitted.  The GNU linker extension is to actually discard
   1016  1.1     skrll      all but one of the sections.  */
   1017  1.1     skrll   if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gnu.linkonce")
   1018  1.1     skrll       && elf_next_in_group (newsect) == NULL)
   1019  1.1     skrll     flags |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
   1020  1.1     skrll 
   1021  1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   1022  1.1     skrll   if (bed->elf_backend_section_flags)
   1023  1.1     skrll     if (! bed->elf_backend_section_flags (&flags, hdr))
   1024  1.1     skrll       return FALSE;
   1025  1.1     skrll 
   1026  1.1     skrll   if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, newsect, flags))
   1027  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   1028  1.1     skrll 
   1029  1.1     skrll   /* We do not parse the PT_NOTE segments as we are interested even in the
   1030  1.1     skrll      separate debug info files which may have the segments offsets corrupted.
   1031  1.1     skrll      PT_NOTEs from the core files are currently not parsed using BFD.  */
   1032  1.1     skrll   if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOTE)
   1033  1.1     skrll     {
   1034  1.1     skrll       bfd_byte *contents;
   1035  1.1     skrll 
   1036  1.1     skrll       if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, newsect, &contents))
   1037  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   1038  1.1     skrll 
   1039  1.1     skrll       elf_parse_notes (abfd, (char *) contents, hdr->sh_size, -1);
   1040  1.1     skrll       free (contents);
   1041  1.1     skrll     }
   1042  1.1     skrll 
   1043  1.1     skrll   if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
   1044  1.1     skrll     {
   1045  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdr;
   1046  1.1     skrll       unsigned int i, nload;
   1047  1.1     skrll 
   1048  1.1     skrll       /* Some ELF linkers produce binaries with all the program header
   1049  1.1     skrll 	 p_paddr fields zero.  If we have such a binary with more than
   1050  1.1     skrll 	 one PT_LOAD header, then leave the section lma equal to vma
   1051  1.1     skrll 	 so that we don't create sections with overlapping lma.  */
   1052  1.1     skrll       phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
   1053  1.1     skrll       for (nload = 0, i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
   1054  1.1     skrll 	if (phdr->p_paddr != 0)
   1055  1.1     skrll 	  break;
   1056  1.1     skrll 	else if (phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD && phdr->p_memsz != 0)
   1057  1.1     skrll 	  ++nload;
   1058  1.1     skrll       if (i >= elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum && nload > 1)
   1059  1.1     skrll 	return TRUE;
   1060  1.1     skrll 
   1061  1.1     skrll       phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
   1062  1.1     skrll       for (i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
   1063  1.1     skrll 	{
   1064  1.3  christos 	  if (((phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD
   1065  1.3  christos 		&& (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
   1066  1.3  christos 	       || phdr->p_type == PT_TLS)
   1067  1.3  christos 	      && ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (hdr, phdr))
   1068  1.1     skrll 	    {
   1069  1.1     skrll 	      if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
   1070  1.1     skrll 		newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
   1071  1.1     skrll 				+ hdr->sh_addr - phdr->p_vaddr);
   1072  1.1     skrll 	      else
   1073  1.1     skrll 		/* We used to use the same adjustment for SEC_LOAD
   1074  1.1     skrll 		   sections, but that doesn't work if the segment
   1075  1.1     skrll 		   is packed with code from multiple VMAs.
   1076  1.1     skrll 		   Instead we calculate the section LMA based on
   1077  1.1     skrll 		   the segment LMA.  It is assumed that the
   1078  1.1     skrll 		   segment will contain sections with contiguous
   1079  1.1     skrll 		   LMAs, even if the VMAs are not.  */
   1080  1.1     skrll 		newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
   1081  1.1     skrll 				+ hdr->sh_offset - phdr->p_offset);
   1082  1.1     skrll 
   1083  1.1     skrll 	      /* With contiguous segments, we can't tell from file
   1084  1.1     skrll 		 offsets whether a section with zero size should
   1085  1.1     skrll 		 be placed at the end of one segment or the
   1086  1.1     skrll 		 beginning of the next.  Decide based on vaddr.  */
   1087  1.1     skrll 	      if (hdr->sh_addr >= phdr->p_vaddr
   1088  1.1     skrll 		  && (hdr->sh_addr + hdr->sh_size
   1089  1.1     skrll 		      <= phdr->p_vaddr + phdr->p_memsz))
   1090  1.1     skrll 		break;
   1091  1.1     skrll 	    }
   1092  1.1     skrll 	}
   1093  1.1     skrll     }
   1094  1.1     skrll 
   1095  1.3  christos   /* Compress/decompress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_* and
   1096  1.3  christos      .zdebug_*, after the section flags is set.  */
   1097  1.3  christos   if ((flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
   1098  1.3  christos       && ((name[1] == 'd' && name[6] == '_')
   1099  1.3  christos 	  || (name[1] == 'z' && name[7] == '_')))
   1100  1.3  christos     {
   1101  1.3  christos       enum { nothing, compress, decompress } action = nothing;
   1102  1.6  christos       int compression_header_size;
   1103  1.6  christos       bfd_size_type uncompressed_size;
   1104  1.6  christos       bfd_boolean compressed
   1105  1.6  christos 	= bfd_is_section_compressed_with_header (abfd, newsect,
   1106  1.6  christos 						 &compression_header_size,
   1107  1.6  christos 						 &uncompressed_size);
   1108  1.3  christos 
   1109  1.6  christos       if (compressed)
   1110  1.3  christos 	{
   1111  1.3  christos 	  /* Compressed section.  Check if we should decompress.  */
   1112  1.3  christos 	  if ((abfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS))
   1113  1.3  christos 	    action = decompress;
   1114  1.3  christos 	}
   1115  1.6  christos 
   1116  1.6  christos       /* Compress the uncompressed section or convert from/to .zdebug*
   1117  1.6  christos 	 section.  Check if we should compress.  */
   1118  1.6  christos       if (action == nothing)
   1119  1.6  christos 	{
   1120  1.6  christos 	  if (newsect->size != 0
   1121  1.6  christos 	      && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS)
   1122  1.6  christos 	      && compression_header_size >= 0
   1123  1.6  christos 	      && uncompressed_size > 0
   1124  1.6  christos 	      && (!compressed
   1125  1.6  christos 		  || ((compression_header_size > 0)
   1126  1.6  christos 		      != ((abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0))))
   1127  1.3  christos 	    action = compress;
   1128  1.6  christos 	  else
   1129  1.6  christos 	    return TRUE;
   1130  1.3  christos 	}
   1131  1.1     skrll 
   1132  1.6  christos       if (action == compress)
   1133  1.3  christos 	{
   1134  1.3  christos 	  if (!bfd_init_section_compress_status (abfd, newsect))
   1135  1.3  christos 	    {
   1136  1.3  christos 	      (*_bfd_error_handler)
   1137  1.5  christos 		(_("%B: unable to initialize compress status for section %s"),
   1138  1.3  christos 		 abfd, name);
   1139  1.3  christos 	      return FALSE;
   1140  1.3  christos 	    }
   1141  1.6  christos 	}
   1142  1.6  christos       else
   1143  1.6  christos 	{
   1144  1.3  christos 	  if (!bfd_init_section_decompress_status (abfd, newsect))
   1145  1.3  christos 	    {
   1146  1.3  christos 	      (*_bfd_error_handler)
   1147  1.5  christos 		(_("%B: unable to initialize decompress status for section %s"),
   1148  1.3  christos 		 abfd, name);
   1149  1.3  christos 	      return FALSE;
   1150  1.3  christos 	    }
   1151  1.6  christos 	}
   1152  1.1     skrll 
   1153  1.6  christos       if (abfd->is_linker_input)
   1154  1.6  christos 	{
   1155  1.6  christos 	  if (name[1] == 'z'
   1156  1.6  christos 	      && (action == decompress
   1157  1.6  christos 		  || (action == compress
   1158  1.6  christos 		      && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0)))
   1159  1.6  christos 	    {
   1160  1.6  christos 	      /* Convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* so
   1161  1.6  christos 		 that linker will consider this section as a debug
   1162  1.6  christos 		 section.  */
   1163  1.6  christos 	      char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
   1164  1.3  christos 	      if (new_name == NULL)
   1165  1.3  christos 		return FALSE;
   1166  1.6  christos 	      bfd_rename_section (abfd, newsect, new_name);
   1167  1.3  christos 	    }
   1168  1.1     skrll 	}
   1169  1.6  christos       else
   1170  1.6  christos 	/* For objdump, don't rename the section.  For objcopy, delay
   1171  1.6  christos 	   section rename to elf_fake_sections.  */
   1172  1.6  christos 	newsect->flags |= SEC_ELF_RENAME;
   1173  1.1     skrll     }
   1174  1.3  christos 
   1175  1.3  christos   return TRUE;
   1176  1.1     skrll }
   1177  1.1     skrll 
   1178  1.1     skrll const char *const bfd_elf_section_type_names[] = {
   1179  1.1     skrll   "SHT_NULL", "SHT_PROGBITS", "SHT_SYMTAB", "SHT_STRTAB",
   1180  1.1     skrll   "SHT_RELA", "SHT_HASH", "SHT_DYNAMIC", "SHT_NOTE",
   1181  1.1     skrll   "SHT_NOBITS", "SHT_REL", "SHT_SHLIB", "SHT_DYNSYM",
   1182  1.1     skrll };
   1183  1.1     skrll 
   1184  1.1     skrll /* ELF relocs are against symbols.  If we are producing relocatable
   1185  1.1     skrll    output, and the reloc is against an external symbol, and nothing
   1186  1.1     skrll    has given us any additional addend, the resulting reloc will also
   1187  1.1     skrll    be against the same symbol.  In such a case, we don't want to
   1188  1.1     skrll    change anything about the way the reloc is handled, since it will
   1189  1.1     skrll    all be done at final link time.  Rather than put special case code
   1190  1.1     skrll    into bfd_perform_relocation, all the reloc types use this howto
   1191  1.1     skrll    function.  It just short circuits the reloc if producing
   1192  1.1     skrll    relocatable output against an external symbol.  */
   1193  1.1     skrll 
   1194  1.1     skrll bfd_reloc_status_type
   1195  1.1     skrll bfd_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   1196  1.1     skrll 		       arelent *reloc_entry,
   1197  1.1     skrll 		       asymbol *symbol,
   1198  1.1     skrll 		       void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   1199  1.1     skrll 		       asection *input_section,
   1200  1.1     skrll 		       bfd *output_bfd,
   1201  1.1     skrll 		       char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   1202  1.1     skrll {
   1203  1.1     skrll   if (output_bfd != NULL
   1204  1.1     skrll       && (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
   1205  1.1     skrll       && (! reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace
   1206  1.1     skrll 	  || reloc_entry->addend == 0))
   1207  1.1     skrll     {
   1208  1.1     skrll       reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
   1209  1.1     skrll       return bfd_reloc_ok;
   1210  1.1     skrll     }
   1211  1.1     skrll 
   1212  1.1     skrll   return bfd_reloc_continue;
   1213  1.1     skrll }
   1214  1.1     skrll 
   1215  1.1     skrll /* Copy the program header and other data from one object module to
   1217  1.1     skrll    another.  */
   1218  1.1     skrll 
   1219  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   1220  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
   1221  1.1     skrll {
   1222  1.1     skrll   if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
   1223  1.1     skrll       || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
   1224  1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   1225  1.6  christos 
   1226  1.6  christos   if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
   1227  1.6  christos     {
   1228  1.6  christos       elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
   1229  1.6  christos       elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
   1230  1.1     skrll     }
   1231  1.1     skrll 
   1232  1.6  christos   elf_gp (obfd) = elf_gp (ibfd);
   1233  1.6  christos 
   1234  1.6  christos   /* Also copy the EI_OSABI field.  */
   1235  1.6  christos   elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI] =
   1236  1.1     skrll     elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI];
   1237  1.1     skrll 
   1238  1.1     skrll   /* Copy object attributes.  */
   1239  1.6  christos   _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
   1240  1.6  christos 
   1241  1.6  christos   /* This is an feature for objcopy --only-keep-debug:  When a section's type
   1242  1.6  christos      is changed to NOBITS, we preserve the sh_link and sh_info fields so that
   1243  1.6  christos      they can be matched up with the original.  */
   1244  1.6  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr ** iheaders = elf_elfsections (ibfd);
   1245  1.6  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr ** oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
   1246  1.6  christos 
   1247  1.6  christos   if (iheaders != NULL && oheaders != NULL)
   1248  1.6  christos     {
   1249  1.6  christos       unsigned int i;
   1250  1.6  christos 
   1251  1.6  christos       for (i = 0; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
   1252  1.6  christos 	{
   1253  1.6  christos 	  unsigned int j;
   1254  1.6  christos 	  Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
   1255  1.6  christos 
   1256  1.6  christos 	  if (oheader == NULL
   1257  1.6  christos 	      || oheader->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
   1258  1.6  christos 	      || oheader->sh_size == 0
   1259  1.6  christos 	      || (oheader->sh_info != 0 && oheader->sh_link != 0))
   1260  1.6  christos 	    continue;
   1261  1.6  christos 
   1262  1.6  christos 	  /* Scan for the matching section in the input bfd.
   1263  1.6  christos 	     FIXME: We could use something better than a linear scan here.
   1264  1.6  christos 	     Unfortunately we cannot compare names as the output string table
   1265  1.6  christos 	     is empty, so instead we check size, address and type.  */
   1266  1.6  christos 	  for (j = 0; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
   1267  1.6  christos 	    {
   1268  1.6  christos 	      Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
   1269  1.6  christos 
   1270  1.6  christos 	      /* Since --only-keep-debug turns all non-debug sections
   1271  1.6  christos 		 into SHT_NOBITS sections, the output SHT_NOBITS type
   1272  1.6  christos 		 matches any input type.  */
   1273  1.6  christos 	      if ((oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
   1274  1.6  christos 		   || iheader->sh_type == oheader->sh_type)
   1275  1.6  christos 		  && iheader->sh_flags == oheader->sh_flags
   1276  1.6  christos 		  && iheader->sh_addralign == oheader->sh_addralign
   1277  1.6  christos 		  && iheader->sh_entsize == oheader->sh_entsize
   1278  1.6  christos 		  && iheader->sh_size == oheader->sh_size
   1279  1.6  christos 		  && iheader->sh_addr == oheader->sh_addr
   1280  1.6  christos 		  && (iheader->sh_info != oheader->sh_info
   1281  1.6  christos 		      || iheader->sh_link != oheader->sh_link))
   1282  1.6  christos 		{
   1283  1.6  christos 		  /* Note: Strictly speaking these assignments are wrong.
   1284  1.6  christos 		     The sh_link and sh_info fields should point to the
   1285  1.6  christos 		     relevent sections in the output BFD, which may not be in
   1286  1.6  christos 		     the same location as they were in the input BFD.  But the
   1287  1.6  christos 		     whole point of this action is to preserve the original
   1288  1.6  christos 		     values of the sh_link and sh_info fields, so that they
   1289  1.6  christos 		     can be matched up with the section headers in the
   1290  1.6  christos 		     original file.  So strictly speaking we may be creating
   1291  1.6  christos 		     an invalid ELF file, but it is only for a file that just
   1292  1.6  christos 		     contains debug info and only for sections without any
   1293  1.6  christos 		     contents.  */
   1294  1.6  christos 		  if (oheader->sh_link == 0)
   1295  1.6  christos 		    oheader->sh_link = iheader->sh_link;
   1296  1.6  christos 		  if (oheader->sh_info == 0)
   1297  1.6  christos 		    oheader->sh_info = iheader->sh_info;
   1298  1.6  christos 		  break;
   1299  1.6  christos 		}
   1300  1.6  christos 	    }
   1301  1.6  christos 	}
   1302  1.6  christos     }
   1303  1.1     skrll 
   1304  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   1305  1.1     skrll }
   1306  1.1     skrll 
   1307  1.1     skrll static const char *
   1308  1.1     skrll get_segment_type (unsigned int p_type)
   1309  1.1     skrll {
   1310  1.1     skrll   const char *pt;
   1311  1.1     skrll   switch (p_type)
   1312  1.1     skrll     {
   1313  1.1     skrll     case PT_NULL: pt = "NULL"; break;
   1314  1.1     skrll     case PT_LOAD: pt = "LOAD"; break;
   1315  1.1     skrll     case PT_DYNAMIC: pt = "DYNAMIC"; break;
   1316  1.1     skrll     case PT_INTERP: pt = "INTERP"; break;
   1317  1.1     skrll     case PT_NOTE: pt = "NOTE"; break;
   1318  1.1     skrll     case PT_SHLIB: pt = "SHLIB"; break;
   1319  1.1     skrll     case PT_PHDR: pt = "PHDR"; break;
   1320  1.1     skrll     case PT_TLS: pt = "TLS"; break;
   1321  1.1     skrll     case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME: pt = "EH_FRAME"; break;
   1322  1.1     skrll     case PT_GNU_STACK: pt = "STACK"; break;
   1323  1.1     skrll     case PT_GNU_RELRO: pt = "RELRO"; break;
   1324  1.1     skrll     default: pt = NULL; break;
   1325  1.1     skrll     }
   1326  1.1     skrll   return pt;
   1327  1.1     skrll }
   1328  1.1     skrll 
   1329  1.1     skrll /* Print out the program headers.  */
   1330  1.1     skrll 
   1331  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   1332  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *farg)
   1333  1.3  christos {
   1334  1.1     skrll   FILE *f = (FILE *) farg;
   1335  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
   1336  1.1     skrll   asection *s;
   1337  1.1     skrll   bfd_byte *dynbuf = NULL;
   1338  1.1     skrll 
   1339  1.1     skrll   p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
   1340  1.1     skrll   if (p != NULL)
   1341  1.1     skrll     {
   1342  1.1     skrll       unsigned int i, c;
   1343  1.1     skrll 
   1344  1.1     skrll       fprintf (f, _("\nProgram Header:\n"));
   1345  1.1     skrll       c = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
   1346  1.1     skrll       for (i = 0; i < c; i++, p++)
   1347  1.1     skrll 	{
   1348  1.1     skrll 	  const char *pt = get_segment_type (p->p_type);
   1349  1.1     skrll 	  char buf[20];
   1350  1.1     skrll 
   1351  1.1     skrll 	  if (pt == NULL)
   1352  1.1     skrll 	    {
   1353  1.1     skrll 	      sprintf (buf, "0x%lx", p->p_type);
   1354  1.1     skrll 	      pt = buf;
   1355  1.1     skrll 	    }
   1356  1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, "%8s off    0x", pt);
   1357  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_offset);
   1358  1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, " vaddr 0x");
   1359  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_vaddr);
   1360  1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, " paddr 0x");
   1361  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_paddr);
   1362  1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, " align 2**%u\n", bfd_log2 (p->p_align));
   1363  1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, "         filesz 0x");
   1364  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_filesz);
   1365  1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, " memsz 0x");
   1366  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_memsz);
   1367  1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, " flags %c%c%c",
   1368  1.1     skrll 		   (p->p_flags & PF_R) != 0 ? 'r' : '-',
   1369  1.1     skrll 		   (p->p_flags & PF_W) != 0 ? 'w' : '-',
   1370  1.1     skrll 		   (p->p_flags & PF_X) != 0 ? 'x' : '-');
   1371  1.1     skrll 	  if ((p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X)) != 0)
   1372  1.1     skrll 	    fprintf (f, " %lx", p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X));
   1373  1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, "\n");
   1374  1.1     skrll 	}
   1375  1.1     skrll     }
   1376  1.1     skrll 
   1377  1.1     skrll   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
   1378  1.1     skrll   if (s != NULL)
   1379  1.1     skrll     {
   1380  1.1     skrll       unsigned int elfsec;
   1381  1.1     skrll       unsigned long shlink;
   1382  1.1     skrll       bfd_byte *extdyn, *extdynend;
   1383  1.1     skrll       size_t extdynsize;
   1384  1.1     skrll       void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
   1385  1.1     skrll 
   1386  1.1     skrll       fprintf (f, _("\nDynamic Section:\n"));
   1387  1.1     skrll 
   1388  1.1     skrll       if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &dynbuf))
   1389  1.1     skrll 	goto error_return;
   1390  1.1     skrll 
   1391  1.1     skrll       elfsec = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, s);
   1392  1.1     skrll       if (elfsec == SHN_BAD)
   1393  1.1     skrll 	goto error_return;
   1394  1.1     skrll       shlink = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec]->sh_link;
   1395  1.1     skrll 
   1396  1.1     skrll       extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
   1397  1.1     skrll       swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
   1398  1.1     skrll 
   1399  1.6  christos       extdyn = dynbuf;
   1400  1.6  christos       /* PR 17512: file: 6f427532.  */
   1401  1.6  christos       if (s->size < extdynsize)
   1402  1.1     skrll 	goto error_return;
   1403  1.6  christos       extdynend = extdyn + s->size;
   1404  1.6  christos       /* PR 17512: file: id:000006,sig:06,src:000000,op:flip4,pos:5664.
   1405  1.6  christos          Fix range check.  */
   1406  1.1     skrll       for (; extdyn <= (extdynend - extdynsize); extdyn += extdynsize)
   1407  1.1     skrll 	{
   1408  1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
   1409  1.1     skrll 	  const char *name = "";
   1410  1.1     skrll 	  char ab[20];
   1411  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_boolean stringp;
   1412  1.1     skrll 	  const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   1413  1.1     skrll 
   1414  1.1     skrll 	  (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
   1415  1.1     skrll 
   1416  1.1     skrll 	  if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
   1417  1.1     skrll 	    break;
   1418  1.1     skrll 
   1419  1.1     skrll 	  stringp = FALSE;
   1420  1.1     skrll 	  switch (dyn.d_tag)
   1421  1.1     skrll 	    {
   1422  1.1     skrll 	    default:
   1423  1.1     skrll 	      if (bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag)
   1424  1.1     skrll 		name = (*bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag) (dyn.d_tag);
   1425  1.1     skrll 
   1426  1.1     skrll 	      if (!strcmp (name, ""))
   1427  1.1     skrll 		{
   1428  1.1     skrll 		  sprintf (ab, "0x%lx", (unsigned long) dyn.d_tag);
   1429  1.1     skrll 		  name = ab;
   1430  1.1     skrll 		}
   1431  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   1432  1.1     skrll 
   1433  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_NEEDED: name = "NEEDED"; stringp = TRUE; break;
   1434  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_PLTRELSZ: name = "PLTRELSZ"; break;
   1435  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_PLTGOT: name = "PLTGOT"; break;
   1436  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_HASH: name = "HASH"; break;
   1437  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_STRTAB: name = "STRTAB"; break;
   1438  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_SYMTAB: name = "SYMTAB"; break;
   1439  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_RELA: name = "RELA"; break;
   1440  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_RELASZ: name = "RELASZ"; break;
   1441  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_RELAENT: name = "RELAENT"; break;
   1442  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_STRSZ: name = "STRSZ"; break;
   1443  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_SYMENT: name = "SYMENT"; break;
   1444  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_INIT: name = "INIT"; break;
   1445  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_FINI: name = "FINI"; break;
   1446  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_SONAME: name = "SONAME"; stringp = TRUE; break;
   1447  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_RPATH: name = "RPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
   1448  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_SYMBOLIC: name = "SYMBOLIC"; break;
   1449  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_REL: name = "REL"; break;
   1450  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_RELSZ: name = "RELSZ"; break;
   1451  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_RELENT: name = "RELENT"; break;
   1452  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_PLTREL: name = "PLTREL"; break;
   1453  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_DEBUG: name = "DEBUG"; break;
   1454  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_TEXTREL: name = "TEXTREL"; break;
   1455  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_JMPREL: name = "JMPREL"; break;
   1456  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_BIND_NOW: name = "BIND_NOW"; break;
   1457  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_INIT_ARRAY: name = "INIT_ARRAY"; break;
   1458  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_FINI_ARRAY: name = "FINI_ARRAY"; break;
   1459  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_INIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "INIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
   1460  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_FINI_ARRAYSZ: name = "FINI_ARRAYSZ"; break;
   1461  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_RUNPATH: name = "RUNPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
   1462  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_FLAGS: name = "FLAGS"; break;
   1463  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_PREINIT_ARRAY: name = "PREINIT_ARRAY"; break;
   1464  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_PREINIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "PREINIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
   1465  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_CHECKSUM: name = "CHECKSUM"; break;
   1466  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_PLTPADSZ: name = "PLTPADSZ"; break;
   1467  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_MOVEENT: name = "MOVEENT"; break;
   1468  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_MOVESZ: name = "MOVESZ"; break;
   1469  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_FEATURE: name = "FEATURE"; break;
   1470  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_POSFLAG_1: name = "POSFLAG_1"; break;
   1471  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_SYMINSZ: name = "SYMINSZ"; break;
   1472  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_SYMINENT: name = "SYMINENT"; break;
   1473  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_CONFIG: name = "CONFIG"; stringp = TRUE; break;
   1474  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_DEPAUDIT: name = "DEPAUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
   1475  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_AUDIT: name = "AUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
   1476  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_PLTPAD: name = "PLTPAD"; break;
   1477  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_MOVETAB: name = "MOVETAB"; break;
   1478  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_SYMINFO: name = "SYMINFO"; break;
   1479  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_RELACOUNT: name = "RELACOUNT"; break;
   1480  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_RELCOUNT: name = "RELCOUNT"; break;
   1481  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_FLAGS_1: name = "FLAGS_1"; break;
   1482  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_VERSYM: name = "VERSYM"; break;
   1483  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_VERDEF: name = "VERDEF"; break;
   1484  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_VERDEFNUM: name = "VERDEFNUM"; break;
   1485  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_VERNEED: name = "VERNEED"; break;
   1486  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_VERNEEDNUM: name = "VERNEEDNUM"; break;
   1487  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_AUXILIARY: name = "AUXILIARY"; stringp = TRUE; break;
   1488  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_USED: name = "USED"; break;
   1489  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_FILTER: name = "FILTER"; stringp = TRUE; break;
   1490  1.1     skrll 	    case DT_GNU_HASH: name = "GNU_HASH"; break;
   1491  1.1     skrll 	    }
   1492  1.1     skrll 
   1493  1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, "  %-20s ", name);
   1494  1.1     skrll 	  if (! stringp)
   1495  1.1     skrll 	    {
   1496  1.1     skrll 	      fprintf (f, "0x");
   1497  1.1     skrll 	      bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, dyn.d_un.d_val);
   1498  1.1     skrll 	    }
   1499  1.1     skrll 	  else
   1500  1.1     skrll 	    {
   1501  1.1     skrll 	      const char *string;
   1502  1.1     skrll 	      unsigned int tagv = dyn.d_un.d_val;
   1503  1.1     skrll 
   1504  1.1     skrll 	      string = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shlink, tagv);
   1505  1.1     skrll 	      if (string == NULL)
   1506  1.1     skrll 		goto error_return;
   1507  1.1     skrll 	      fprintf (f, "%s", string);
   1508  1.1     skrll 	    }
   1509  1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, "\n");
   1510  1.1     skrll 	}
   1511  1.1     skrll 
   1512  1.1     skrll       free (dynbuf);
   1513  1.1     skrll       dynbuf = NULL;
   1514  1.1     skrll     }
   1515  1.1     skrll 
   1516  1.1     skrll   if ((elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
   1517  1.1     skrll       || (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL))
   1518  1.1     skrll     {
   1519  1.1     skrll       if (! _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (abfd, FALSE))
   1520  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   1521  1.1     skrll     }
   1522  1.1     skrll 
   1523  1.1     skrll   if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
   1524  1.1     skrll     {
   1525  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Verdef *t;
   1526  1.1     skrll 
   1527  1.1     skrll       fprintf (f, _("\nVersion definitions:\n"));
   1528  1.1     skrll       for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef; t != NULL; t = t->vd_nextdef)
   1529  1.1     skrll 	{
   1530  1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, "%d 0x%2.2x 0x%8.8lx %s\n", t->vd_ndx,
   1531  1.1     skrll 		   t->vd_flags, t->vd_hash,
   1532  1.1     skrll 		   t->vd_nodename ? t->vd_nodename : "<corrupt>");
   1533  1.1     skrll 	  if (t->vd_auxptr != NULL && t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr != NULL)
   1534  1.1     skrll 	    {
   1535  1.1     skrll 	      Elf_Internal_Verdaux *a;
   1536  1.1     skrll 
   1537  1.1     skrll 	      fprintf (f, "\t");
   1538  1.1     skrll 	      for (a = t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr;
   1539  1.1     skrll 		   a != NULL;
   1540  1.1     skrll 		   a = a->vda_nextptr)
   1541  1.1     skrll 		fprintf (f, "%s ",
   1542  1.1     skrll 			 a->vda_nodename ? a->vda_nodename : "<corrupt>");
   1543  1.1     skrll 	      fprintf (f, "\n");
   1544  1.1     skrll 	    }
   1545  1.1     skrll 	}
   1546  1.1     skrll     }
   1547  1.1     skrll 
   1548  1.1     skrll   if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
   1549  1.1     skrll     {
   1550  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
   1551  1.1     skrll 
   1552  1.1     skrll       fprintf (f, _("\nVersion References:\n"));
   1553  1.1     skrll       for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref; t != NULL; t = t->vn_nextref)
   1554  1.1     skrll 	{
   1555  1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
   1556  1.1     skrll 
   1557  1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, _("  required from %s:\n"),
   1558  1.1     skrll 		   t->vn_filename ? t->vn_filename : "<corrupt>");
   1559  1.1     skrll 	  for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
   1560  1.1     skrll 	    fprintf (f, "    0x%8.8lx 0x%2.2x %2.2d %s\n", a->vna_hash,
   1561  1.1     skrll 		     a->vna_flags, a->vna_other,
   1562  1.1     skrll 		     a->vna_nodename ? a->vna_nodename : "<corrupt>");
   1563  1.1     skrll 	}
   1564  1.1     skrll     }
   1565  1.1     skrll 
   1566  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   1567  1.1     skrll 
   1568  1.1     skrll  error_return:
   1569  1.1     skrll   if (dynbuf != NULL)
   1570  1.1     skrll     free (dynbuf);
   1571  1.1     skrll   return FALSE;
   1572  1.1     skrll }
   1573  1.6  christos 
   1574  1.6  christos /* Get version string.  */
   1575  1.6  christos 
   1576  1.6  christos const char *
   1577  1.6  christos _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
   1578  1.6  christos 				    bfd_boolean *hidden)
   1579  1.6  christos {
   1580  1.6  christos   const char *version_string = NULL;
   1581  1.6  christos   if (elf_dynversym (abfd) != 0
   1582  1.6  christos       && (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 || elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0))
   1583  1.6  christos     {
   1584  1.6  christos       unsigned int vernum = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->version;
   1585  1.6  christos 
   1586  1.6  christos       *hidden = (vernum & VERSYM_HIDDEN) != 0;
   1587  1.6  christos       vernum &= VERSYM_VERSION;
   1588  1.6  christos 
   1589  1.6  christos       if (vernum == 0)
   1590  1.6  christos 	version_string = "";
   1591  1.6  christos       else if (vernum == 1)
   1592  1.6  christos 	version_string = "Base";
   1593  1.6  christos       else if (vernum <= elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs)
   1594  1.6  christos 	version_string =
   1595  1.6  christos 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[vernum - 1].vd_nodename;
   1596  1.6  christos       else
   1597  1.6  christos 	{
   1598  1.6  christos 	  Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
   1599  1.6  christos 
   1600  1.6  christos 	  version_string = "";
   1601  1.6  christos 	  for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
   1602  1.6  christos 	       t != NULL;
   1603  1.6  christos 	       t = t->vn_nextref)
   1604  1.6  christos 	    {
   1605  1.6  christos 	      Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
   1606  1.6  christos 
   1607  1.6  christos 	      for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
   1608  1.6  christos 		{
   1609  1.6  christos 		  if (a->vna_other == vernum)
   1610  1.6  christos 		    {
   1611  1.6  christos 		      version_string = a->vna_nodename;
   1612  1.6  christos 		      break;
   1613  1.6  christos 		    }
   1614  1.6  christos 		}
   1615  1.6  christos 	    }
   1616  1.6  christos 	}
   1617  1.6  christos     }
   1618  1.6  christos   return version_string;
   1619  1.6  christos }
   1620  1.1     skrll 
   1621  1.1     skrll /* Display ELF-specific fields of a symbol.  */
   1622  1.1     skrll 
   1623  1.1     skrll void
   1624  1.1     skrll bfd_elf_print_symbol (bfd *abfd,
   1625  1.1     skrll 		      void *filep,
   1626  1.1     skrll 		      asymbol *symbol,
   1627  1.1     skrll 		      bfd_print_symbol_type how)
   1628  1.3  christos {
   1629  1.1     skrll   FILE *file = (FILE *) filep;
   1630  1.1     skrll   switch (how)
   1631  1.1     skrll     {
   1632  1.1     skrll     case bfd_print_symbol_name:
   1633  1.1     skrll       fprintf (file, "%s", symbol->name);
   1634  1.1     skrll       break;
   1635  1.1     skrll     case bfd_print_symbol_more:
   1636  1.1     skrll       fprintf (file, "elf ");
   1637  1.1     skrll       bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, symbol->value);
   1638  1.1     skrll       fprintf (file, " %lx", (unsigned long) symbol->flags);
   1639  1.1     skrll       break;
   1640  1.1     skrll     case bfd_print_symbol_all:
   1641  1.1     skrll       {
   1642  1.1     skrll 	const char *section_name;
   1643  1.1     skrll 	const char *name = NULL;
   1644  1.1     skrll 	const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   1645  1.1     skrll 	unsigned char st_other;
   1646  1.6  christos 	bfd_vma val;
   1647  1.6  christos 	const char *version_string;
   1648  1.1     skrll 	bfd_boolean hidden;
   1649  1.1     skrll 
   1650  1.1     skrll 	section_name = symbol->section ? symbol->section->name : "(*none*)";
   1651  1.1     skrll 
   1652  1.1     skrll 	bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   1653  1.1     skrll 	if (bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all)
   1654  1.1     skrll 	  name = (*bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all) (abfd, filep, symbol);
   1655  1.1     skrll 
   1656  1.1     skrll 	if (name == NULL)
   1657  1.1     skrll 	  {
   1658  1.1     skrll 	    name = symbol->name;
   1659  1.1     skrll 	    bfd_print_symbol_vandf (abfd, file, symbol);
   1660  1.1     skrll 	  }
   1661  1.1     skrll 
   1662  1.1     skrll 	fprintf (file, " %s\t", section_name);
   1663  1.1     skrll 	/* Print the "other" value for a symbol.  For common symbols,
   1664  1.1     skrll 	   we've already printed the size; now print the alignment.
   1665  1.1     skrll 	   For other symbols, we have no specified alignment, and
   1666  1.1     skrll 	   we've printed the address; now print the size.  */
   1667  1.1     skrll 	if (symbol->section && bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
   1668  1.1     skrll 	  val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
   1669  1.1     skrll 	else
   1670  1.1     skrll 	  val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
   1671  1.1     skrll 	bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, val);
   1672  1.1     skrll 
   1673  1.6  christos 	/* If we have version information, print it.  */
   1674  1.6  christos 	version_string = _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (abfd,
   1675  1.6  christos 							     symbol,
   1676  1.6  christos 							     &hidden);
   1677  1.1     skrll 	if (version_string)
   1678  1.6  christos 	  {
   1679  1.1     skrll 	    if (!hidden)
   1680  1.1     skrll 	      fprintf (file, "  %-11s", version_string);
   1681  1.1     skrll 	    else
   1682  1.1     skrll 	      {
   1683  1.1     skrll 		int i;
   1684  1.1     skrll 
   1685  1.1     skrll 		fprintf (file, " (%s)", version_string);
   1686  1.1     skrll 		for (i = 10 - strlen (version_string); i > 0; --i)
   1687  1.1     skrll 		  putc (' ', file);
   1688  1.1     skrll 	      }
   1689  1.1     skrll 	  }
   1690  1.1     skrll 
   1691  1.1     skrll 	/* If the st_other field is not zero, print it.  */
   1692  1.1     skrll 	st_other = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
   1693  1.1     skrll 
   1694  1.1     skrll 	switch (st_other)
   1695  1.1     skrll 	  {
   1696  1.1     skrll 	  case 0: break;
   1697  1.1     skrll 	  case STV_INTERNAL:  fprintf (file, " .internal");  break;
   1698  1.1     skrll 	  case STV_HIDDEN:    fprintf (file, " .hidden");    break;
   1699  1.1     skrll 	  case STV_PROTECTED: fprintf (file, " .protected"); break;
   1700  1.1     skrll 	  default:
   1701  1.1     skrll 	    /* Some other non-defined flags are also present, so print
   1702  1.1     skrll 	       everything hex.  */
   1703  1.1     skrll 	    fprintf (file, " 0x%02x", (unsigned int) st_other);
   1704  1.1     skrll 	  }
   1705  1.1     skrll 
   1706  1.1     skrll 	fprintf (file, " %s", name);
   1707  1.1     skrll       }
   1708  1.1     skrll       break;
   1709  1.1     skrll     }
   1710  1.1     skrll }
   1711  1.1     skrll 
   1712  1.1     skrll /* ELF .o/exec file reading */
   1714  1.1     skrll 
   1715  1.1     skrll /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF section header.  */
   1716  1.1     skrll 
   1717  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   1718  1.1     skrll bfd_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
   1719  1.1     skrll {
   1720  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
   1721  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Ehdr *ehdr;
   1722  1.6  christos   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   1723  1.6  christos   const char *name;
   1724  1.6  christos   bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
   1725  1.6  christos   static bfd_boolean * sections_being_created = NULL;
   1726  1.1     skrll   static bfd * sections_being_created_abfd = NULL;
   1727  1.1     skrll   static unsigned int nesting = 0;
   1728  1.1     skrll 
   1729  1.1     skrll   if (shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
   1730  1.6  christos     return FALSE;
   1731  1.6  christos 
   1732  1.6  christos   if (++ nesting > 3)
   1733  1.6  christos     {
   1734  1.6  christos       /* PR17512: A corrupt ELF binary might contain a recursive group of
   1735  1.6  christos 	 sections, with each the string indicies pointing to the next in the
   1736  1.6  christos 	 loop.  Detect this here, by refusing to load a section that we are
   1737  1.6  christos 	 already in the process of loading.  We only trigger this test if
   1738  1.6  christos 	 we have nested at least three sections deep as normal ELF binaries
   1739  1.6  christos 	 can expect to recurse at least once.
   1740  1.6  christos 
   1741  1.6  christos 	 FIXME: It would be better if this array was attached to the bfd,
   1742  1.6  christos 	 rather than being held in a static pointer.  */
   1743  1.6  christos 
   1744  1.6  christos       if (sections_being_created_abfd != abfd)
   1745  1.6  christos 	sections_being_created = NULL;
   1746  1.6  christos       if (sections_being_created == NULL)
   1747  1.6  christos 	{
   1748  1.6  christos 	  /* FIXME: It would be more efficient to attach this array to the bfd somehow.  */
   1749  1.6  christos 	  sections_being_created = (bfd_boolean *)
   1750  1.6  christos 	    bfd_zalloc (abfd, elf_numsections (abfd) * sizeof (bfd_boolean));
   1751  1.6  christos 	  sections_being_created_abfd = abfd;
   1752  1.6  christos 	}
   1753  1.6  christos       if (sections_being_created [shindex])
   1754  1.6  christos 	{
   1755  1.6  christos 	  (*_bfd_error_handler)
   1756  1.6  christos 	    (_("%B: warning: loop in section dependencies detected"), abfd);
   1757  1.6  christos 	  return FALSE;
   1758  1.6  christos 	}
   1759  1.6  christos       sections_being_created [shindex] = TRUE;
   1760  1.1     skrll     }
   1761  1.1     skrll 
   1762  1.1     skrll   hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
   1763  1.1     skrll   ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
   1764  1.1     skrll   name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, ehdr->e_shstrndx,
   1765  1.6  christos 					  hdr->sh_name);
   1766  1.1     skrll   if (name == NULL)
   1767  1.1     skrll     goto fail;
   1768  1.1     skrll 
   1769  1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   1770  1.1     skrll   switch (hdr->sh_type)
   1771  1.1     skrll     {
   1772  1.6  christos     case SHT_NULL:
   1773  1.1     skrll       /* Inactive section. Throw it away.  */
   1774  1.6  christos       goto success;
   1775  1.6  christos 
   1776  1.6  christos     case SHT_PROGBITS:		/* Normal section with contents.  */
   1777  1.6  christos     case SHT_NOBITS:		/* .bss section.  */
   1778  1.1     skrll     case SHT_HASH:		/* .hash section.  */
   1779  1.1     skrll     case SHT_NOTE:		/* .note section.  */
   1780  1.1     skrll     case SHT_INIT_ARRAY:	/* .init_array section.  */
   1781  1.1     skrll     case SHT_FINI_ARRAY:	/* .fini_array section.  */
   1782  1.1     skrll     case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY:	/* .preinit_array section.  */
   1783  1.6  christos     case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST:	/* .gnu.liblist section.  */
   1784  1.6  christos     case SHT_GNU_HASH:		/* .gnu.hash section.  */
   1785  1.1     skrll       ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
   1786  1.1     skrll       goto success;
   1787  1.1     skrll 
   1788  1.6  christos     case SHT_DYNAMIC:	/* Dynamic linking information.  */
   1789  1.6  christos       if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
   1790  1.3  christos 	goto fail;
   1791  1.3  christos 
   1792  1.3  christos       if (hdr->sh_link > elf_numsections (abfd))
   1793  1.3  christos 	{
   1794  1.3  christos 	  /* PR 10478: Accept Solaris binaries with a sh_link
   1795  1.3  christos 	     field set to SHN_BEFORE or SHN_AFTER.  */
   1796  1.3  christos 	  switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
   1797  1.3  christos 	    {
   1798  1.3  christos 	    case bfd_arch_i386:
   1799  1.3  christos 	    case bfd_arch_sparc:
   1800  1.3  christos 	      if (hdr->sh_link == (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xffff) /* SHN_BEFORE */
   1801  1.3  christos 		  || hdr->sh_link == ((SHN_LORESERVE + 1) & 0xffff) /* SHN_AFTER */)
   1802  1.3  christos 		break;
   1803  1.6  christos 	      /* Otherwise fall through.  */
   1804  1.3  christos 	    default:
   1805  1.3  christos 	      goto fail;
   1806  1.3  christos 	    }
   1807  1.6  christos 	}
   1808  1.3  christos       else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link] == NULL)
   1809  1.1     skrll 	goto fail;
   1810  1.1     skrll       else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB)
   1811  1.1     skrll 	{
   1812  1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Shdr *dynsymhdr;
   1813  1.1     skrll 
   1814  1.1     skrll 	  /* The shared libraries distributed with hpux11 have a bogus
   1815  1.1     skrll 	     sh_link field for the ".dynamic" section.  Find the
   1816  1.1     skrll 	     string table for the ".dynsym" section instead.  */
   1817  1.1     skrll 	  if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
   1818  1.1     skrll 	    {
   1819  1.1     skrll 	      dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)];
   1820  1.1     skrll 	      hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
   1821  1.1     skrll 	    }
   1822  1.1     skrll 	  else
   1823  1.1     skrll 	    {
   1824  1.1     skrll 	      unsigned int i, num_sec;
   1825  1.1     skrll 
   1826  1.1     skrll 	      num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
   1827  1.1     skrll 	      for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
   1828  1.1     skrll 		{
   1829  1.1     skrll 		  dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
   1830  1.1     skrll 		  if (dynsymhdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
   1831  1.1     skrll 		    {
   1832  1.1     skrll 		      hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
   1833  1.1     skrll 		      break;
   1834  1.1     skrll 		    }
   1835  1.1     skrll 		}
   1836  1.6  christos 	    }
   1837  1.1     skrll 	}
   1838  1.6  christos       goto success;
   1839  1.1     skrll 
   1840  1.6  christos     case SHT_SYMTAB:		/* A symbol table.  */
   1841  1.1     skrll       if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == shindex)
   1842  1.1     skrll 	goto success;
   1843  1.6  christos 
   1844  1.6  christos       if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
   1845  1.2     skrll 	goto fail;
   1846  1.5  christos 
   1847  1.5  christos       if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
   1848  1.6  christos 	{
   1849  1.5  christos 	  if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
   1850  1.5  christos 	    goto fail;
   1851  1.5  christos 	  /* Some assemblers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
   1852  1.5  christos 	     zero sh_size.  ld sees this as a global symbol count
   1853  1.6  christos 	     of (unsigned) -1.  Fix it here.  */
   1854  1.6  christos 	  hdr->sh_info = 0;
   1855  1.6  christos 	  goto success;
   1856  1.6  christos 	}
   1857  1.6  christos 
   1858  1.6  christos       /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one symbol table.
   1859  1.6  christos 	 Unusual, but possible.  Warn, but continue.  */
   1860  1.6  christos       if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) != 0)
   1861  1.6  christos 	{
   1862  1.6  christos 	  (*_bfd_error_handler)
   1863  1.6  christos 	    (_("%B: warning: multiple symbol tables detected - ignoring the table in section %u"),
   1864  1.5  christos 	     abfd, shindex);
   1865  1.1     skrll 	  goto success;
   1866  1.6  christos 	}
   1867  1.6  christos       elf_onesymtab (abfd) = shindex;
   1868  1.1     skrll       elf_symtab_hdr (abfd) = *hdr;
   1869  1.1     skrll       elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
   1870  1.1     skrll       abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
   1871  1.1     skrll 
   1872  1.1     skrll       /* Sometimes a shared object will map in the symbol table.  If
   1873  1.1     skrll 	 SHF_ALLOC is set, and this is a shared object, then we also
   1874  1.1     skrll 	 treat this section as a BFD section.  We can not base the
   1875  1.1     skrll 	 decision purely on SHF_ALLOC, because that flag is sometimes
   1876  1.1     skrll 	 set in a relocatable object file, which would confuse the
   1877  1.1     skrll 	 linker.  */
   1878  1.1     skrll       if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
   1879  1.1     skrll 	  && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
   1880  1.6  christos 	  && ! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
   1881  1.1     skrll 						shindex))
   1882  1.1     skrll 	goto fail;
   1883  1.1     skrll 
   1884  1.1     skrll       /* Go looking for SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX too, since if there is one we
   1885  1.6  christos 	 can't read symbols without that section loaded as well.  It
   1886  1.6  christos 	 is most likely specified by the next section header.  */
   1887  1.6  christos       {
   1888  1.6  christos 	elf_section_list * entry;
   1889  1.6  christos 	unsigned int i, num_sec;
   1890  1.6  christos 
   1891  1.6  christos 	for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
   1892  1.6  christos 	  if (entry->hdr.sh_link == shindex)
   1893  1.6  christos 	    goto success;
   1894  1.6  christos 
   1895  1.6  christos 	num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
   1896  1.6  christos 	for (i = shindex + 1; i < num_sec; i++)
   1897  1.6  christos 	  {
   1898  1.6  christos 	    Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
   1899  1.6  christos 
   1900  1.6  christos 	    if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
   1901  1.6  christos 		&& hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
   1902  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   1903  1.6  christos 	  }
   1904  1.6  christos 
   1905  1.1     skrll 	if (i == num_sec)
   1906  1.1     skrll 	  for (i = 1; i < shindex; i++)
   1907  1.6  christos 	    {
   1908  1.1     skrll 	      Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
   1909  1.1     skrll 
   1910  1.1     skrll 	      if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
   1911  1.1     skrll 		  && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
   1912  1.1     skrll 		break;
   1913  1.6  christos 	    }
   1914  1.6  christos 
   1915  1.6  christos 	if (i != shindex)
   1916  1.6  christos 	  ret = bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i);
   1917  1.6  christos 	/* else FIXME: we have failed to find the symbol table - should we issue an error ? */
   1918  1.6  christos 	goto success;
   1919  1.6  christos       }
   1920  1.1     skrll 
   1921  1.6  christos     case SHT_DYNSYM:		/* A dynamic symbol table.  */
   1922  1.1     skrll       if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == shindex)
   1923  1.1     skrll 	goto success;
   1924  1.6  christos 
   1925  1.6  christos       if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
   1926  1.5  christos 	goto fail;
   1927  1.5  christos 
   1928  1.5  christos       if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
   1929  1.6  christos 	{
   1930  1.6  christos 	  if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
   1931  1.5  christos 	    goto fail;
   1932  1.5  christos 
   1933  1.5  christos 	  /* Some linkers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
   1934  1.5  christos 	     zero sh_size.  ld sees this as a global symbol count
   1935  1.6  christos 	     of (unsigned) -1.  Fix it here.  */
   1936  1.6  christos 	  hdr->sh_info = 0;
   1937  1.6  christos 	  goto success;
   1938  1.6  christos 	}
   1939  1.6  christos 
   1940  1.6  christos       /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one dynamic symbol table.
   1941  1.6  christos 	 Unusual, but possible.  Warn, but continue.  */
   1942  1.6  christos       if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
   1943  1.6  christos 	{
   1944  1.6  christos 	  (*_bfd_error_handler)
   1945  1.6  christos 	    (_("%B: warning: multiple dynamic symbol tables detected - ignoring the table in section %u"),
   1946  1.5  christos 	     abfd, shindex);
   1947  1.1     skrll 	  goto success;
   1948  1.1     skrll 	}
   1949  1.1     skrll       elf_dynsymtab (abfd) = shindex;
   1950  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr = *hdr;
   1951  1.1     skrll       elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
   1952  1.1     skrll       abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
   1953  1.1     skrll 
   1954  1.6  christos       /* Besides being a symbol table, we also treat this as a regular
   1955  1.6  christos 	 section, so that objcopy can handle it.  */
   1956  1.1     skrll       ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
   1957  1.6  christos       goto success;
   1958  1.6  christos 
   1959  1.6  christos     case SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX:	/* Symbol section indices when >64k sections.  */
   1960  1.1     skrll       {
   1961  1.6  christos 	elf_section_list * entry;
   1962  1.6  christos 
   1963  1.6  christos 	for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
   1964  1.6  christos 	  if (entry->ndx == shindex)
   1965  1.6  christos 	    goto success;
   1966  1.6  christos 
   1967  1.6  christos 	entry = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof * entry);
   1968  1.6  christos 	if (entry == NULL)
   1969  1.6  christos 	  goto fail;
   1970  1.6  christos 	entry->ndx = shindex;
   1971  1.6  christos 	entry->hdr = * hdr;
   1972  1.6  christos 	entry->next = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
   1973  1.6  christos 	elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
   1974  1.6  christos 	elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = & entry->hdr;
   1975  1.1     skrll 	goto success;
   1976  1.6  christos       }
   1977  1.1     skrll 
   1978  1.6  christos     case SHT_STRTAB:		/* A string table.  */
   1979  1.6  christos       if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
   1980  1.1     skrll 	goto success;
   1981  1.1     skrll 
   1982  1.1     skrll       if (ehdr->e_shstrndx == shindex)
   1983  1.1     skrll 	{
   1984  1.6  christos 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
   1985  1.1     skrll 	  elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
   1986  1.6  christos 	  goto success;
   1987  1.1     skrll 	}
   1988  1.1     skrll 
   1989  1.1     skrll       if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
   1990  1.1     skrll 	{
   1991  1.1     skrll 	symtab_strtab:
   1992  1.6  christos 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr = *hdr;
   1993  1.1     skrll 	  elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
   1994  1.6  christos 	  goto success;
   1995  1.1     skrll 	}
   1996  1.1     skrll 
   1997  1.1     skrll       if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
   1998  1.1     skrll 	{
   1999  1.1     skrll 	dynsymtab_strtab:
   2000  1.1     skrll 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
   2001  1.1     skrll 	  hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr;
   2002  1.1     skrll 	  elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr;
   2003  1.6  christos 	  /* We also treat this as a regular section, so that objcopy
   2004  1.6  christos 	     can handle it.  */
   2005  1.6  christos 	  ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
   2006  1.1     skrll 						 shindex);
   2007  1.1     skrll 	  goto success;
   2008  1.1     skrll 	}
   2009  1.1     skrll 
   2010  1.1     skrll       /* If the string table isn't one of the above, then treat it as a
   2011  1.1     skrll 	 regular section.  We need to scan all the headers to be sure,
   2012  1.1     skrll 	 just in case this strtab section appeared before the above.  */
   2013  1.1     skrll       if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == 0 || elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
   2014  1.1     skrll 	{
   2015  1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int i, num_sec;
   2016  1.1     skrll 
   2017  1.1     skrll 	  num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
   2018  1.1     skrll 	  for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
   2019  1.1     skrll 	    {
   2020  1.1     skrll 	      Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
   2021  1.1     skrll 	      if (hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
   2022  1.1     skrll 		{
   2023  1.6  christos 		  /* Prevent endless recursion on broken objects.  */
   2024  1.1     skrll 		  if (i == shindex)
   2025  1.6  christos 		    goto fail;
   2026  1.1     skrll 		  if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
   2027  1.1     skrll 		    goto fail;
   2028  1.1     skrll 		  if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == i)
   2029  1.1     skrll 		    goto symtab_strtab;
   2030  1.1     skrll 		  if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == i)
   2031  1.1     skrll 		    goto dynsymtab_strtab;
   2032  1.1     skrll 		}
   2033  1.6  christos 	    }
   2034  1.6  christos 	}
   2035  1.1     skrll       ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
   2036  1.1     skrll       goto success;
   2037  1.1     skrll 
   2038  1.1     skrll     case SHT_REL:
   2039  1.1     skrll     case SHT_RELA:
   2040  1.1     skrll       /* *These* do a lot of work -- but build no sections!  */
   2041  1.3  christos       {
   2042  1.1     skrll 	asection *target_sect;
   2043  1.3  christos 	Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2, **p_hdr;
   2044  1.3  christos 	unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
   2045  1.1     skrll 	struct bfd_elf_section_data *esdt;
   2046  1.1     skrll 	bfd_size_type amt;
   2047  1.1     skrll 
   2048  1.1     skrll 	if (hdr->sh_entsize
   2049  1.6  christos 	    != (bfd_size_type) (hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL
   2050  1.1     skrll 				? bed->s->sizeof_rel : bed->s->sizeof_rela))
   2051  1.1     skrll 	  goto fail;
   2052  1.1     skrll 
   2053  1.1     skrll 	/* Check for a bogus link to avoid crashing.  */
   2054  1.1     skrll 	if (hdr->sh_link >= num_sec)
   2055  1.1     skrll 	  {
   2056  1.1     skrll 	    ((*_bfd_error_handler)
   2057  1.6  christos 	     (_("%B: invalid link %lu for reloc section %s (index %u)"),
   2058  1.6  christos 	      abfd, hdr->sh_link, name, shindex));
   2059  1.6  christos 	    ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
   2060  1.1     skrll 						   shindex);
   2061  1.1     skrll 	    goto success;
   2062  1.1     skrll 	  }
   2063  1.1     skrll 
   2064  1.1     skrll 	/* For some incomprehensible reason Oracle distributes
   2065  1.1     skrll 	   libraries for Solaris in which some of the objects have
   2066  1.1     skrll 	   bogus sh_link fields.  It would be nice if we could just
   2067  1.1     skrll 	   reject them, but, unfortunately, some people need to use
   2068  1.3  christos 	   them.  We scan through the section headers; if we find only
   2069  1.3  christos 	   one suitable symbol table, we clobber the sh_link to point
   2070  1.3  christos 	   to it.  I hope this doesn't break anything.
   2071  1.3  christos 
   2072  1.3  christos 	   Don't do it on executable nor shared library.  */
   2073  1.1     skrll 	if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0
   2074  1.1     skrll 	    && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
   2075  1.1     skrll 	    && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_DYNSYM)
   2076  1.1     skrll 	  {
   2077  1.1     skrll 	    unsigned int scan;
   2078  1.1     skrll 	    int found;
   2079  1.1     skrll 
   2080  1.1     skrll 	    found = 0;
   2081  1.1     skrll 	    for (scan = 1; scan < num_sec; scan++)
   2082  1.1     skrll 	      {
   2083  1.1     skrll 		if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
   2084  1.1     skrll 		    || elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
   2085  1.1     skrll 		  {
   2086  1.1     skrll 		    if (found != 0)
   2087  1.1     skrll 		      {
   2088  1.1     skrll 			found = 0;
   2089  1.1     skrll 			break;
   2090  1.1     skrll 		      }
   2091  1.1     skrll 		    found = scan;
   2092  1.1     skrll 		  }
   2093  1.1     skrll 	      }
   2094  1.1     skrll 	    if (found != 0)
   2095  1.1     skrll 	      hdr->sh_link = found;
   2096  1.1     skrll 	  }
   2097  1.1     skrll 
   2098  1.1     skrll 	/* Get the symbol table.  */
   2099  1.1     skrll 	if ((elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
   2100  1.6  christos 	     || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
   2101  1.1     skrll 	    && ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_link))
   2102  1.1     skrll 	  goto fail;
   2103  1.1     skrll 
   2104  1.1     skrll 	/* If this reloc section does not use the main symbol table we
   2105  1.1     skrll 	   don't treat it as a reloc section.  BFD can't adequately
   2106  1.1     skrll 	   represent such a section, so at least for now, we don't
   2107  1.3  christos 	   try.  We just present it as a normal section.  We also
   2108  1.3  christos 	   can't use it as a reloc section if it points to the null
   2109  1.1     skrll 	   section, an invalid section, another reloc section, or its
   2110  1.3  christos 	   sh_link points to the null section.  */
   2111  1.1     skrll 	if (hdr->sh_link != elf_onesymtab (abfd)
   2112  1.1     skrll 	    || hdr->sh_link == SHN_UNDEF
   2113  1.1     skrll 	    || hdr->sh_info == SHN_UNDEF
   2114  1.1     skrll 	    || hdr->sh_info >= num_sec
   2115  1.6  christos 	    || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_REL
   2116  1.6  christos 	    || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
   2117  1.6  christos 	  {
   2118  1.6  christos 	    ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
   2119  1.6  christos 						   shindex);
   2120  1.1     skrll 	    goto success;
   2121  1.1     skrll 	  }
   2122  1.6  christos 
   2123  1.6  christos 	if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_info))
   2124  1.1     skrll 	  goto fail;
   2125  1.1     skrll 
   2126  1.6  christos 	target_sect = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, hdr->sh_info);
   2127  1.1     skrll 	if (target_sect == NULL)
   2128  1.3  christos 	  goto fail;
   2129  1.3  christos 
   2130  1.3  christos 	esdt = elf_section_data (target_sect);
   2131  1.1     skrll 	if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
   2132  1.3  christos 	  p_hdr = &esdt->rela.hdr;
   2133  1.3  christos 	else
   2134  1.6  christos 	  p_hdr = &esdt->rel.hdr;
   2135  1.6  christos 
   2136  1.6  christos 	/* PR 17512: file: 0b4f81b7.  */
   2137  1.3  christos 	if (*p_hdr != NULL)
   2138  1.3  christos 	  goto fail;
   2139  1.3  christos 	amt = sizeof (*hdr2);
   2140  1.6  christos 	hdr2 = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
   2141  1.1     skrll 	if (hdr2 == NULL)
   2142  1.3  christos 	  goto fail;
   2143  1.1     skrll 	*hdr2 = *hdr;
   2144  1.1     skrll 	*p_hdr = hdr2;
   2145  1.1     skrll 	elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr2;
   2146  1.1     skrll 	target_sect->reloc_count += NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr);
   2147  1.1     skrll 	target_sect->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
   2148  1.1     skrll 	target_sect->relocation = NULL;
   2149  1.1     skrll 	target_sect->rel_filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
   2150  1.1     skrll 	/* In the section to which the relocations apply, mark whether
   2151  1.3  christos 	   its relocations are of the REL or RELA variety.  */
   2152  1.3  christos 	if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
   2153  1.3  christos 	  {
   2154  1.3  christos 	    if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
   2155  1.1     skrll 	      target_sect->use_rela_p = 1;
   2156  1.6  christos 	  }
   2157  1.1     skrll 	abfd->flags |= HAS_RELOC;
   2158  1.1     skrll 	goto success;
   2159  1.1     skrll       }
   2160  1.1     skrll 
   2161  1.1     skrll     case SHT_GNU_verdef:
   2162  1.6  christos       elf_dynverdef (abfd) = shindex;
   2163  1.6  christos       elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr = *hdr;
   2164  1.1     skrll       ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
   2165  1.1     skrll       goto success;
   2166  1.1     skrll 
   2167  1.6  christos     case SHT_GNU_versym:
   2168  1.6  christos       if (hdr->sh_entsize != sizeof (Elf_External_Versym))
   2169  1.1     skrll 	goto fail;
   2170  1.1     skrll 
   2171  1.6  christos       elf_dynversym (abfd) = shindex;
   2172  1.6  christos       elf_tdata (abfd)->dynversym_hdr = *hdr;
   2173  1.1     skrll       ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
   2174  1.1     skrll       goto success;
   2175  1.1     skrll 
   2176  1.1     skrll     case SHT_GNU_verneed:
   2177  1.6  christos       elf_dynverref (abfd) = shindex;
   2178  1.6  christos       elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr = *hdr;
   2179  1.1     skrll       ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
   2180  1.1     skrll       goto success;
   2181  1.6  christos 
   2182  1.1     skrll     case SHT_SHLIB:
   2183  1.1     skrll       goto success;
   2184  1.6  christos 
   2185  1.6  christos     case SHT_GROUP:
   2186  1.6  christos       if (! IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (hdr, GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
   2187  1.1     skrll 	goto fail;
   2188  1.6  christos 
   2189  1.6  christos       if (!_bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
   2190  1.1     skrll 	goto fail;
   2191  1.1     skrll 
   2192  1.1     skrll       if (hdr->contents != NULL)
   2193  1.6  christos 	{
   2194  1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Group *idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) hdr->contents;
   2195  1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int n_elt = hdr->sh_size / sizeof (* idx);
   2196  1.6  christos 	  asection *s;
   2197  1.6  christos 
   2198  1.1     skrll 	  if (n_elt == 0)
   2199  1.1     skrll 	    goto fail;
   2200  1.1     skrll 	  if (idx->flags & GRP_COMDAT)
   2201  1.1     skrll 	    hdr->bfd_section->flags
   2202  1.1     skrll 	      |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
   2203  1.1     skrll 
   2204  1.6  christos 	  /* We try to keep the same section order as it comes in.  */
   2205  1.1     skrll 	  idx += n_elt;
   2206  1.1     skrll 
   2207  1.1     skrll 	  while (--n_elt != 0)
   2208  1.1     skrll 	    {
   2209  1.1     skrll 	      --idx;
   2210  1.1     skrll 
   2211  1.1     skrll 	      if (idx->shdr != NULL
   2212  1.1     skrll 		  && (s = idx->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
   2213  1.1     skrll 		  && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
   2214  1.1     skrll 		{
   2215  1.1     skrll 		  elf_next_in_group (hdr->bfd_section) = s;
   2216  1.1     skrll 		  break;
   2217  1.1     skrll 		}
   2218  1.6  christos 	    }
   2219  1.1     skrll 	}
   2220  1.1     skrll       goto success;
   2221  1.1     skrll 
   2222  1.1     skrll     default:
   2223  1.1     skrll       /* Possibly an attributes section.  */
   2224  1.1     skrll       if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_ATTRIBUTES
   2225  1.1     skrll 	  || hdr->sh_type == bed->obj_attrs_section_type)
   2226  1.6  christos 	{
   2227  1.1     skrll 	  if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
   2228  1.6  christos 	    goto fail;
   2229  1.1     skrll 	  _bfd_elf_parse_attributes (abfd, hdr);
   2230  1.1     skrll 	  goto success;
   2231  1.1     skrll 	}
   2232  1.1     skrll 
   2233  1.6  christos       /* Check for any processor-specific section types.  */
   2234  1.1     skrll       if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
   2235  1.1     skrll 	goto success;
   2236  1.1     skrll 
   2237  1.1     skrll       if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOUSER && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIUSER)
   2238  1.1     skrll 	{
   2239  1.1     skrll 	  if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
   2240  1.1     skrll 	    /* FIXME: How to properly handle allocated section reserved
   2241  1.1     skrll 	       for applications?  */
   2242  1.1     skrll 	    (*_bfd_error_handler)
   2243  1.1     skrll 	      (_("%B: don't know how to handle allocated, application "
   2244  1.1     skrll 		 "specific section `%s' [0x%8x]"),
   2245  1.6  christos 	       abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
   2246  1.6  christos 	  else
   2247  1.6  christos 	    {
   2248  1.6  christos 	      /* Allow sections reserved for applications.  */
   2249  1.6  christos 	      ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
   2250  1.6  christos 						     shindex);
   2251  1.1     skrll 	      goto success;
   2252  1.1     skrll 	    }
   2253  1.1     skrll 	}
   2254  1.1     skrll       else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOPROC
   2255  1.1     skrll 	       && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIPROC)
   2256  1.1     skrll 	/* FIXME: We should handle this section.  */
   2257  1.1     skrll 	(*_bfd_error_handler)
   2258  1.1     skrll 	  (_("%B: don't know how to handle processor specific section "
   2259  1.1     skrll 	     "`%s' [0x%8x]"),
   2260  1.1     skrll 	   abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
   2261  1.1     skrll       else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIOS)
   2262  1.1     skrll 	{
   2263  1.1     skrll 	  /* Unrecognised OS-specific sections.  */
   2264  1.1     skrll 	  if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING) != 0)
   2265  1.1     skrll 	    /* SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING indicates that special knowledge is
   2266  1.1     skrll 	       required to correctly process the section and the file should
   2267  1.1     skrll 	       be rejected with an error message.  */
   2268  1.1     skrll 	    (*_bfd_error_handler)
   2269  1.1     skrll 	      (_("%B: don't know how to handle OS specific section "
   2270  1.1     skrll 		 "`%s' [0x%8x]"),
   2271  1.6  christos 	       abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
   2272  1.6  christos 	  else
   2273  1.6  christos 	    {
   2274  1.6  christos 	      /* Otherwise it should be processed.  */
   2275  1.6  christos 	      ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
   2276  1.1     skrll 	      goto success;
   2277  1.1     skrll 	    }
   2278  1.1     skrll 	}
   2279  1.1     skrll       else
   2280  1.1     skrll 	/* FIXME: We should handle this section.  */
   2281  1.1     skrll 	(*_bfd_error_handler)
   2282  1.1     skrll 	  (_("%B: don't know how to handle section `%s' [0x%8x]"),
   2283  1.6  christos 	   abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
   2284  1.1     skrll 
   2285  1.1     skrll       goto fail;
   2286  1.6  christos     }
   2287  1.6  christos 
   2288  1.6  christos  fail:
   2289  1.6  christos   ret = FALSE;
   2290  1.6  christos  success:
   2291  1.6  christos   if (sections_being_created && sections_being_created_abfd == abfd)
   2292  1.6  christos     sections_being_created [shindex] = FALSE;
   2293  1.6  christos   if (-- nesting == 0)
   2294  1.6  christos     {
   2295  1.6  christos       sections_being_created = NULL;
   2296  1.6  christos       sections_being_created_abfd = abfd;
   2297  1.1     skrll     }
   2298  1.1     skrll   return ret;
   2299  1.3  christos }
   2300  1.1     skrll 
   2301  1.3  christos /* Return the local symbol specified by ABFD, R_SYMNDX.  */
   2302  1.3  christos 
   2303  1.3  christos Elf_Internal_Sym *
   2304  1.3  christos bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (struct sym_cache *cache,
   2305  1.1     skrll 		       bfd *abfd,
   2306  1.1     skrll 		       unsigned long r_symndx)
   2307  1.1     skrll {
   2308  1.1     skrll   unsigned int ent = r_symndx % LOCAL_SYM_CACHE_SIZE;
   2309  1.1     skrll 
   2310  1.1     skrll   if (cache->abfd != abfd || cache->indx[ent] != r_symndx)
   2311  1.1     skrll     {
   2312  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   2313  1.1     skrll       unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
   2314  1.1     skrll       Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
   2315  1.1     skrll 
   2316  1.3  christos       symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
   2317  1.1     skrll       if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr, 1, r_symndx,
   2318  1.1     skrll 				&cache->sym[ent], esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
   2319  1.1     skrll 	return NULL;
   2320  1.1     skrll 
   2321  1.1     skrll       if (cache->abfd != abfd)
   2322  1.1     skrll 	{
   2323  1.1     skrll 	  memset (cache->indx, -1, sizeof (cache->indx));
   2324  1.1     skrll 	  cache->abfd = abfd;
   2325  1.1     skrll 	}
   2326  1.1     skrll       cache->indx[ent] = r_symndx;
   2327  1.3  christos     }
   2328  1.1     skrll 
   2329  1.1     skrll   return &cache->sym[ent];
   2330  1.1     skrll }
   2331  1.1     skrll 
   2332  1.1     skrll /* Given an ELF section number, retrieve the corresponding BFD
   2333  1.1     skrll    section.  */
   2334  1.3  christos 
   2335  1.1     skrll asection *
   2336  1.3  christos bfd_section_from_elf_index (bfd *abfd, unsigned int sec_index)
   2337  1.1     skrll {
   2338  1.3  christos   if (sec_index >= elf_numsections (abfd))
   2339  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
   2340  1.1     skrll   return elf_elfsections (abfd)[sec_index]->bfd_section;
   2341  1.1     skrll }
   2342  1.1     skrll 
   2343  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_b[] =
   2344  1.1     skrll {
   2345  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".bss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS,   SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   2346  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                   0,  0, 0,            0 }
   2347  1.1     skrll };
   2348  1.1     skrll 
   2349  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_c[] =
   2350  1.1     skrll {
   2351  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".comment"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2352  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                       0, 0, 0,            0 }
   2353  1.1     skrll };
   2354  1.1     skrll 
   2355  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_d[] =
   2356  1.1     skrll {
   2357  1.6  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data"),         -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   2358  1.6  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data1"),         0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   2359  1.6  christos   /* There are more DWARF sections than these, but they needn't be added here
   2360  1.1     skrll      unless you have to cope with broken compilers that don't emit section
   2361  1.1     skrll      attributes or you want to help the user writing assembler.  */
   2362  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug"),         0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2363  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_line"),    0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2364  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_info"),    0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2365  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_abbrev"),  0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2366  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2367  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynamic"),       0, SHT_DYNAMIC,  SHF_ALLOC },
   2368  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynstr"),        0, SHT_STRTAB,   SHF_ALLOC },
   2369  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynsym"),        0, SHT_DYNSYM,   SHF_ALLOC },
   2370  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                      0,        0, 0,            0 }
   2371  1.1     skrll };
   2372  1.1     skrll 
   2373  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_f[] =
   2374  1.1     skrll {
   2375  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini"),       0, SHT_PROGBITS,   SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
   2376  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini_array"), 0, SHT_FINI_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   2377  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                          0, 0, 0,              0 }
   2378  1.1     skrll };
   2379  1.1     skrll 
   2380  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_g[] =
   2381  1.3  christos {
   2382  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.b"), -2, SHT_NOBITS,      SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   2383  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.lto_"),       -1, SHT_PROGBITS,    SHF_EXCLUDE },
   2384  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".got"),             0, SHT_PROGBITS,    SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   2385  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version"),     0, SHT_GNU_versym,  0 },
   2386  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_d"),   0, SHT_GNU_verdef,  0 },
   2387  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_r"),   0, SHT_GNU_verneed, 0 },
   2388  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.liblist"),     0, SHT_GNU_LIBLIST, SHF_ALLOC },
   2389  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.conflict"),    0, SHT_RELA,        SHF_ALLOC },
   2390  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.hash"),        0, SHT_GNU_HASH,    SHF_ALLOC },
   2391  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                        0,        0, 0,               0 }
   2392  1.1     skrll };
   2393  1.1     skrll 
   2394  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_h[] =
   2395  1.1     skrll {
   2396  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".hash"), 0, SHT_HASH,     SHF_ALLOC },
   2397  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                    0, 0, 0,            0 }
   2398  1.1     skrll };
   2399  1.1     skrll 
   2400  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_i[] =
   2401  1.1     skrll {
   2402  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init"),       0, SHT_PROGBITS,   SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
   2403  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init_array"), 0, SHT_INIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   2404  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".interp"),     0, SHT_PROGBITS,   0 },
   2405  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                      0,     0, 0,              0 }
   2406  1.1     skrll };
   2407  1.1     skrll 
   2408  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_l[] =
   2409  1.1     skrll {
   2410  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2411  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                    0, 0, 0,            0 }
   2412  1.1     skrll };
   2413  1.1     skrll 
   2414  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_n[] =
   2415  1.1     skrll {
   2416  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note.GNU-stack"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2417  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note"),          -1, SHT_NOTE,     0 },
   2418  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                    0,           0, 0,            0 }
   2419  1.1     skrll };
   2420  1.1     skrll 
   2421  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_p[] =
   2422  1.1     skrll {
   2423  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".preinit_array"), 0, SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   2424  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"),           0, SHT_PROGBITS,      SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
   2425  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                   0,           0, 0,                 0 }
   2426  1.1     skrll };
   2427  1.1     skrll 
   2428  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_r[] =
   2429  1.1     skrll {
   2430  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
   2431  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
   2432  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rela"),   -1, SHT_RELA,     0 },
   2433  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rel"),    -1, SHT_REL,      0 },
   2434  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                   0,     0, 0,            0 }
   2435  1.1     skrll };
   2436  1.1     skrll 
   2437  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_s[] =
   2438  1.1     skrll {
   2439  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".shstrtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
   2440  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".strtab"),   0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
   2441  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".symtab"),   0, SHT_SYMTAB, 0 },
   2442  1.1     skrll   /* See struct bfd_elf_special_section declaration for the semantics of
   2443  1.1     skrll      this special case where .prefix_length != strlen (.prefix).  */
   2444  1.1     skrll   { ".stabstr",			5,  3, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
   2445  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                       0,  0, 0,          0 }
   2446  1.1     skrll };
   2447  1.1     skrll 
   2448  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_t[] =
   2449  1.1     skrll {
   2450  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".text"),  -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
   2451  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tbss"),  -2, SHT_NOBITS,   SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
   2452  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
   2453  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                     0,  0, 0,            0 }
   2454  1.1     skrll };
   2455  1.1     skrll 
   2456  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_z[] =
   2457  1.1     skrll {
   2458  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_line"),    0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2459  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_info"),    0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2460  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_abbrev"),  0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2461  1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2462  1.1     skrll   { NULL,                     0,  0, 0,            0 }
   2463  1.5  christos };
   2464  1.1     skrll 
   2465  1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section * const special_sections[] =
   2466  1.1     skrll {
   2467  1.1     skrll   special_sections_b,		/* 'b' */
   2468  1.1     skrll   special_sections_c,		/* 'c' */
   2469  1.1     skrll   special_sections_d,		/* 'd' */
   2470  1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'e' */
   2471  1.1     skrll   special_sections_f,		/* 'f' */
   2472  1.1     skrll   special_sections_g,		/* 'g' */
   2473  1.1     skrll   special_sections_h,		/* 'h' */
   2474  1.1     skrll   special_sections_i,		/* 'i' */
   2475  1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'j' */
   2476  1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'k' */
   2477  1.1     skrll   special_sections_l,		/* 'l' */
   2478  1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'm' */
   2479  1.1     skrll   special_sections_n,		/* 'n' */
   2480  1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'o' */
   2481  1.1     skrll   special_sections_p,		/* 'p' */
   2482  1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'q' */
   2483  1.1     skrll   special_sections_r,		/* 'r' */
   2484  1.1     skrll   special_sections_s,		/* 's' */
   2485  1.1     skrll   special_sections_t,		/* 't' */
   2486  1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'u' */
   2487  1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'v' */
   2488  1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'w' */
   2489  1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'x' */
   2490  1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'y' */
   2491  1.1     skrll   special_sections_z		/* 'z' */
   2492  1.1     skrll };
   2493  1.1     skrll 
   2494  1.1     skrll const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
   2495  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_get_special_section (const char *name,
   2496  1.1     skrll 			      const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec,
   2497  1.1     skrll 			      unsigned int rela)
   2498  1.1     skrll {
   2499  1.1     skrll   int i;
   2500  1.1     skrll   int len;
   2501  1.1     skrll 
   2502  1.1     skrll   len = strlen (name);
   2503  1.1     skrll 
   2504  1.1     skrll   for (i = 0; spec[i].prefix != NULL; i++)
   2505  1.1     skrll     {
   2506  1.1     skrll       int suffix_len;
   2507  1.1     skrll       int prefix_len = spec[i].prefix_length;
   2508  1.1     skrll 
   2509  1.1     skrll       if (len < prefix_len)
   2510  1.1     skrll 	continue;
   2511  1.1     skrll       if (memcmp (name, spec[i].prefix, prefix_len) != 0)
   2512  1.1     skrll 	continue;
   2513  1.1     skrll 
   2514  1.1     skrll       suffix_len = spec[i].suffix_length;
   2515  1.1     skrll       if (suffix_len <= 0)
   2516  1.1     skrll 	{
   2517  1.1     skrll 	  if (name[prefix_len] != 0)
   2518  1.1     skrll 	    {
   2519  1.1     skrll 	      if (suffix_len == 0)
   2520  1.1     skrll 		continue;
   2521  1.1     skrll 	      if (name[prefix_len] != '.'
   2522  1.1     skrll 		  && (suffix_len == -2
   2523  1.1     skrll 		      || (rela && spec[i].type == SHT_REL)))
   2524  1.1     skrll 		continue;
   2525  1.1     skrll 	    }
   2526  1.1     skrll 	}
   2527  1.1     skrll       else
   2528  1.1     skrll 	{
   2529  1.1     skrll 	  if (len < prefix_len + suffix_len)
   2530  1.1     skrll 	    continue;
   2531  1.1     skrll 	  if (memcmp (name + len - suffix_len,
   2532  1.1     skrll 		      spec[i].prefix + prefix_len,
   2533  1.1     skrll 		      suffix_len) != 0)
   2534  1.1     skrll 	    continue;
   2535  1.1     skrll 	}
   2536  1.1     skrll       return &spec[i];
   2537  1.1     skrll     }
   2538  1.1     skrll 
   2539  1.1     skrll   return NULL;
   2540  1.1     skrll }
   2541  1.1     skrll 
   2542  1.1     skrll const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
   2543  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
   2544  1.1     skrll {
   2545  1.1     skrll   int i;
   2546  1.1     skrll   const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec;
   2547  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   2548  1.1     skrll 
   2549  1.1     skrll   /* See if this is one of the special sections.  */
   2550  1.1     skrll   if (sec->name == NULL)
   2551  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
   2552  1.1     skrll 
   2553  1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   2554  1.1     skrll   spec = bed->special_sections;
   2555  1.1     skrll   if (spec)
   2556  1.1     skrll     {
   2557  1.1     skrll       spec = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name,
   2558  1.1     skrll 					   bed->special_sections,
   2559  1.1     skrll 					   sec->use_rela_p);
   2560  1.1     skrll       if (spec != NULL)
   2561  1.1     skrll 	return spec;
   2562  1.1     skrll     }
   2563  1.1     skrll 
   2564  1.1     skrll   if (sec->name[0] != '.')
   2565  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
   2566  1.1     skrll 
   2567  1.1     skrll   i = sec->name[1] - 'b';
   2568  1.1     skrll   if (i < 0 || i > 'z' - 'b')
   2569  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
   2570  1.1     skrll 
   2571  1.1     skrll   spec = special_sections[i];
   2572  1.1     skrll 
   2573  1.1     skrll   if (spec == NULL)
   2574  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
   2575  1.1     skrll 
   2576  1.1     skrll   return _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, spec, sec->use_rela_p);
   2577  1.1     skrll }
   2578  1.1     skrll 
   2579  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   2580  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
   2581  1.1     skrll {
   2582  1.1     skrll   struct bfd_elf_section_data *sdata;
   2583  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   2584  1.1     skrll   const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
   2585  1.1     skrll 
   2586  1.1     skrll   sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) sec->used_by_bfd;
   2587  1.3  christos   if (sdata == NULL)
   2588  1.3  christos     {
   2589  1.1     skrll       sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
   2590  1.1     skrll                                                           sizeof (*sdata));
   2591  1.1     skrll       if (sdata == NULL)
   2592  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   2593  1.1     skrll       sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
   2594  1.1     skrll     }
   2595  1.1     skrll 
   2596  1.1     skrll   /* Indicate whether or not this section should use RELA relocations.  */
   2597  1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   2598  1.1     skrll   sec->use_rela_p = bed->default_use_rela_p;
   2599  1.1     skrll 
   2600  1.1     skrll   /* When we read a file, we don't need to set ELF section type and
   2601  1.1     skrll      flags.  They will be overridden in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr
   2602  1.1     skrll      anyway.  We will set ELF section type and flags for all linker
   2603  1.5  christos      created sections.  If user specifies BFD section flags, we will
   2604  1.5  christos      set ELF section type and flags based on BFD section flags in
   2605  1.5  christos      elf_fake_sections.  Special handling for .init_array/.fini_array
   2606  1.5  christos      output sections since they may contain .ctors/.dtors input
   2607  1.5  christos      sections.  We don't want _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data to
   2608  1.1     skrll      copy ELF section type from .ctors/.dtors input sections.  */
   2609  1.1     skrll   if (abfd->direction != read_direction
   2610  1.1     skrll       || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
   2611  1.5  christos     {
   2612  1.5  christos       ssect = (*bed->get_sec_type_attr) (abfd, sec);
   2613  1.5  christos       if (ssect != NULL
   2614  1.5  christos 	  && (!sec->flags
   2615  1.5  christos 	      || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
   2616  1.1     skrll 	      || ssect->type == SHT_INIT_ARRAY
   2617  1.1     skrll 	      || ssect->type == SHT_FINI_ARRAY))
   2618  1.1     skrll 	{
   2619  1.1     skrll 	  elf_section_type (sec) = ssect->type;
   2620  1.1     skrll 	  elf_section_flags (sec) = ssect->attr;
   2621  1.1     skrll 	}
   2622  1.1     skrll     }
   2623  1.1     skrll 
   2624  1.1     skrll   return _bfd_generic_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
   2625  1.1     skrll }
   2626  1.1     skrll 
   2627  1.1     skrll /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF program header.
   2628  1.1     skrll 
   2629  1.1     skrll    Since program segments have no names, we generate a synthetic name
   2630  1.1     skrll    of the form segment<NUM>, where NUM is generally the index in the
   2631  1.1     skrll    program header table.  For segments that are split (see below) we
   2632  1.1     skrll    generate the names segment<NUM>a and segment<NUM>b.
   2633  1.1     skrll 
   2634  1.1     skrll    Note that some program segments may have a file size that is different than
   2635  1.1     skrll    (less than) the memory size.  All this means is that at execution the
   2636  1.1     skrll    system must allocate the amount of memory specified by the memory size,
   2637  1.1     skrll    but only initialize it with the first "file size" bytes read from the
   2638  1.1     skrll    file.  This would occur for example, with program segments consisting
   2639  1.1     skrll    of combined data+bss.
   2640  1.1     skrll 
   2641  1.1     skrll    To handle the above situation, this routine generates TWO bfd sections
   2642  1.1     skrll    for the single program segment.  The first has the length specified by
   2643  1.1     skrll    the file size of the segment, and the second has the length specified
   2644  1.1     skrll    by the difference between the two sizes.  In effect, the segment is split
   2645  1.1     skrll    into its initialized and uninitialized parts.
   2646  1.1     skrll 
   2647  1.1     skrll  */
   2648  1.1     skrll 
   2649  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   2650  1.3  christos _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd,
   2651  1.3  christos 				 Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr,
   2652  1.1     skrll 				 int hdr_index,
   2653  1.1     skrll 				 const char *type_name)
   2654  1.1     skrll {
   2655  1.1     skrll   asection *newsect;
   2656  1.1     skrll   char *name;
   2657  1.1     skrll   char namebuf[64];
   2658  1.1     skrll   size_t len;
   2659  1.1     skrll   int split;
   2660  1.1     skrll 
   2661  1.1     skrll   split = ((hdr->p_memsz > 0)
   2662  1.1     skrll 	    && (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
   2663  1.1     skrll 	    && (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz));
   2664  1.1     skrll 
   2665  1.3  christos   if (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
   2666  1.1     skrll     {
   2667  1.3  christos       sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "a" : "");
   2668  1.1     skrll       len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
   2669  1.1     skrll       name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
   2670  1.1     skrll       if (!name)
   2671  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   2672  1.1     skrll       memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
   2673  1.1     skrll       newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
   2674  1.1     skrll       if (newsect == NULL)
   2675  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   2676  1.1     skrll       newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr;
   2677  1.1     skrll       newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr;
   2678  1.1     skrll       newsect->size = hdr->p_filesz;
   2679  1.1     skrll       newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset;
   2680  1.1     skrll       newsect->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
   2681  1.1     skrll       newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (hdr->p_align);
   2682  1.1     skrll       if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
   2683  1.1     skrll 	{
   2684  1.1     skrll 	  newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
   2685  1.1     skrll 	  newsect->flags |= SEC_LOAD;
   2686  1.1     skrll 	  if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
   2687  1.1     skrll 	    {
   2688  1.1     skrll 	      /* FIXME: all we known is that it has execute PERMISSION,
   2689  1.1     skrll 		 may be data.  */
   2690  1.1     skrll 	      newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
   2691  1.1     skrll 	    }
   2692  1.1     skrll 	}
   2693  1.1     skrll       if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
   2694  1.1     skrll 	{
   2695  1.1     skrll 	  newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
   2696  1.1     skrll 	}
   2697  1.1     skrll     }
   2698  1.1     skrll 
   2699  1.1     skrll   if (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz)
   2700  1.1     skrll     {
   2701  1.3  christos       bfd_vma align;
   2702  1.1     skrll 
   2703  1.3  christos       sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "b" : "");
   2704  1.1     skrll       len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
   2705  1.1     skrll       name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
   2706  1.1     skrll       if (!name)
   2707  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   2708  1.1     skrll       memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
   2709  1.1     skrll       newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
   2710  1.1     skrll       if (newsect == NULL)
   2711  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   2712  1.1     skrll       newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr + hdr->p_filesz;
   2713  1.1     skrll       newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr + hdr->p_filesz;
   2714  1.1     skrll       newsect->size = hdr->p_memsz - hdr->p_filesz;
   2715  1.1     skrll       newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset + hdr->p_filesz;
   2716  1.1     skrll       align = newsect->vma & -newsect->vma;
   2717  1.1     skrll       if (align == 0 || align > hdr->p_align)
   2718  1.1     skrll 	align = hdr->p_align;
   2719  1.1     skrll       newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (align);
   2720  1.1     skrll       if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
   2721  1.1     skrll 	{
   2722  1.1     skrll 	  /* Hack for gdb.  Segments that have not been modified do
   2723  1.1     skrll 	     not have their contents written to a core file, on the
   2724  1.1     skrll 	     assumption that a debugger can find the contents in the
   2725  1.1     skrll 	     executable.  We flag this case by setting the fake
   2726  1.1     skrll 	     section size to zero.  Note that "real" bss sections will
   2727  1.1     skrll 	     always have their contents dumped to the core file.  */
   2728  1.1     skrll 	  if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
   2729  1.1     skrll 	    newsect->size = 0;
   2730  1.1     skrll 	  newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
   2731  1.1     skrll 	  if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
   2732  1.1     skrll 	    newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
   2733  1.1     skrll 	}
   2734  1.1     skrll       if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
   2735  1.1     skrll 	newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
   2736  1.1     skrll     }
   2737  1.1     skrll 
   2738  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   2739  1.1     skrll }
   2740  1.3  christos 
   2741  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   2742  1.1     skrll bfd_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr, int hdr_index)
   2743  1.1     skrll {
   2744  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   2745  1.1     skrll 
   2746  1.1     skrll   switch (hdr->p_type)
   2747  1.3  christos     {
   2748  1.1     skrll     case PT_NULL:
   2749  1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "null");
   2750  1.3  christos 
   2751  1.1     skrll     case PT_LOAD:
   2752  1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "load");
   2753  1.3  christos 
   2754  1.1     skrll     case PT_DYNAMIC:
   2755  1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "dynamic");
   2756  1.3  christos 
   2757  1.1     skrll     case PT_INTERP:
   2758  1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "interp");
   2759  1.3  christos 
   2760  1.1     skrll     case PT_NOTE:
   2761  1.1     skrll       if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "note"))
   2762  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   2763  1.1     skrll       if (! elf_read_notes (abfd, hdr->p_offset, hdr->p_filesz))
   2764  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   2765  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   2766  1.3  christos 
   2767  1.1     skrll     case PT_SHLIB:
   2768  1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "shlib");
   2769  1.3  christos 
   2770  1.1     skrll     case PT_PHDR:
   2771  1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "phdr");
   2772  1.3  christos 
   2773  1.1     skrll     case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME:
   2774  1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index,
   2775  1.1     skrll 					      "eh_frame_hdr");
   2776  1.3  christos 
   2777  1.1     skrll     case PT_GNU_STACK:
   2778  1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "stack");
   2779  1.3  christos 
   2780  1.1     skrll     case PT_GNU_RELRO:
   2781  1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "relro");
   2782  1.1     skrll 
   2783  1.1     skrll     default:
   2784  1.3  christos       /* Check for any processor-specific program segment types.  */
   2785  1.1     skrll       bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   2786  1.1     skrll       return bed->elf_backend_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "proc");
   2787  1.1     skrll     }
   2788  1.3  christos }
   2789  1.3  christos 
   2790  1.3  christos /* Return the REL_HDR for SEC, assuming there is only a single one, either
   2791  1.3  christos    REL or RELA.  */
   2792  1.3  christos 
   2793  1.3  christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *
   2794  1.3  christos _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (asection *sec)
   2795  1.3  christos {
   2796  1.3  christos   if (elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr)
   2797  1.3  christos     {
   2798  1.3  christos       BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr == NULL);
   2799  1.3  christos       return elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr;
   2800  1.3  christos     }
   2801  1.3  christos   else
   2802  1.3  christos     return elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr;
   2803  1.6  christos }
   2804  1.6  christos 
   2805  1.6  christos static bfd_boolean
   2806  1.6  christos _bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (bfd *abfd,
   2807  1.6  christos 			    Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr,
   2808  1.6  christos 			    const char *sec_name,
   2809  1.6  christos 			    bfd_boolean use_rela_p)
   2810  1.6  christos {
   2811  1.6  christos   char *name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd,
   2812  1.6  christos 				   sizeof ".rela" + strlen (sec_name));
   2813  1.6  christos   if (name == NULL)
   2814  1.6  christos     return FALSE;
   2815  1.6  christos 
   2816  1.6  christos   sprintf (name, "%s%s", use_rela_p ? ".rela" : ".rel", sec_name);
   2817  1.6  christos   rel_hdr->sh_name =
   2818  1.6  christos     (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd), name,
   2819  1.6  christos 					FALSE);
   2820  1.6  christos   if (rel_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
   2821  1.6  christos     return FALSE;
   2822  1.6  christos 
   2823  1.6  christos   return TRUE;
   2824  1.3  christos }
   2825  1.3  christos 
   2826  1.3  christos /* Allocate and initialize a section-header for a new reloc section,
   2827  1.3  christos    containing relocations against ASECT.  It is stored in RELDATA.  If
   2828  1.1     skrll    USE_RELA_P is TRUE, we use RELA relocations; otherwise, we use REL
   2829  1.6  christos    relocations.  */
   2830  1.1     skrll 
   2831  1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   2832  1.6  christos _bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (bfd *abfd,
   2833  1.6  christos 			  struct bfd_elf_section_reloc_data *reldata,
   2834  1.6  christos 			  const char *sec_name,
   2835  1.1     skrll 			  bfd_boolean use_rela_p,
   2836  1.3  christos 			  bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p)
   2837  1.1     skrll {
   2838  1.3  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
   2839  1.3  christos   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   2840  1.3  christos   bfd_size_type amt;
   2841  1.3  christos 
   2842  1.3  christos   amt = sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr);
   2843  1.3  christos   BFD_ASSERT (reldata->hdr == NULL);
   2844  1.1     skrll   rel_hdr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   2845  1.6  christos   reldata->hdr = rel_hdr;
   2846  1.6  christos 
   2847  1.6  christos   if (delay_st_name_p)
   2848  1.6  christos     rel_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
   2849  1.1     skrll   else if (!_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd, rel_hdr, sec_name,
   2850  1.1     skrll 					use_rela_p))
   2851  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   2852  1.1     skrll   rel_hdr->sh_type = use_rela_p ? SHT_RELA : SHT_REL;
   2853  1.1     skrll   rel_hdr->sh_entsize = (use_rela_p
   2854  1.1     skrll 			 ? bed->s->sizeof_rela
   2855  1.1     skrll 			 : bed->s->sizeof_rel);
   2856  1.1     skrll   rel_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
   2857  1.1     skrll   rel_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
   2858  1.1     skrll   rel_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
   2859  1.1     skrll   rel_hdr->sh_size = 0;
   2860  1.1     skrll   rel_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
   2861  1.1     skrll 
   2862  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   2863  1.3  christos }
   2864  1.3  christos 
   2865  1.3  christos /* Return the default section type based on the passed in section flags.  */
   2866  1.3  christos 
   2867  1.3  christos int
   2868  1.3  christos bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (flagword flags)
   2869  1.3  christos {
   2870  1.3  christos   if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
   2871  1.3  christos       && (flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
   2872  1.3  christos     return SHT_NOBITS;
   2873  1.3  christos   return SHT_PROGBITS;
   2874  1.3  christos }
   2875  1.3  christos 
   2876  1.3  christos struct fake_section_arg
   2877  1.3  christos {
   2878  1.3  christos   struct bfd_link_info *link_info;
   2879  1.3  christos   bfd_boolean failed;
   2880  1.1     skrll };
   2881  1.1     skrll 
   2882  1.1     skrll /* Set up an ELF internal section header for a section.  */
   2883  1.3  christos 
   2884  1.1     skrll static void
   2885  1.3  christos elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, asection *asect, void *fsarg)
   2886  1.1     skrll {
   2887  1.3  christos   struct fake_section_arg *arg = (struct fake_section_arg *)fsarg;
   2888  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   2889  1.1     skrll   struct bfd_elf_section_data *esd = elf_section_data (asect);
   2890  1.6  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
   2891  1.6  christos   unsigned int sh_type;
   2892  1.1     skrll   const char *name = asect->name;
   2893  1.3  christos   bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p = FALSE;
   2894  1.1     skrll 
   2895  1.1     skrll   if (arg->failed)
   2896  1.1     skrll     {
   2897  1.1     skrll       /* We already failed; just get out of the bfd_map_over_sections
   2898  1.1     skrll 	 loop.  */
   2899  1.1     skrll       return;
   2900  1.3  christos     }
   2901  1.1     skrll 
   2902  1.6  christos   this_hdr = &esd->this_hdr;
   2903  1.6  christos 
   2904  1.6  christos   if (arg->link_info)
   2905  1.6  christos     {
   2906  1.6  christos       /* ld: compress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_*.  */
   2907  1.6  christos       if ((arg->link_info->compress_debug & COMPRESS_DEBUG)
   2908  1.6  christos 	  && (asect->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
   2909  1.6  christos 	  && name[1] == 'd'
   2910  1.6  christos 	  && name[6] == '_')
   2911  1.6  christos 	{
   2912  1.6  christos 	  /* Set SEC_ELF_COMPRESS to indicate this section should be
   2913  1.6  christos 	     compressed.  */
   2914  1.6  christos 	  asect->flags |= SEC_ELF_COMPRESS;
   2915  1.6  christos 
   2916  1.6  christos 	  /* If this section will be compressed, delay adding setion
   2917  1.6  christos 	     name to section name section after it is compressed in
   2918  1.6  christos 	     _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load.  */
   2919  1.6  christos 	  delay_st_name_p = TRUE;
   2920  1.6  christos 	}
   2921  1.6  christos     }
   2922  1.6  christos   else if ((asect->flags & SEC_ELF_RENAME))
   2923  1.6  christos     {
   2924  1.6  christos       /* objcopy: rename output DWARF debug section.  */
   2925  1.6  christos       if ((abfd->flags & (BFD_DECOMPRESS | BFD_COMPRESS_GABI)))
   2926  1.6  christos 	{
   2927  1.6  christos 	  /* When we decompress or compress with SHF_COMPRESSED,
   2928  1.6  christos 	     convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* if
   2929  1.6  christos 	     needed.  */
   2930  1.6  christos 	  if (name[1] == 'z')
   2931  1.6  christos 	    {
   2932  1.6  christos 	      char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
   2933  1.6  christos 	      if (new_name == NULL)
   2934  1.6  christos 		{
   2935  1.6  christos 		  arg->failed = TRUE;
   2936  1.6  christos 		  return;
   2937  1.6  christos 		}
   2938  1.6  christos 	      name = new_name;
   2939  1.6  christos 	    }
   2940  1.6  christos 	}
   2941  1.6  christos       else if (asect->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE)
   2942  1.6  christos 	{
   2943  1.6  christos 	  /* PR binutils/18087: Compression does not always make a
   2944  1.6  christos 	     section smaller.  So only rename the section when
   2945  1.6  christos 	     compression has actually taken place.  If input section
   2946  1.6  christos 	     name is .zdebug_*, we should never compress it again.  */
   2947  1.6  christos 	  char *new_name = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
   2948  1.6  christos 	  if (new_name == NULL)
   2949  1.6  christos 	    {
   2950  1.6  christos 	      arg->failed = TRUE;
   2951  1.6  christos 	      return;
   2952  1.6  christos 	    }
   2953  1.6  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (name[1] != 'z');
   2954  1.6  christos 	  name = new_name;
   2955  1.6  christos 	}
   2956  1.6  christos     }
   2957  1.6  christos 
   2958  1.6  christos   if (delay_st_name_p)
   2959  1.1     skrll     this_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
   2960  1.6  christos   else
   2961  1.6  christos     {
   2962  1.6  christos       this_hdr->sh_name
   2963  1.6  christos 	= (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
   2964  1.6  christos 					      name, FALSE);
   2965  1.6  christos       if (this_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
   2966  1.6  christos 	{
   2967  1.6  christos 	  arg->failed = TRUE;
   2968  1.1     skrll 	  return;
   2969  1.1     skrll 	}
   2970  1.1     skrll     }
   2971  1.1     skrll 
   2972  1.1     skrll   /* Don't clear sh_flags. Assembler may set additional bits.  */
   2973  1.1     skrll 
   2974  1.1     skrll   if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
   2975  1.1     skrll       || asect->user_set_vma)
   2976  1.1     skrll     this_hdr->sh_addr = asect->vma;
   2977  1.1     skrll   else
   2978  1.1     skrll     this_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
   2979  1.1     skrll 
   2980  1.1     skrll   this_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
   2981  1.6  christos   this_hdr->sh_size = asect->size;
   2982  1.6  christos   this_hdr->sh_link = 0;
   2983  1.6  christos   /* PR 17512: file: 0eb809fe, 8b0535ee.  */
   2984  1.6  christos   if (asect->alignment_power >= (sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 1)
   2985  1.6  christos     {
   2986  1.6  christos       (*_bfd_error_handler)
   2987  1.6  christos 	(_("%B: error: Alignment power %d of section `%A' is too big"),
   2988  1.6  christos 	 abfd, asect, asect->alignment_power);
   2989  1.6  christos       arg->failed = TRUE;
   2990  1.1     skrll       return;
   2991  1.1     skrll     }
   2992  1.1     skrll   this_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << asect->alignment_power;
   2993  1.1     skrll   /* The sh_entsize and sh_info fields may have been set already by
   2994  1.1     skrll      copy_private_section_data.  */
   2995  1.1     skrll 
   2996  1.1     skrll   this_hdr->bfd_section = asect;
   2997  1.1     skrll   this_hdr->contents = NULL;
   2998  1.1     skrll 
   2999  1.1     skrll   /* If the section type is unspecified, we set it based on
   3000  1.1     skrll      asect->flags.  */
   3001  1.1     skrll   if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) != 0)
   3002  1.3  christos     sh_type = SHT_GROUP;
   3003  1.1     skrll   else
   3004  1.1     skrll     sh_type = bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (asect->flags);
   3005  1.1     skrll 
   3006  1.1     skrll   if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NULL)
   3007  1.1     skrll     this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
   3008  1.1     skrll   else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
   3009  1.1     skrll 	   && sh_type == SHT_PROGBITS
   3010  1.1     skrll 	   && (asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
   3011  1.1     skrll     {
   3012  1.1     skrll       /* Warn if we are changing a NOBITS section to PROGBITS, but
   3013  1.1     skrll 	 allow the link to proceed.  This can happen when users link
   3014  1.1     skrll 	 non-bss input sections to bss output sections, or emit data
   3015  1.1     skrll 	 to a bss output section via a linker script.  */
   3016  1.1     skrll       (*_bfd_error_handler)
   3017  1.1     skrll 	(_("warning: section `%A' type changed to PROGBITS"), asect);
   3018  1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
   3019  1.1     skrll     }
   3020  1.1     skrll 
   3021  1.1     skrll   switch (this_hdr->sh_type)
   3022  1.1     skrll     {
   3023  1.1     skrll     default:
   3024  1.1     skrll       break;
   3025  1.1     skrll 
   3026  1.1     skrll     case SHT_STRTAB:
   3027  1.1     skrll     case SHT_INIT_ARRAY:
   3028  1.1     skrll     case SHT_FINI_ARRAY:
   3029  1.1     skrll     case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY:
   3030  1.1     skrll     case SHT_NOTE:
   3031  1.1     skrll     case SHT_NOBITS:
   3032  1.1     skrll     case SHT_PROGBITS:
   3033  1.1     skrll       break;
   3034  1.1     skrll 
   3035  1.1     skrll     case SHT_HASH:
   3036  1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_hash_entry;
   3037  1.1     skrll       break;
   3038  1.1     skrll 
   3039  1.1     skrll     case SHT_DYNSYM:
   3040  1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
   3041  1.1     skrll       break;
   3042  1.1     skrll 
   3043  1.1     skrll     case SHT_DYNAMIC:
   3044  1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_dyn;
   3045  1.1     skrll       break;
   3046  1.1     skrll 
   3047  1.1     skrll     case SHT_RELA:
   3048  1.1     skrll       if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rela_p)
   3049  1.1     skrll 	this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rela;
   3050  1.1     skrll       break;
   3051  1.1     skrll 
   3052  1.1     skrll      case SHT_REL:
   3053  1.1     skrll       if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rel_p)
   3054  1.1     skrll 	this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rel;
   3055  1.1     skrll       break;
   3056  1.1     skrll 
   3057  1.1     skrll      case SHT_GNU_versym:
   3058  1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Versym);
   3059  1.1     skrll       break;
   3060  1.1     skrll 
   3061  1.1     skrll      case SHT_GNU_verdef:
   3062  1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
   3063  1.1     skrll       /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
   3064  1.1     skrll 	 cverdefs.  The linker will set cverdefs, but sh_info will be
   3065  1.1     skrll 	 zero.  */
   3066  1.1     skrll       if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
   3067  1.1     skrll 	this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs;
   3068  1.1     skrll       else
   3069  1.1     skrll 	BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs == 0
   3070  1.1     skrll 		    || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs);
   3071  1.1     skrll       break;
   3072  1.1     skrll 
   3073  1.1     skrll     case SHT_GNU_verneed:
   3074  1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
   3075  1.1     skrll       /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
   3076  1.1     skrll 	 cverrefs.  The linker will set cverrefs, but sh_info will be
   3077  1.1     skrll 	 zero.  */
   3078  1.1     skrll       if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
   3079  1.1     skrll 	this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs;
   3080  1.1     skrll       else
   3081  1.1     skrll 	BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs == 0
   3082  1.1     skrll 		    || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs);
   3083  1.1     skrll       break;
   3084  1.1     skrll 
   3085  1.1     skrll     case SHT_GROUP:
   3086  1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_entsize = GRP_ENTRY_SIZE;
   3087  1.1     skrll       break;
   3088  1.1     skrll 
   3089  1.1     skrll     case SHT_GNU_HASH:
   3090  1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size == 64 ? 0 : 4;
   3091  1.1     skrll       break;
   3092  1.1     skrll     }
   3093  1.1     skrll 
   3094  1.1     skrll   if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
   3095  1.1     skrll     this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
   3096  1.1     skrll   if ((asect->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
   3097  1.1     skrll     this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_WRITE;
   3098  1.1     skrll   if ((asect->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
   3099  1.1     skrll     this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXECINSTR;
   3100  1.1     skrll   if ((asect->flags & SEC_MERGE) != 0)
   3101  1.1     skrll     {
   3102  1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MERGE;
   3103  1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_entsize = asect->entsize;
   3104  1.1     skrll       if ((asect->flags & SEC_STRINGS) != 0)
   3105  1.1     skrll 	this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_STRINGS;
   3106  1.1     skrll     }
   3107  1.1     skrll   if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) == 0 && elf_group_name (asect) != NULL)
   3108  1.1     skrll     this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
   3109  1.1     skrll   if ((asect->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
   3110  1.1     skrll     {
   3111  1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_TLS;
   3112  1.1     skrll       if (asect->size == 0
   3113  1.1     skrll 	  && (asect->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
   3114  1.1     skrll 	{
   3115  1.1     skrll 	  struct bfd_link_order *o = asect->map_tail.link_order;
   3116  1.1     skrll 
   3117  1.1     skrll 	  this_hdr->sh_size = 0;
   3118  1.1     skrll 	  if (o != NULL)
   3119  1.1     skrll 	    {
   3120  1.1     skrll 	      this_hdr->sh_size = o->offset + o->size;
   3121  1.1     skrll 	      if (this_hdr->sh_size != 0)
   3122  1.1     skrll 		this_hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
   3123  1.1     skrll 	    }
   3124  1.3  christos 	}
   3125  1.3  christos     }
   3126  1.3  christos   if ((asect->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE)) == SEC_EXCLUDE)
   3127  1.3  christos     this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXCLUDE;
   3128  1.3  christos 
   3129  1.3  christos   /* If the section has relocs, set up a section header for the
   3130  1.3  christos      SHT_REL[A] section.  If two relocation sections are required for
   3131  1.3  christos      this section, it is up to the processor-specific back-end to
   3132  1.3  christos      create the other.  */
   3133  1.3  christos   if ((asect->flags & SEC_RELOC) != 0)
   3134  1.3  christos     {
   3135  1.3  christos       /* When doing a relocatable link, create both REL and RELA sections if
   3136  1.3  christos 	 needed.  */
   3137  1.3  christos       if (arg->link_info
   3138  1.6  christos 	  /* Do the normal setup if we wouldn't create any sections here.  */
   3139  1.6  christos 	  && esd->rel.count + esd->rela.count > 0
   3140  1.3  christos 	  && (bfd_link_relocatable (arg->link_info)
   3141  1.3  christos 	      || arg->link_info->emitrelocations))
   3142  1.6  christos 	{
   3143  1.6  christos 	  if (esd->rel.count && esd->rel.hdr == NULL
   3144  1.3  christos 	      && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rel, name, FALSE,
   3145  1.3  christos 					    delay_st_name_p))
   3146  1.3  christos 	    {
   3147  1.3  christos 	      arg->failed = TRUE;
   3148  1.3  christos 	      return;
   3149  1.6  christos 	    }
   3150  1.6  christos 	  if (esd->rela.count && esd->rela.hdr == NULL
   3151  1.3  christos 	      && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rela, name, TRUE,
   3152  1.3  christos 					    delay_st_name_p))
   3153  1.3  christos 	    {
   3154  1.3  christos 	      arg->failed = TRUE;
   3155  1.3  christos 	      return;
   3156  1.3  christos 	    }
   3157  1.3  christos 	}
   3158  1.3  christos       else if (!_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd,
   3159  1.6  christos 					  (asect->use_rela_p
   3160  1.6  christos 					   ? &esd->rela : &esd->rel),
   3161  1.6  christos 					  name,
   3162  1.3  christos 					  asect->use_rela_p,
   3163  1.3  christos 					  delay_st_name_p))
   3164  1.1     skrll 	  arg->failed = TRUE;
   3165  1.1     skrll     }
   3166  1.1     skrll 
   3167  1.1     skrll   /* Check for processor-specific section types.  */
   3168  1.1     skrll   sh_type = this_hdr->sh_type;
   3169  1.3  christos   if (bed->elf_backend_fake_sections
   3170  1.1     skrll       && !(*bed->elf_backend_fake_sections) (abfd, this_hdr, asect))
   3171  1.1     skrll     arg->failed = TRUE;
   3172  1.1     skrll 
   3173  1.1     skrll   if (sh_type == SHT_NOBITS && asect->size != 0)
   3174  1.1     skrll     {
   3175  1.1     skrll       /* Don't change the header type from NOBITS if we are being
   3176  1.1     skrll 	 called for objcopy --only-keep-debug.  */
   3177  1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
   3178  1.1     skrll     }
   3179  1.2     skrll }
   3180  1.2     skrll 
   3181  1.2     skrll /* Fill in the contents of a SHT_GROUP section.  Called from
   3182  1.2     skrll    _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions for gas, objcopy, and
   3183  1.1     skrll    when ELF targets use the generic linker, ld.  Called for ld -r
   3184  1.1     skrll    from bfd_elf_final_link.  */
   3185  1.1     skrll 
   3186  1.1     skrll void
   3187  1.3  christos bfd_elf_set_group_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, void *failedptrarg)
   3188  1.1     skrll {
   3189  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean *failedptr = (bfd_boolean *) failedptrarg;
   3190  1.1     skrll   asection *elt, *first;
   3191  1.1     skrll   unsigned char *loc;
   3192  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean gas;
   3193  1.1     skrll 
   3194  1.1     skrll   /* Ignore linker created group section.  See elfNN_ia64_object_p in
   3195  1.1     skrll      elfxx-ia64.c.  */
   3196  1.1     skrll   if (((sec->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_LINKER_CREATED)) != SEC_GROUP)
   3197  1.1     skrll       || *failedptr)
   3198  1.2     skrll     return;
   3199  1.2     skrll 
   3200  1.2     skrll   if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == 0)
   3201  1.2     skrll     {
   3202  1.2     skrll       unsigned long symindx = 0;
   3203  1.2     skrll 
   3204  1.2     skrll       /* elf_group_id will have been set up by objcopy and the
   3205  1.2     skrll 	 generic linker.  */
   3206  1.2     skrll       if (elf_group_id (sec) != NULL)
   3207  1.2     skrll 	symindx = elf_group_id (sec)->udata.i;
   3208  1.2     skrll 
   3209  1.2     skrll       if (symindx == 0)
   3210  1.2     skrll 	{
   3211  1.2     skrll 	  /* If called from the assembler, swap_out_syms will have set up
   3212  1.2     skrll 	     elf_section_syms.  */
   3213  1.2     skrll 	  BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_syms (abfd) != NULL);
   3214  1.2     skrll 	  symindx = elf_section_syms (abfd)[sec->index]->udata.i;
   3215  1.2     skrll 	}
   3216  1.2     skrll       elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = symindx;
   3217  1.2     skrll     }
   3218  1.2     skrll   else if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == (unsigned int) -2)
   3219  1.2     skrll     {
   3220  1.2     skrll       /* The ELF backend linker sets sh_info to -2 when the group
   3221  1.2     skrll 	 signature symbol is global, and thus the index can't be
   3222  1.2     skrll 	 set until all local symbols are output.  */
   3223  1.2     skrll       asection *igroup = elf_sec_group (elf_next_in_group (sec));
   3224  1.2     skrll       struct bfd_elf_section_data *sec_data = elf_section_data (igroup);
   3225  1.2     skrll       unsigned long symndx = sec_data->this_hdr.sh_info;
   3226  1.2     skrll       unsigned long extsymoff = 0;
   3227  1.2     skrll       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   3228  1.2     skrll 
   3229  1.2     skrll       if (!elf_bad_symtab (igroup->owner))
   3230  1.2     skrll 	{
   3231  1.2     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   3232  1.2     skrll 
   3233  1.2     skrll 	  symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (igroup->owner)->symtab_hdr;
   3234  1.2     skrll 	  extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
   3235  1.2     skrll 	}
   3236  1.2     skrll       h = elf_sym_hashes (igroup->owner)[symndx - extsymoff];
   3237  1.2     skrll       while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
   3238  1.2     skrll 	     || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
   3239  1.2     skrll 	h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
   3240  1.1     skrll 
   3241  1.1     skrll       elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = h->indx;
   3242  1.1     skrll     }
   3243  1.1     skrll 
   3244  1.1     skrll   /* The contents won't be allocated for "ld -r" or objcopy.  */
   3245  1.1     skrll   gas = TRUE;
   3246  1.1     skrll   if (sec->contents == NULL)
   3247  1.3  christos     {
   3248  1.1     skrll       gas = FALSE;
   3249  1.1     skrll       sec->contents = (unsigned char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sec->size);
   3250  1.1     skrll 
   3251  1.1     skrll       /* Arrange for the section to be written out.  */
   3252  1.1     skrll       elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = sec->contents;
   3253  1.1     skrll       if (sec->contents == NULL)
   3254  1.1     skrll 	{
   3255  1.1     skrll 	  *failedptr = TRUE;
   3256  1.1     skrll 	  return;
   3257  1.1     skrll 	}
   3258  1.1     skrll     }
   3259  1.1     skrll 
   3260  1.1     skrll   loc = sec->contents + sec->size;
   3261  1.1     skrll 
   3262  1.1     skrll   /* Get the pointer to the first section in the group that gas
   3263  1.1     skrll      squirreled away here.  objcopy arranges for this to be set to the
   3264  1.1     skrll      start of the input section group.  */
   3265  1.1     skrll   first = elt = elf_next_in_group (sec);
   3266  1.1     skrll 
   3267  1.1     skrll   /* First element is a flag word.  Rest of section is elf section
   3268  1.1     skrll      indices for all the sections of the group.  Write them backwards
   3269  1.1     skrll      just to keep the group in the same order as given in .section
   3270  1.1     skrll      directives, not that it matters.  */
   3271  1.1     skrll   while (elt != NULL)
   3272  1.1     skrll     {
   3273  1.1     skrll       asection *s;
   3274  1.1     skrll 
   3275  1.1     skrll       s = elt;
   3276  1.3  christos       if (!gas)
   3277  1.3  christos 	s = s->output_section;
   3278  1.3  christos       if (s != NULL
   3279  1.3  christos 	  && !bfd_is_abs_section (s))
   3280  1.3  christos 	{
   3281  1.3  christos 	  unsigned int idx = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
   3282  1.3  christos 
   3283  1.3  christos 	  loc -= 4;
   3284  1.1     skrll 	  H_PUT_32 (abfd, idx, loc);
   3285  1.1     skrll 	}
   3286  1.1     skrll       elt = elf_next_in_group (elt);
   3287  1.1     skrll       if (elt == first)
   3288  1.1     skrll 	break;
   3289  1.1     skrll     }
   3290  1.1     skrll 
   3291  1.1     skrll   if ((loc -= 4) != sec->contents)
   3292  1.1     skrll     abort ();
   3293  1.1     skrll 
   3294  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, sec->flags & SEC_LINK_ONCE ? GRP_COMDAT : 0, loc);
   3295  1.6  christos }
   3296  1.6  christos 
   3297  1.6  christos /* Return the section which RELOC_SEC applies to.  */
   3298  1.6  christos 
   3299  1.6  christos asection *
   3300  1.6  christos _bfd_elf_get_reloc_section (asection *reloc_sec)
   3301  1.6  christos {
   3302  1.6  christos   const char *name;
   3303  1.6  christos   unsigned int type;
   3304  1.6  christos   bfd *abfd;
   3305  1.6  christos 
   3306  1.6  christos   if (reloc_sec == NULL)
   3307  1.6  christos     return NULL;
   3308  1.6  christos 
   3309  1.6  christos   type = elf_section_data (reloc_sec)->this_hdr.sh_type;
   3310  1.6  christos   if (type != SHT_REL && type != SHT_RELA)
   3311  1.6  christos     return NULL;
   3312  1.6  christos 
   3313  1.6  christos   /* We look up the section the relocs apply to by name.  */
   3314  1.6  christos   name = reloc_sec->name;
   3315  1.6  christos   if (type == SHT_REL)
   3316  1.6  christos     name += 4;
   3317  1.6  christos   else
   3318  1.6  christos     name += 5;
   3319  1.6  christos 
   3320  1.6  christos   /* If a target needs .got.plt section, relocations in rela.plt/rel.plt
   3321  1.6  christos      section apply to .got.plt section.  */
   3322  1.6  christos   abfd = reloc_sec->owner;
   3323  1.6  christos   if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->want_got_plt
   3324  1.6  christos       && strcmp (name, ".plt") == 0)
   3325  1.6  christos     {
   3326  1.6  christos       /* .got.plt is a linker created input section.  It may be mapped
   3327  1.6  christos 	 to some other output section.  Try two likely sections.  */
   3328  1.6  christos       name = ".got.plt";
   3329  1.6  christos       reloc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
   3330  1.6  christos       if (reloc_sec != NULL)
   3331  1.6  christos 	return reloc_sec;
   3332  1.6  christos       name = ".got";
   3333  1.6  christos     }
   3334  1.6  christos 
   3335  1.6  christos   reloc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
   3336  1.6  christos   return reloc_sec;
   3337  1.1     skrll }
   3338  1.1     skrll 
   3339  1.1     skrll /* Assign all ELF section numbers.  The dummy first section is handled here
   3340  1.1     skrll    too.  The link/info pointers for the standard section types are filled
   3341  1.1     skrll    in here too, while we're at it.  */
   3342  1.1     skrll 
   3343  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   3344  1.1     skrll assign_section_numbers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
   3345  1.1     skrll {
   3346  1.6  christos   struct elf_obj_tdata *t = elf_tdata (abfd);
   3347  1.1     skrll   asection *sec;
   3348  1.1     skrll   unsigned int section_number;
   3349  1.3  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
   3350  1.1     skrll   struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
   3351  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean need_symtab;
   3352  1.1     skrll 
   3353  1.1     skrll   section_number = 1;
   3354  1.1     skrll 
   3355  1.1     skrll   _bfd_elf_strtab_clear_all_refs (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
   3356  1.6  christos 
   3357  1.1     skrll   /* SHT_GROUP sections are in relocatable files only.  */
   3358  1.1     skrll   if (link_info == NULL || bfd_link_relocatable (link_info))
   3359  1.1     skrll     {
   3360  1.1     skrll       /* Put SHT_GROUP sections first.  */
   3361  1.1     skrll       for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
   3362  1.1     skrll 	{
   3363  1.1     skrll 	  d = elf_section_data (sec);
   3364  1.1     skrll 
   3365  1.1     skrll 	  if (d->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
   3366  1.1     skrll 	    {
   3367  1.1     skrll 	      if (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED)
   3368  1.1     skrll 		{
   3369  1.1     skrll 		  /* Remove the linker created SHT_GROUP sections.  */
   3370  1.1     skrll 		  bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, sec);
   3371  1.1     skrll 		  abfd->section_count--;
   3372  1.1     skrll 		}
   3373  1.1     skrll 	      else
   3374  1.1     skrll 		d->this_idx = section_number++;
   3375  1.1     skrll 	    }
   3376  1.1     skrll 	}
   3377  1.1     skrll     }
   3378  1.1     skrll 
   3379  1.1     skrll   for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
   3380  1.1     skrll     {
   3381  1.1     skrll       d = elf_section_data (sec);
   3382  1.1     skrll 
   3383  1.6  christos       if (d->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_GROUP)
   3384  1.6  christos 	d->this_idx = section_number++;
   3385  1.3  christos       if (d->this_hdr.sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
   3386  1.1     skrll 	_bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->this_hdr.sh_name);
   3387  1.3  christos       if (d->rel.hdr)
   3388  1.6  christos 	{
   3389  1.6  christos 	  d->rel.idx = section_number++;
   3390  1.1     skrll 	  if (d->rel.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
   3391  1.3  christos 	    _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rel.hdr->sh_name);
   3392  1.3  christos 	}
   3393  1.1     skrll       else
   3394  1.3  christos 	d->rel.idx = 0;
   3395  1.1     skrll 
   3396  1.3  christos       if (d->rela.hdr)
   3397  1.6  christos 	{
   3398  1.6  christos 	  d->rela.idx = section_number++;
   3399  1.1     skrll 	  if (d->rela.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
   3400  1.1     skrll 	    _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rela.hdr->sh_name);
   3401  1.3  christos 	}
   3402  1.1     skrll       else
   3403  1.1     skrll 	d->rela.idx = 0;
   3404  1.6  christos     }
   3405  1.1     skrll 
   3406  1.6  christos   elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
   3407  1.1     skrll   _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name);
   3408  1.3  christos   elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
   3409  1.3  christos 
   3410  1.3  christos   need_symtab = (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
   3411  1.3  christos 		|| (link_info == NULL
   3412  1.3  christos 		    && ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
   3413  1.1     skrll 			== HAS_RELOC)));
   3414  1.6  christos   if (need_symtab)
   3415  1.1     skrll     {
   3416  1.1     skrll       elf_onesymtab (abfd) = section_number++;
   3417  1.1     skrll       _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->symtab_hdr.sh_name);
   3418  1.6  christos       if (section_number > ((SHN_LORESERVE - 2) & 0xFFFF))
   3419  1.6  christos 	{
   3420  1.6  christos 	  elf_section_list * entry;
   3421  1.6  christos 
   3422  1.6  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) == NULL);
   3423  1.6  christos 
   3424  1.6  christos 	  entry = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof * entry);
   3425  1.6  christos 	  entry->ndx = section_number++;
   3426  1.1     skrll 	  elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
   3427  1.1     skrll 	  entry->hdr.sh_name
   3428  1.6  christos 	    = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
   3429  1.1     skrll 						  ".symtab_shndx", FALSE);
   3430  1.1     skrll 	  if (entry->hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
   3431  1.6  christos 	    return FALSE;
   3432  1.1     skrll 	}
   3433  1.1     skrll       elf_strtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
   3434  1.1     skrll       _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->strtab_hdr.sh_name);
   3435  1.5  christos     }
   3436  1.5  christos 
   3437  1.5  christos   if (section_number >= SHN_LORESERVE)
   3438  1.5  christos     {
   3439  1.5  christos       _bfd_error_handler (_("%B: too many sections: %u"),
   3440  1.5  christos 			  abfd, section_number);
   3441  1.5  christos       return FALSE;
   3442  1.1     skrll     }
   3443  1.1     skrll 
   3444  1.1     skrll   elf_numsections (abfd) = section_number;
   3445  1.1     skrll   elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shnum = section_number;
   3446  1.1     skrll 
   3447  1.3  christos   /* Set up the list of section header pointers, in agreement with the
   3448  1.3  christos      indices.  */
   3449  1.1     skrll   i_shdrp = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, section_number,
   3450  1.1     skrll                                                 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
   3451  1.1     skrll   if (i_shdrp == NULL)
   3452  1.3  christos     return FALSE;
   3453  1.3  christos 
   3454  1.1     skrll   i_shdrp[0] = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
   3455  1.1     skrll                                                  sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr));
   3456  1.1     skrll   if (i_shdrp[0] == NULL)
   3457  1.1     skrll     {
   3458  1.1     skrll       bfd_release (abfd, i_shdrp);
   3459  1.1     skrll       return FALSE;
   3460  1.1     skrll     }
   3461  1.1     skrll 
   3462  1.6  christos   elf_elfsections (abfd) = i_shdrp;
   3463  1.3  christos 
   3464  1.1     skrll   i_shdrp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->shstrtab_hdr;
   3465  1.6  christos   if (need_symtab)
   3466  1.1     skrll     {
   3467  1.1     skrll       i_shdrp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)] = &t->symtab_hdr;
   3468  1.6  christos       if (elf_numsections (abfd) > (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xFFFF))
   3469  1.6  christos 	{
   3470  1.6  christos 	  elf_section_list * entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
   3471  1.6  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (entry != NULL);
   3472  1.1     skrll 	  i_shdrp[entry->ndx] = & entry->hdr;
   3473  1.6  christos 	  entry->hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
   3474  1.6  christos 	}
   3475  1.1     skrll       i_shdrp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->strtab_hdr;
   3476  1.1     skrll       t->symtab_hdr.sh_link = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
   3477  1.1     skrll     }
   3478  1.1     skrll 
   3479  1.1     skrll   for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
   3480  1.1     skrll     {
   3481  1.3  christos       asection *s;
   3482  1.3  christos 
   3483  1.1     skrll       d = elf_section_data (sec);
   3484  1.3  christos 
   3485  1.3  christos       i_shdrp[d->this_idx] = &d->this_hdr;
   3486  1.3  christos       if (d->rel.idx != 0)
   3487  1.3  christos 	i_shdrp[d->rel.idx] = d->rel.hdr;
   3488  1.1     skrll       if (d->rela.idx != 0)
   3489  1.1     skrll 	i_shdrp[d->rela.idx] = d->rela.hdr;
   3490  1.1     skrll 
   3491  1.1     skrll       /* Fill in the sh_link and sh_info fields while we're at it.  */
   3492  1.1     skrll 
   3493  1.1     skrll       /* sh_link of a reloc section is the section index of the symbol
   3494  1.3  christos 	 table.  sh_info is the section index of the section to which
   3495  1.1     skrll 	 the relocation entries apply.  */
   3496  1.6  christos       if (d->rel.idx != 0)
   3497  1.3  christos 	{
   3498  1.6  christos 	  d->rel.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
   3499  1.1     skrll 	  d->rel.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
   3500  1.3  christos 	  d->rel.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
   3501  1.1     skrll 	}
   3502  1.6  christos       if (d->rela.idx != 0)
   3503  1.3  christos 	{
   3504  1.6  christos 	  d->rela.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
   3505  1.1     skrll 	  d->rela.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
   3506  1.1     skrll 	  d->rela.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
   3507  1.1     skrll 	}
   3508  1.1     skrll 
   3509  1.1     skrll       /* We need to set up sh_link for SHF_LINK_ORDER.  */
   3510  1.1     skrll       if ((d->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
   3511  1.1     skrll 	{
   3512  1.1     skrll 	  s = elf_linked_to_section (sec);
   3513  1.1     skrll 	  if (s)
   3514  1.1     skrll 	    {
   3515  1.1     skrll 	      /* elf_linked_to_section points to the input section.  */
   3516  1.1     skrll 	      if (link_info != NULL)
   3517  1.5  christos 		{
   3518  1.1     skrll 		  /* Check discarded linkonce section.  */
   3519  1.1     skrll 		  if (discarded_section (s))
   3520  1.1     skrll 		    {
   3521  1.1     skrll 		      asection *kept;
   3522  1.1     skrll 		      (*_bfd_error_handler)
   3523  1.1     skrll 			(_("%B: sh_link of section `%A' points to discarded section `%A' of `%B'"),
   3524  1.1     skrll 			 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section,
   3525  1.1     skrll 			 s, s->owner);
   3526  1.1     skrll 		      /* Point to the kept section if it has the same
   3527  1.1     skrll 			 size as the discarded one.  */
   3528  1.1     skrll 		      kept = _bfd_elf_check_kept_section (s, link_info);
   3529  1.1     skrll 		      if (kept == NULL)
   3530  1.1     skrll 			{
   3531  1.1     skrll 			  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   3532  1.1     skrll 			  return FALSE;
   3533  1.1     skrll 			}
   3534  1.1     skrll 		      s = kept;
   3535  1.1     skrll 		    }
   3536  1.1     skrll 
   3537  1.1     skrll 		  s = s->output_section;
   3538  1.1     skrll 		  BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
   3539  1.1     skrll 		}
   3540  1.1     skrll 	      else
   3541  1.1     skrll 		{
   3542  1.1     skrll 		  /* Handle objcopy. */
   3543  1.1     skrll 		  if (s->output_section == NULL)
   3544  1.1     skrll 		    {
   3545  1.1     skrll 		      (*_bfd_error_handler)
   3546  1.1     skrll 			(_("%B: sh_link of section `%A' points to removed section `%A' of `%B'"),
   3547  1.1     skrll 			 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section, s, s->owner);
   3548  1.1     skrll 		      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   3549  1.1     skrll 		      return FALSE;
   3550  1.1     skrll 		    }
   3551  1.1     skrll 		  s = s->output_section;
   3552  1.1     skrll 		}
   3553  1.1     skrll 	      d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
   3554  1.1     skrll 	    }
   3555  1.1     skrll 	  else
   3556  1.1     skrll 	    {
   3557  1.1     skrll 	      /* PR 290:
   3558  1.1     skrll 		 The Intel C compiler generates SHT_IA_64_UNWIND with
   3559  1.1     skrll 		 SHF_LINK_ORDER.  But it doesn't set the sh_link or
   3560  1.1     skrll 		 sh_info fields.  Hence we could get the situation
   3561  1.1     skrll 		 where s is NULL.  */
   3562  1.1     skrll 	      const struct elf_backend_data *bed
   3563  1.1     skrll 		= get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   3564  1.1     skrll 	      if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
   3565  1.1     skrll 		bed->link_order_error_handler
   3566  1.1     skrll 		  (_("%B: warning: sh_link not set for section `%A'"),
   3567  1.1     skrll 		   abfd, sec);
   3568  1.1     skrll 	    }
   3569  1.1     skrll 	}
   3570  1.1     skrll 
   3571  1.1     skrll       switch (d->this_hdr.sh_type)
   3572  1.1     skrll 	{
   3573  1.1     skrll 	case SHT_REL:
   3574  1.1     skrll 	case SHT_RELA:
   3575  1.1     skrll 	  /* A reloc section which we are treating as a normal BFD
   3576  1.1     skrll 	     section.  sh_link is the section index of the symbol
   3577  1.1     skrll 	     table.  sh_info is the section index of the section to
   3578  1.1     skrll 	     which the relocation entries apply.  We assume that an
   3579  1.1     skrll 	     allocated reloc section uses the dynamic symbol table.
   3580  1.1     skrll 	     FIXME: How can we be sure?  */
   3581  1.1     skrll 	  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
   3582  1.1     skrll 	  if (s != NULL)
   3583  1.6  christos 	    d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
   3584  1.1     skrll 
   3585  1.6  christos 	  s = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->get_reloc_section (sec);
   3586  1.6  christos 	  if (s != NULL)
   3587  1.6  christos 	    {
   3588  1.6  christos 	      d->this_hdr.sh_info = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
   3589  1.1     skrll 	      d->this_hdr.sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
   3590  1.1     skrll 	    }
   3591  1.1     skrll 	  break;
   3592  1.1     skrll 
   3593  1.1     skrll 	case SHT_STRTAB:
   3594  1.1     skrll 	  /* We assume that a section named .stab*str is a stabs
   3595  1.1     skrll 	     string section.  We look for a section with the same name
   3596  1.1     skrll 	     but without the trailing ``str'', and set its sh_link
   3597  1.1     skrll 	     field to point to this section.  */
   3598  1.1     skrll 	  if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, ".stab")
   3599  1.1     skrll 	      && strcmp (sec->name + strlen (sec->name) - 3, "str") == 0)
   3600  1.1     skrll 	    {
   3601  1.1     skrll 	      size_t len;
   3602  1.1     skrll 	      char *alc;
   3603  1.3  christos 
   3604  1.1     skrll 	      len = strlen (sec->name);
   3605  1.1     skrll 	      alc = (char *) bfd_malloc (len - 2);
   3606  1.1     skrll 	      if (alc == NULL)
   3607  1.1     skrll 		return FALSE;
   3608  1.1     skrll 	      memcpy (alc, sec->name, len - 3);
   3609  1.1     skrll 	      alc[len - 3] = '\0';
   3610  1.1     skrll 	      s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, alc);
   3611  1.1     skrll 	      free (alc);
   3612  1.1     skrll 	      if (s != NULL)
   3613  1.1     skrll 		{
   3614  1.1     skrll 		  elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link = d->this_idx;
   3615  1.1     skrll 
   3616  1.1     skrll 		  /* This is a .stab section.  */
   3617  1.1     skrll 		  if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize == 0)
   3618  1.1     skrll 		    elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
   3619  1.1     skrll 		      = 4 + 2 * bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 8;
   3620  1.1     skrll 		}
   3621  1.1     skrll 	    }
   3622  1.1     skrll 	  break;
   3623  1.1     skrll 
   3624  1.1     skrll 	case SHT_DYNAMIC:
   3625  1.1     skrll 	case SHT_DYNSYM:
   3626  1.1     skrll 	case SHT_GNU_verneed:
   3627  1.1     skrll 	case SHT_GNU_verdef:
   3628  1.1     skrll 	  /* sh_link is the section header index of the string table
   3629  1.1     skrll 	     used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or the
   3630  1.1     skrll 	     version strings.  */
   3631  1.1     skrll 	  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
   3632  1.1     skrll 	  if (s != NULL)
   3633  1.1     skrll 	    d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
   3634  1.1     skrll 	  break;
   3635  1.1     skrll 
   3636  1.1     skrll 	case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST:
   3637  1.1     skrll 	  /* sh_link is the section header index of the prelink library
   3638  1.1     skrll 	     list used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or
   3639  1.1     skrll 	     the version strings.  */
   3640  1.1     skrll 	  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC)
   3641  1.1     skrll 					     ? ".dynstr" : ".gnu.libstr");
   3642  1.1     skrll 	  if (s != NULL)
   3643  1.1     skrll 	    d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
   3644  1.1     skrll 	  break;
   3645  1.1     skrll 
   3646  1.1     skrll 	case SHT_HASH:
   3647  1.1     skrll 	case SHT_GNU_HASH:
   3648  1.1     skrll 	case SHT_GNU_versym:
   3649  1.1     skrll 	  /* sh_link is the section header index of the symbol table
   3650  1.1     skrll 	     this hash table or version table is for.  */
   3651  1.1     skrll 	  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
   3652  1.1     skrll 	  if (s != NULL)
   3653  1.1     skrll 	    d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
   3654  1.1     skrll 	  break;
   3655  1.6  christos 
   3656  1.1     skrll 	case SHT_GROUP:
   3657  1.1     skrll 	  d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
   3658  1.1     skrll 	}
   3659  1.6  christos     }
   3660  1.6  christos 
   3661  1.6  christos   /* Delay setting sh_name to _bfd_elf_write_object_contents so that
   3662  1.6  christos      _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load can convert DWARF
   3663  1.1     skrll      debug section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_* if needed.  */
   3664  1.1     skrll 
   3665  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   3666  1.1     skrll }
   3667  1.1     skrll 
   3668  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   3669  1.1     skrll sym_is_global (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
   3670  1.1     skrll {
   3671  1.1     skrll   /* If the backend has a special mapping, use it.  */
   3672  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   3673  1.1     skrll   if (bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global)
   3674  1.3  christos     return (*bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global) (abfd, sym);
   3675  1.1     skrll 
   3676  1.1     skrll   return ((sym->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK | BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)) != 0
   3677  1.1     skrll 	  || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (sym))
   3678  1.1     skrll 	  || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (sym)));
   3679  1.1     skrll }
   3680  1.5  christos 
   3681  1.1     skrll /* Don't output section symbols for sections that are not going to be
   3682  1.1     skrll    output, that are duplicates or there is no BFD section.  */
   3683  1.1     skrll 
   3684  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   3685  1.5  christos ignore_section_sym (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
   3686  1.5  christos {
   3687  1.5  christos   elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
   3688  1.5  christos 
   3689  1.5  christos   if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
   3690  1.5  christos     return FALSE;
   3691  1.5  christos 
   3692  1.5  christos   type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, sym);
   3693  1.5  christos   return ((type_ptr != NULL
   3694  1.5  christos 	   && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
   3695  1.1     skrll 	   && bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
   3696  1.5  christos 	  || !(sym->section->owner == abfd
   3697  1.5  christos 	       || (sym->section->output_section->owner == abfd
   3698  1.1     skrll 		   && sym->section->output_offset == 0)
   3699  1.1     skrll 	       || bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section)));
   3700  1.5  christos }
   3701  1.5  christos 
   3702  1.5  christos /* Map symbol from it's internal number to the external number, moving
   3703  1.1     skrll    all local symbols to be at the head of the list.  */
   3704  1.6  christos 
   3705  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   3706  1.1     skrll elf_map_symbols (bfd *abfd, unsigned int *pnum_locals)
   3707  1.1     skrll {
   3708  1.1     skrll   unsigned int symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
   3709  1.1     skrll   asymbol **syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
   3710  1.1     skrll   asymbol **sect_syms;
   3711  1.1     skrll   unsigned int num_locals = 0;
   3712  1.1     skrll   unsigned int num_globals = 0;
   3713  1.6  christos   unsigned int num_locals2 = 0;
   3714  1.1     skrll   unsigned int num_globals2 = 0;
   3715  1.1     skrll   unsigned int max_index = 0;
   3716  1.1     skrll   unsigned int idx;
   3717  1.1     skrll   asection *asect;
   3718  1.1     skrll   asymbol **new_syms;
   3719  1.1     skrll 
   3720  1.1     skrll #ifdef DEBUG
   3721  1.1     skrll   fprintf (stderr, "elf_map_symbols\n");
   3722  1.1     skrll   fflush (stderr);
   3723  1.1     skrll #endif
   3724  1.1     skrll 
   3725  1.1     skrll   for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
   3726  1.1     skrll     {
   3727  1.1     skrll       if (max_index < asect->index)
   3728  1.1     skrll 	max_index = asect->index;
   3729  1.1     skrll     }
   3730  1.3  christos 
   3731  1.1     skrll   max_index++;
   3732  1.1     skrll   sect_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, max_index, sizeof (asymbol *));
   3733  1.1     skrll   if (sect_syms == NULL)
   3734  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   3735  1.1     skrll   elf_section_syms (abfd) = sect_syms;
   3736  1.1     skrll   elf_num_section_syms (abfd) = max_index;
   3737  1.1     skrll 
   3738  1.1     skrll   /* Init sect_syms entries for any section symbols we have already
   3739  1.1     skrll      decided to output.  */
   3740  1.1     skrll   for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
   3741  1.1     skrll     {
   3742  1.1     skrll       asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
   3743  1.1     skrll 
   3744  1.5  christos       if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0
   3745  1.5  christos 	  && sym->value == 0
   3746  1.1     skrll 	  && !ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym)
   3747  1.1     skrll 	  && !bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
   3748  1.1     skrll 	{
   3749  1.1     skrll 	  asection *sec = sym->section;
   3750  1.1     skrll 
   3751  1.1     skrll 	  if (sec->owner != abfd)
   3752  1.1     skrll 	    sec = sec->output_section;
   3753  1.1     skrll 
   3754  1.1     skrll 	  sect_syms[sec->index] = syms[idx];
   3755  1.1     skrll 	}
   3756  1.1     skrll     }
   3757  1.1     skrll 
   3758  1.1     skrll   /* Classify all of the symbols.  */
   3759  1.5  christos   for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
   3760  1.5  christos     {
   3761  1.5  christos       if (sym_is_global (abfd, syms[idx]))
   3762  1.1     skrll 	num_globals++;
   3763  1.1     skrll       else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, syms[idx]))
   3764  1.1     skrll 	num_locals++;
   3765  1.1     skrll     }
   3766  1.1     skrll 
   3767  1.1     skrll   /* We will be adding a section symbol for each normal BFD section.  Most
   3768  1.1     skrll      sections will already have a section symbol in outsymbols, but
   3769  1.1     skrll      eg. SHT_GROUP sections will not, and we need the section symbol mapped
   3770  1.1     skrll      at least in that case.  */
   3771  1.1     skrll   for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
   3772  1.1     skrll     {
   3773  1.1     skrll       if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
   3774  1.1     skrll 	{
   3775  1.1     skrll 	  if (!sym_is_global (abfd, asect->symbol))
   3776  1.1     skrll 	    num_locals++;
   3777  1.1     skrll 	  else
   3778  1.1     skrll 	    num_globals++;
   3779  1.1     skrll 	}
   3780  1.1     skrll     }
   3781  1.3  christos 
   3782  1.3  christos   /* Now sort the symbols so the local symbols are first.  */
   3783  1.1     skrll   new_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_locals + num_globals,
   3784  1.1     skrll                                       sizeof (asymbol *));
   3785  1.1     skrll 
   3786  1.1     skrll   if (new_syms == NULL)
   3787  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   3788  1.1     skrll 
   3789  1.1     skrll   for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
   3790  1.1     skrll     {
   3791  1.1     skrll       asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
   3792  1.5  christos       unsigned int i;
   3793  1.5  christos 
   3794  1.5  christos       if (sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
   3795  1.1     skrll 	i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
   3796  1.1     skrll       else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym))
   3797  1.5  christos 	i = num_locals2++;
   3798  1.1     skrll       else
   3799  1.1     skrll 	continue;
   3800  1.1     skrll       new_syms[i] = sym;
   3801  1.1     skrll       sym->udata.i = i + 1;
   3802  1.1     skrll     }
   3803  1.1     skrll   for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
   3804  1.1     skrll     {
   3805  1.1     skrll       if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
   3806  1.1     skrll 	{
   3807  1.1     skrll 	  asymbol *sym = asect->symbol;
   3808  1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int i;
   3809  1.1     skrll 
   3810  1.1     skrll 	  sect_syms[asect->index] = sym;
   3811  1.1     skrll 	  if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
   3812  1.1     skrll 	    i = num_locals2++;
   3813  1.1     skrll 	  else
   3814  1.1     skrll 	    i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
   3815  1.1     skrll 	  new_syms[i] = sym;
   3816  1.1     skrll 	  sym->udata.i = i + 1;
   3817  1.1     skrll 	}
   3818  1.1     skrll     }
   3819  1.1     skrll 
   3820  1.6  christos   bfd_set_symtab (abfd, new_syms, num_locals + num_globals);
   3821  1.1     skrll 
   3822  1.1     skrll   *pnum_locals = num_locals;
   3823  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   3824  1.1     skrll }
   3825  1.1     skrll 
   3826  1.1     skrll /* Align to the maximum file alignment that could be required for any
   3827  1.1     skrll    ELF data structure.  */
   3828  1.1     skrll 
   3829  1.1     skrll static inline file_ptr
   3830  1.1     skrll align_file_position (file_ptr off, int align)
   3831  1.1     skrll {
   3832  1.1     skrll   return (off + align - 1) & ~(align - 1);
   3833  1.1     skrll }
   3834  1.1     skrll 
   3835  1.1     skrll /* Assign a file position to a section, optionally aligning to the
   3836  1.1     skrll    required section alignment.  */
   3837  1.1     skrll 
   3838  1.1     skrll file_ptr
   3839  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (Elf_Internal_Shdr *i_shdrp,
   3840  1.1     skrll 					   file_ptr offset,
   3841  1.1     skrll 					   bfd_boolean align)
   3842  1.1     skrll {
   3843  1.1     skrll   if (align && i_shdrp->sh_addralign > 1)
   3844  1.1     skrll     offset = BFD_ALIGN (offset, i_shdrp->sh_addralign);
   3845  1.1     skrll   i_shdrp->sh_offset = offset;
   3846  1.1     skrll   if (i_shdrp->bfd_section != NULL)
   3847  1.1     skrll     i_shdrp->bfd_section->filepos = offset;
   3848  1.1     skrll   if (i_shdrp->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
   3849  1.1     skrll     offset += i_shdrp->sh_size;
   3850  1.1     skrll   return offset;
   3851  1.1     skrll }
   3852  1.1     skrll 
   3853  1.1     skrll /* Compute the file positions we are going to put the sections at, and
   3854  1.1     skrll    otherwise prepare to begin writing out the ELF file.  If LINK_INFO
   3855  1.1     skrll    is not NULL, this is being called by the ELF backend linker.  */
   3856  1.1     skrll 
   3857  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   3858  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (bfd *abfd,
   3859  1.1     skrll 					 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
   3860  1.3  christos {
   3861  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   3862  1.6  christos   struct fake_section_arg fsargs;
   3863  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean failed;
   3864  1.3  christos   struct elf_strtab_hash *strtab = NULL;
   3865  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *shstrtab_hdr;
   3866  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean need_symtab;
   3867  1.1     skrll 
   3868  1.1     skrll   if (abfd->output_has_begun)
   3869  1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   3870  1.1     skrll 
   3871  1.1     skrll   /* Do any elf backend specific processing first.  */
   3872  1.1     skrll   if (bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing)
   3873  1.1     skrll     (*bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing) (abfd, link_info);
   3874  1.1     skrll 
   3875  1.1     skrll   if (! prep_headers (abfd))
   3876  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   3877  1.6  christos 
   3878  1.1     skrll   /* Post process the headers if necessary.  */
   3879  1.3  christos   (*bed->elf_backend_post_process_headers) (abfd, link_info);
   3880  1.3  christos 
   3881  1.3  christos   fsargs.failed = FALSE;
   3882  1.3  christos   fsargs.link_info = link_info;
   3883  1.1     skrll   bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, elf_fake_sections, &fsargs);
   3884  1.1     skrll   if (fsargs.failed)
   3885  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   3886  1.1     skrll 
   3887  1.1     skrll   if (!assign_section_numbers (abfd, link_info))
   3888  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   3889  1.3  christos 
   3890  1.3  christos   /* The backend linker builds symbol table information itself.  */
   3891  1.3  christos   need_symtab = (link_info == NULL
   3892  1.3  christos 		 && (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
   3893  1.3  christos 		     || ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
   3894  1.1     skrll 			 == HAS_RELOC)));
   3895  1.1     skrll   if (need_symtab)
   3896  1.1     skrll     {
   3897  1.1     skrll       /* Non-zero if doing a relocatable link.  */
   3898  1.1     skrll       int relocatable_p = ! (abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC));
   3899  1.1     skrll 
   3900  1.1     skrll       if (! swap_out_syms (abfd, &strtab, relocatable_p))
   3901  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   3902  1.3  christos     }
   3903  1.1     skrll 
   3904  1.1     skrll   failed = FALSE;
   3905  1.1     skrll   if (link_info == NULL)
   3906  1.1     skrll     {
   3907  1.1     skrll       bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bfd_elf_set_group_contents, &failed);
   3908  1.1     skrll       if (failed)
   3909  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   3910  1.1     skrll     }
   3911  1.1     skrll 
   3912  1.1     skrll   shstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
   3913  1.1     skrll   /* sh_name was set in prep_headers.  */
   3914  1.1     skrll   shstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
   3915  1.6  christos   shstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
   3916  1.1     skrll   shstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
   3917  1.1     skrll   /* sh_size is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load.  */
   3918  1.1     skrll   shstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
   3919  1.6  christos   shstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
   3920  1.1     skrll   shstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
   3921  1.1     skrll   /* sh_offset is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load.  */
   3922  1.1     skrll   shstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
   3923  1.1     skrll 
   3924  1.1     skrll   if (!assign_file_positions_except_relocs (abfd, link_info))
   3925  1.3  christos     return FALSE;
   3926  1.1     skrll 
   3927  1.1     skrll   if (need_symtab)
   3928  1.1     skrll     {
   3929  1.1     skrll       file_ptr off;
   3930  1.6  christos       Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
   3931  1.1     skrll 
   3932  1.6  christos       off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
   3933  1.1     skrll 
   3934  1.1     skrll       hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
   3935  1.6  christos       off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
   3936  1.6  christos 
   3937  1.6  christos       if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL)
   3938  1.6  christos 	{
   3939  1.6  christos 	  hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
   3940  1.6  christos 	  if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
   3941  1.6  christos 	    off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
   3942  1.1     skrll 	  /* FIXME: What about other symtab_shndx sections in the list ?  */
   3943  1.1     skrll 	}
   3944  1.1     skrll 
   3945  1.1     skrll       hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
   3946  1.6  christos       off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
   3947  1.1     skrll 
   3948  1.1     skrll       elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
   3949  1.1     skrll 
   3950  1.1     skrll       /* Now that we know where the .strtab section goes, write it
   3951  1.6  christos 	 out.  */
   3952  1.1     skrll       if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
   3953  1.6  christos 	  || ! _bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, strtab))
   3954  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   3955  1.1     skrll       _bfd_elf_strtab_free (strtab);
   3956  1.1     skrll     }
   3957  1.1     skrll 
   3958  1.1     skrll   abfd->output_has_begun = TRUE;
   3959  1.1     skrll 
   3960  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   3961  1.1     skrll }
   3962  1.1     skrll 
   3963  1.1     skrll /* Make an initial estimate of the size of the program header.  If we
   3964  1.1     skrll    get the number wrong here, we'll redo section placement.  */
   3965  1.1     skrll 
   3966  1.1     skrll static bfd_size_type
   3967  1.1     skrll get_program_header_size (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   3968  1.1     skrll {
   3969  1.1     skrll   size_t segs;
   3970  1.1     skrll   asection *s;
   3971  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   3972  1.1     skrll 
   3973  1.1     skrll   /* Assume we will need exactly two PT_LOAD segments: one for text
   3974  1.1     skrll      and one for data.  */
   3975  1.1     skrll   segs = 2;
   3976  1.1     skrll 
   3977  1.1     skrll   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
   3978  1.1     skrll   if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
   3979  1.1     skrll     {
   3980  1.1     skrll       /* If we have a loadable interpreter section, we need a
   3981  1.1     skrll 	 PT_INTERP segment.  In this case, assume we also need a
   3982  1.1     skrll 	 PT_PHDR segment, although that may not be true for all
   3983  1.1     skrll 	 targets.  */
   3984  1.1     skrll       segs += 2;
   3985  1.1     skrll     }
   3986  1.1     skrll 
   3987  1.1     skrll   if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
   3988  1.1     skrll     {
   3989  1.1     skrll       /* We need a PT_DYNAMIC segment.  */
   3990  1.1     skrll       ++segs;
   3991  1.1     skrll     }
   3992  1.1     skrll 
   3993  1.1     skrll   if (info != NULL && info->relro)
   3994  1.1     skrll     {
   3995  1.1     skrll       /* We need a PT_GNU_RELRO segment.  */
   3996  1.1     skrll       ++segs;
   3997  1.6  christos     }
   3998  1.1     skrll 
   3999  1.1     skrll   if (elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd))
   4000  1.1     skrll     {
   4001  1.1     skrll       /* We need a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME segment.  */
   4002  1.1     skrll       ++segs;
   4003  1.6  christos     }
   4004  1.1     skrll 
   4005  1.1     skrll   if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
   4006  1.1     skrll     {
   4007  1.1     skrll       /* We need a PT_GNU_STACK segment.  */
   4008  1.1     skrll       ++segs;
   4009  1.1     skrll     }
   4010  1.1     skrll 
   4011  1.1     skrll   for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   4012  1.1     skrll     {
   4013  1.1     skrll       if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
   4014  1.1     skrll 	  && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
   4015  1.1     skrll 	{
   4016  1.1     skrll 	  /* We need a PT_NOTE segment.  */
   4017  1.1     skrll 	  ++segs;
   4018  1.1     skrll 	  /* Try to create just one PT_NOTE segment
   4019  1.1     skrll 	     for all adjacent loadable .note* sections.
   4020  1.1     skrll 	     gABI requires that within a PT_NOTE segment
   4021  1.1     skrll 	     (and also inside of each SHT_NOTE section)
   4022  1.1     skrll 	     each note is padded to a multiple of 4 size,
   4023  1.1     skrll 	     so we check whether the sections are correctly
   4024  1.1     skrll 	     aligned.  */
   4025  1.1     skrll 	  if (s->alignment_power == 2)
   4026  1.1     skrll 	    while (s->next != NULL
   4027  1.1     skrll 		   && s->next->alignment_power == 2
   4028  1.1     skrll 		   && (s->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
   4029  1.1     skrll 		   && CONST_STRNEQ (s->next->name, ".note"))
   4030  1.1     skrll 	      s = s->next;
   4031  1.1     skrll 	}
   4032  1.1     skrll     }
   4033  1.1     skrll 
   4034  1.1     skrll   for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   4035  1.1     skrll     {
   4036  1.1     skrll       if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
   4037  1.1     skrll 	{
   4038  1.1     skrll 	  /* We need a PT_TLS segment.  */
   4039  1.1     skrll 	  ++segs;
   4040  1.1     skrll 	  break;
   4041  1.1     skrll 	}
   4042  1.1     skrll     }
   4043  1.1     skrll 
   4044  1.1     skrll   /* Let the backend count up any program headers it might need.  */
   4045  1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   4046  1.1     skrll   if (bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers)
   4047  1.1     skrll     {
   4048  1.1     skrll       int a;
   4049  1.1     skrll 
   4050  1.1     skrll       a = (*bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers) (abfd, info);
   4051  1.1     skrll       if (a == -1)
   4052  1.1     skrll 	abort ();
   4053  1.1     skrll       segs += a;
   4054  1.1     skrll     }
   4055  1.1     skrll 
   4056  1.1     skrll   return segs * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
   4057  1.1     skrll }
   4058  1.1     skrll 
   4059  1.1     skrll /* Find the segment that contains the output_section of section.  */
   4060  1.1     skrll 
   4061  1.1     skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *
   4062  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_find_segment_containing_section (bfd * abfd, asection * section)
   4063  1.1     skrll {
   4064  1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *m;
   4065  1.6  christos   Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
   4066  1.1     skrll 
   4067  1.1     skrll   for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
   4068  1.1     skrll        m != NULL;
   4069  1.1     skrll        m = m->next, p++)
   4070  1.1     skrll     {
   4071  1.1     skrll       int i;
   4072  1.1     skrll 
   4073  1.1     skrll       for (i = m->count - 1; i >= 0; i--)
   4074  1.1     skrll 	if (m->sections[i] == section)
   4075  1.1     skrll 	  return p;
   4076  1.1     skrll     }
   4077  1.1     skrll 
   4078  1.1     skrll   return NULL;
   4079  1.1     skrll }
   4080  1.1     skrll 
   4081  1.1     skrll /* Create a mapping from a set of sections to a program segment.  */
   4082  1.1     skrll 
   4083  1.1     skrll static struct elf_segment_map *
   4084  1.1     skrll make_mapping (bfd *abfd,
   4085  1.1     skrll 	      asection **sections,
   4086  1.1     skrll 	      unsigned int from,
   4087  1.1     skrll 	      unsigned int to,
   4088  1.1     skrll 	      bfd_boolean phdr)
   4089  1.1     skrll {
   4090  1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *m;
   4091  1.1     skrll   unsigned int i;
   4092  1.1     skrll   asection **hdrpp;
   4093  1.1     skrll   bfd_size_type amt;
   4094  1.1     skrll 
   4095  1.3  christos   amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   4096  1.1     skrll   amt += (to - from - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
   4097  1.1     skrll   m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   4098  1.1     skrll   if (m == NULL)
   4099  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
   4100  1.1     skrll   m->next = NULL;
   4101  1.1     skrll   m->p_type = PT_LOAD;
   4102  1.1     skrll   for (i = from, hdrpp = sections + from; i < to; i++, hdrpp++)
   4103  1.1     skrll     m->sections[i - from] = *hdrpp;
   4104  1.1     skrll   m->count = to - from;
   4105  1.1     skrll 
   4106  1.1     skrll   if (from == 0 && phdr)
   4107  1.1     skrll     {
   4108  1.1     skrll       /* Include the headers in the first PT_LOAD segment.  */
   4109  1.1     skrll       m->includes_filehdr = 1;
   4110  1.1     skrll       m->includes_phdrs = 1;
   4111  1.1     skrll     }
   4112  1.1     skrll 
   4113  1.1     skrll   return m;
   4114  1.1     skrll }
   4115  1.1     skrll 
   4116  1.1     skrll /* Create the PT_DYNAMIC segment, which includes DYNSEC.  Returns NULL
   4117  1.1     skrll    on failure.  */
   4118  1.1     skrll 
   4119  1.1     skrll struct elf_segment_map *
   4120  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (bfd *abfd, asection *dynsec)
   4121  1.1     skrll {
   4122  1.3  christos   struct elf_segment_map *m;
   4123  1.3  christos 
   4124  1.1     skrll   m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
   4125  1.1     skrll                                              sizeof (struct elf_segment_map));
   4126  1.1     skrll   if (m == NULL)
   4127  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
   4128  1.1     skrll   m->next = NULL;
   4129  1.1     skrll   m->p_type = PT_DYNAMIC;
   4130  1.1     skrll   m->count = 1;
   4131  1.1     skrll   m->sections[0] = dynsec;
   4132  1.1     skrll 
   4133  1.1     skrll   return m;
   4134  1.1     skrll }
   4135  1.1     skrll 
   4136  1.1     skrll /* Possibly add or remove segments from the segment map.  */
   4137  1.1     skrll 
   4138  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   4139  1.1     skrll elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
   4140  1.1     skrll 			struct bfd_link_info *info,
   4141  1.1     skrll 			bfd_boolean remove_empty_load)
   4142  1.1     skrll {
   4143  1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map **m;
   4144  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   4145  1.1     skrll 
   4146  1.1     skrll   /* The placement algorithm assumes that non allocated sections are
   4147  1.1     skrll      not in PT_LOAD segments.  We ensure this here by removing such
   4148  1.1     skrll      sections from the segment map.  We also remove excluded
   4149  1.6  christos      sections.  Finally, any PT_LOAD segment without sections is
   4150  1.1     skrll      removed.  */
   4151  1.1     skrll   m = &elf_seg_map (abfd);
   4152  1.1     skrll   while (*m)
   4153  1.1     skrll     {
   4154  1.1     skrll       unsigned int i, new_count;
   4155  1.1     skrll 
   4156  1.1     skrll       for (new_count = 0, i = 0; i < (*m)->count; i++)
   4157  1.1     skrll 	{
   4158  1.1     skrll 	  if (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
   4159  1.1     skrll 	      && (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
   4160  1.1     skrll 		  || (*m)->p_type != PT_LOAD))
   4161  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4162  1.1     skrll 	      (*m)->sections[new_count] = (*m)->sections[i];
   4163  1.1     skrll 	      new_count++;
   4164  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4165  1.1     skrll 	}
   4166  1.1     skrll       (*m)->count = new_count;
   4167  1.1     skrll 
   4168  1.1     skrll       if (remove_empty_load && (*m)->p_type == PT_LOAD && (*m)->count == 0)
   4169  1.1     skrll 	*m = (*m)->next;
   4170  1.1     skrll       else
   4171  1.1     skrll 	m = &(*m)->next;
   4172  1.1     skrll     }
   4173  1.1     skrll 
   4174  1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   4175  1.1     skrll   if (bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map != NULL)
   4176  1.1     skrll     {
   4177  1.1     skrll       if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map) (abfd, info))
   4178  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   4179  1.1     skrll     }
   4180  1.1     skrll 
   4181  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   4182  1.1     skrll }
   4183  1.1     skrll 
   4184  1.1     skrll /* Set up a mapping from BFD sections to program segments.  */
   4185  1.1     skrll 
   4186  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   4187  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   4188  1.1     skrll {
   4189  1.1     skrll   unsigned int count;
   4190  1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *m;
   4191  1.1     skrll   asection **sections = NULL;
   4192  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   4193  1.6  christos   bfd_boolean no_user_phdrs;
   4194  1.5  christos 
   4195  1.5  christos   no_user_phdrs = elf_seg_map (abfd) == NULL;
   4196  1.5  christos 
   4197  1.5  christos   if (info != NULL)
   4198  1.1     skrll     info->user_phdrs = !no_user_phdrs;
   4199  1.1     skrll 
   4200  1.1     skrll   if (no_user_phdrs && bfd_count_sections (abfd) != 0)
   4201  1.1     skrll     {
   4202  1.1     skrll       asection *s;
   4203  1.1     skrll       unsigned int i;
   4204  1.1     skrll       struct elf_segment_map *mfirst;
   4205  1.1     skrll       struct elf_segment_map **pm;
   4206  1.1     skrll       asection *last_hdr;
   4207  1.1     skrll       bfd_vma last_size;
   4208  1.1     skrll       unsigned int phdr_index;
   4209  1.1     skrll       bfd_vma maxpagesize;
   4210  1.1     skrll       asection **hdrpp;
   4211  1.1     skrll       bfd_boolean phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
   4212  1.1     skrll       bfd_boolean writable;
   4213  1.1     skrll       int tls_count = 0;
   4214  1.1     skrll       asection *first_tls = NULL;
   4215  1.3  christos       asection *dynsec, *eh_frame_hdr;
   4216  1.1     skrll       bfd_size_type amt;
   4217  1.1     skrll       bfd_vma addr_mask, wrap_to = 0;
   4218  1.1     skrll 
   4219  1.3  christos       /* Select the allocated sections, and sort them.  */
   4220  1.3  christos 
   4221  1.1     skrll       sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (bfd_count_sections (abfd),
   4222  1.1     skrll                                             sizeof (asection *));
   4223  1.1     skrll       if (sections == NULL)
   4224  1.3  christos 	goto error_return;
   4225  1.3  christos 
   4226  1.3  christos       /* Calculate top address, avoiding undefined behaviour of shift
   4227  1.3  christos 	 left operator when shift count is equal to size of type
   4228  1.3  christos 	 being shifted.  */
   4229  1.3  christos       addr_mask = ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) - 1)) - 1;
   4230  1.1     skrll       addr_mask = (addr_mask << 1) + 1;
   4231  1.1     skrll 
   4232  1.1     skrll       i = 0;
   4233  1.1     skrll       for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   4234  1.1     skrll 	{
   4235  1.1     skrll 	  if ((s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
   4236  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4237  1.3  christos 	      sections[i] = s;
   4238  1.3  christos 	      ++i;
   4239  1.3  christos 	      /* A wrapping section potentially clashes with header.  */
   4240  1.1     skrll 	      if (((s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask) < (s->lma & addr_mask))
   4241  1.1     skrll 		wrap_to = (s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask;
   4242  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4243  1.1     skrll 	}
   4244  1.1     skrll       BFD_ASSERT (i <= bfd_count_sections (abfd));
   4245  1.1     skrll       count = i;
   4246  1.1     skrll 
   4247  1.1     skrll       qsort (sections, (size_t) count, sizeof (asection *), elf_sort_sections);
   4248  1.1     skrll 
   4249  1.1     skrll       /* Build the mapping.  */
   4250  1.1     skrll 
   4251  1.1     skrll       mfirst = NULL;
   4252  1.1     skrll       pm = &mfirst;
   4253  1.1     skrll 
   4254  1.1     skrll       /* If we have a .interp section, then create a PT_PHDR segment for
   4255  1.1     skrll 	 the program headers and a PT_INTERP segment for the .interp
   4256  1.1     skrll 	 section.  */
   4257  1.1     skrll       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
   4258  1.1     skrll       if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
   4259  1.3  christos 	{
   4260  1.1     skrll 	  amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   4261  1.1     skrll 	  m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   4262  1.1     skrll 	  if (m == NULL)
   4263  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return;
   4264  1.1     skrll 	  m->next = NULL;
   4265  1.1     skrll 	  m->p_type = PT_PHDR;
   4266  1.1     skrll 	  /* FIXME: UnixWare and Solaris set PF_X, Irix 5 does not.  */
   4267  1.1     skrll 	  m->p_flags = PF_R | PF_X;
   4268  1.1     skrll 	  m->p_flags_valid = 1;
   4269  1.1     skrll 	  m->includes_phdrs = 1;
   4270  1.1     skrll 
   4271  1.1     skrll 	  *pm = m;
   4272  1.1     skrll 	  pm = &m->next;
   4273  1.3  christos 
   4274  1.1     skrll 	  amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   4275  1.1     skrll 	  m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   4276  1.1     skrll 	  if (m == NULL)
   4277  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return;
   4278  1.1     skrll 	  m->next = NULL;
   4279  1.1     skrll 	  m->p_type = PT_INTERP;
   4280  1.1     skrll 	  m->count = 1;
   4281  1.1     skrll 	  m->sections[0] = s;
   4282  1.1     skrll 
   4283  1.1     skrll 	  *pm = m;
   4284  1.1     skrll 	  pm = &m->next;
   4285  1.1     skrll 	}
   4286  1.1     skrll 
   4287  1.1     skrll       /* Look through the sections.  We put sections in the same program
   4288  1.1     skrll 	 segment when the start of the second section can be placed within
   4289  1.1     skrll 	 a few bytes of the end of the first section.  */
   4290  1.1     skrll       last_hdr = NULL;
   4291  1.1     skrll       last_size = 0;
   4292  1.6  christos       phdr_index = 0;
   4293  1.6  christos       maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
   4294  1.6  christos       /* PR 17512: file: c8455299.
   4295  1.6  christos 	 Avoid divide-by-zero errors later on.
   4296  1.6  christos 	 FIXME: Should we abort if the maxpagesize is zero ?  */
   4297  1.1     skrll       if (maxpagesize == 0)
   4298  1.1     skrll 	maxpagesize = 1;
   4299  1.1     skrll       writable = FALSE;
   4300  1.1     skrll       dynsec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
   4301  1.1     skrll       if (dynsec != NULL
   4302  1.1     skrll 	  && (dynsec->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
   4303  1.1     skrll 	dynsec = NULL;
   4304  1.1     skrll 
   4305  1.1     skrll       /* Deal with -Ttext or something similar such that the first section
   4306  1.1     skrll 	 is not adjacent to the program headers.  This is an
   4307  1.1     skrll 	 approximation, since at this point we don't know exactly how many
   4308  1.1     skrll 	 program headers we will need.  */
   4309  1.6  christos       if (count > 0)
   4310  1.1     skrll 	{
   4311  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
   4312  1.1     skrll 
   4313  1.5  christos 	  if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
   4314  1.1     skrll 	    phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
   4315  1.3  christos 	  phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   4316  1.3  christos 	  if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0
   4317  1.3  christos 	      || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) < phdr_size
   4318  1.3  christos 	      || ((sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) % maxpagesize
   4319  1.1     skrll 		  < phdr_size % maxpagesize)
   4320  1.1     skrll 	      || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask & -maxpagesize) < wrap_to)
   4321  1.1     skrll 	    phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
   4322  1.1     skrll 	}
   4323  1.1     skrll 
   4324  1.1     skrll       for (i = 0, hdrpp = sections; i < count; i++, hdrpp++)
   4325  1.1     skrll 	{
   4326  1.1     skrll 	  asection *hdr;
   4327  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_boolean new_segment;
   4328  1.1     skrll 
   4329  1.1     skrll 	  hdr = *hdrpp;
   4330  1.1     skrll 
   4331  1.1     skrll 	  /* See if this section and the last one will fit in the same
   4332  1.1     skrll 	     segment.  */
   4333  1.1     skrll 
   4334  1.1     skrll 	  if (last_hdr == NULL)
   4335  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4336  1.1     skrll 	      /* If we don't have a segment yet, then we don't need a new
   4337  1.1     skrll 		 one (we build the last one after this loop).  */
   4338  1.1     skrll 	      new_segment = FALSE;
   4339  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4340  1.1     skrll 	  else if (last_hdr->lma - last_hdr->vma != hdr->lma - hdr->vma)
   4341  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4342  1.1     skrll 	      /* If this section has a different relation between the
   4343  1.1     skrll 		 virtual address and the load address, then we need a new
   4344  1.1     skrll 		 segment.  */
   4345  1.3  christos 	      new_segment = TRUE;
   4346  1.3  christos 	    }
   4347  1.3  christos 	  else if (hdr->lma < last_hdr->lma + last_size
   4348  1.3  christos 		   || last_hdr->lma + last_size < last_hdr->lma)
   4349  1.3  christos 	    {
   4350  1.3  christos 	      /* If this section has a load address that makes it overlap
   4351  1.3  christos 		 the previous section, then we need a new segment.  */
   4352  1.1     skrll 	      new_segment = TRUE;
   4353  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4354  1.1     skrll 	  /* In the next test we have to be careful when last_hdr->lma is close
   4355  1.1     skrll 	     to the end of the address space.  If the aligned address wraps
   4356  1.1     skrll 	     around to the start of the address space, then there are no more
   4357  1.1     skrll 	     pages left in memory and it is OK to assume that the current
   4358  1.1     skrll 	     section can be included in the current segment.  */
   4359  1.1     skrll 	  else if ((BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize) + maxpagesize
   4360  1.1     skrll 		    > last_hdr->lma)
   4361  1.1     skrll 		   && (BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize) + maxpagesize
   4362  1.1     skrll 		       <= hdr->lma))
   4363  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4364  1.1     skrll 	      /* If putting this section in this segment would force us to
   4365  1.1     skrll 		 skip a page in the segment, then we need a new segment.  */
   4366  1.1     skrll 	      new_segment = TRUE;
   4367  1.6  christos 	    }
   4368  1.6  christos 	  else if ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0
   4369  1.6  christos 		   && (hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) != 0
   4370  1.6  christos 		   && ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0
   4371  1.6  christos 		       || (((last_hdr->lma + last_size - 1) & -maxpagesize)
   4372  1.6  christos 			   != (hdr->lma & -maxpagesize))))
   4373  1.6  christos 	    {
   4374  1.6  christos 	      /* We don't want to put a loaded section after a
   4375  1.6  christos 		 nonloaded (ie. bss style) section in the same segment
   4376  1.6  christos 		 as that will force the non-loaded section to be loaded.
   4377  1.6  christos 		 Consider .tbss sections as loaded for this purpose.
   4378  1.6  christos 		 However, like the writable/non-writable case below,
   4379  1.1     skrll 		 if they are on the same page then they must be put
   4380  1.1     skrll 		 in the same segment.  */
   4381  1.1     skrll 	      new_segment = TRUE;
   4382  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4383  1.1     skrll 	  else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0)
   4384  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4385  1.1     skrll 	      /* If the file is not demand paged, which means that we
   4386  1.1     skrll 		 don't require the sections to be correctly aligned in the
   4387  1.1     skrll 		 file, then there is no other reason for a new segment.  */
   4388  1.1     skrll 	      new_segment = FALSE;
   4389  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4390  1.3  christos 	  else if (! writable
   4391  1.3  christos 		   && (hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0
   4392  1.1     skrll 		   && (((last_hdr->lma + last_size - 1) & -maxpagesize)
   4393  1.1     skrll 		       != (hdr->lma & -maxpagesize)))
   4394  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4395  1.1     skrll 	      /* We don't want to put a writable section in a read only
   4396  1.1     skrll 		 segment, unless they are on the same page in memory
   4397  1.1     skrll 		 anyhow.  We already know that the last section does not
   4398  1.1     skrll 		 bring us past the current section on the page, so the
   4399  1.1     skrll 		 only case in which the new section is not on the same
   4400  1.1     skrll 		 page as the previous section is when the previous section
   4401  1.1     skrll 		 ends precisely on a page boundary.  */
   4402  1.1     skrll 	      new_segment = TRUE;
   4403  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4404  1.1     skrll 	  else
   4405  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4406  1.1     skrll 	      /* Otherwise, we can use the same segment.  */
   4407  1.1     skrll 	      new_segment = FALSE;
   4408  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4409  1.1     skrll 
   4410  1.1     skrll 	  /* Allow interested parties a chance to override our decision.  */
   4411  1.1     skrll 	  if (last_hdr != NULL
   4412  1.1     skrll 	      && info != NULL
   4413  1.1     skrll 	      && info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment != NULL)
   4414  1.1     skrll 	    new_segment
   4415  1.1     skrll 	      = info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment (info, abfd, hdr,
   4416  1.1     skrll 							      last_hdr,
   4417  1.1     skrll 							      new_segment);
   4418  1.1     skrll 
   4419  1.1     skrll 	  if (! new_segment)
   4420  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4421  1.1     skrll 	      if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
   4422  1.1     skrll 		writable = TRUE;
   4423  1.1     skrll 	      last_hdr = hdr;
   4424  1.1     skrll 	      /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size.  */
   4425  1.1     skrll 	      if ((hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD))
   4426  1.1     skrll 		  != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
   4427  1.1     skrll 		last_size = hdr->size;
   4428  1.1     skrll 	      else
   4429  1.1     skrll 		last_size = 0;
   4430  1.1     skrll 	      continue;
   4431  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4432  1.1     skrll 
   4433  1.1     skrll 	  /* We need a new program segment.  We must create a new program
   4434  1.1     skrll 	     header holding all the sections from phdr_index until hdr.  */
   4435  1.1     skrll 
   4436  1.1     skrll 	  m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
   4437  1.1     skrll 	  if (m == NULL)
   4438  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return;
   4439  1.1     skrll 
   4440  1.1     skrll 	  *pm = m;
   4441  1.1     skrll 	  pm = &m->next;
   4442  1.1     skrll 
   4443  1.1     skrll 	  if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
   4444  1.1     skrll 	    writable = TRUE;
   4445  1.1     skrll 	  else
   4446  1.1     skrll 	    writable = FALSE;
   4447  1.1     skrll 
   4448  1.1     skrll 	  last_hdr = hdr;
   4449  1.1     skrll 	  /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size.  */
   4450  1.1     skrll 	  if ((hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD)) != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
   4451  1.1     skrll 	    last_size = hdr->size;
   4452  1.1     skrll 	  else
   4453  1.1     skrll 	    last_size = 0;
   4454  1.1     skrll 	  phdr_index = i;
   4455  1.1     skrll 	  phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
   4456  1.3  christos 	}
   4457  1.3  christos 
   4458  1.3  christos       /* Create a final PT_LOAD program segment, but not if it's just
   4459  1.3  christos 	 for .tbss.  */
   4460  1.3  christos       if (last_hdr != NULL
   4461  1.3  christos 	  && (i - phdr_index != 1
   4462  1.1     skrll 	      || ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD))
   4463  1.1     skrll 		  != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)))
   4464  1.1     skrll 	{
   4465  1.1     skrll 	  m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
   4466  1.1     skrll 	  if (m == NULL)
   4467  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return;
   4468  1.1     skrll 
   4469  1.1     skrll 	  *pm = m;
   4470  1.1     skrll 	  pm = &m->next;
   4471  1.1     skrll 	}
   4472  1.1     skrll 
   4473  1.1     skrll       /* If there is a .dynamic section, throw in a PT_DYNAMIC segment.  */
   4474  1.1     skrll       if (dynsec != NULL)
   4475  1.1     skrll 	{
   4476  1.1     skrll 	  m = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (abfd, dynsec);
   4477  1.1     skrll 	  if (m == NULL)
   4478  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return;
   4479  1.1     skrll 	  *pm = m;
   4480  1.1     skrll 	  pm = &m->next;
   4481  1.1     skrll 	}
   4482  1.1     skrll 
   4483  1.1     skrll       /* For each batch of consecutive loadable .note sections,
   4484  1.1     skrll 	 add a PT_NOTE segment.  We don't use bfd_get_section_by_name,
   4485  1.1     skrll 	 because if we link together nonloadable .note sections and
   4486  1.1     skrll 	 loadable .note sections, we will generate two .note sections
   4487  1.1     skrll 	 in the output file.  FIXME: Using names for section types is
   4488  1.1     skrll 	 bogus anyhow.  */
   4489  1.1     skrll       for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   4490  1.1     skrll 	{
   4491  1.1     skrll 	  if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
   4492  1.1     skrll 	      && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
   4493  1.3  christos 	    {
   4494  1.3  christos 	      asection *s2;
   4495  1.1     skrll 
   4496  1.1     skrll 	      count = 1;
   4497  1.1     skrll 	      amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   4498  1.1     skrll 	      if (s->alignment_power == 2)
   4499  1.1     skrll 		for (s2 = s; s2->next != NULL; s2 = s2->next)
   4500  1.1     skrll 		  {
   4501  1.1     skrll 		    if (s2->next->alignment_power == 2
   4502  1.3  christos 			&& (s2->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
   4503  1.3  christos 			&& CONST_STRNEQ (s2->next->name, ".note")
   4504  1.1     skrll 			&& align_power (s2->lma + s2->size, 2)
   4505  1.1     skrll 			   == s2->next->lma)
   4506  1.1     skrll 		      count++;
   4507  1.1     skrll 		    else
   4508  1.1     skrll 		      break;
   4509  1.3  christos 		  }
   4510  1.1     skrll 	      amt += (count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
   4511  1.1     skrll 	      m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   4512  1.1     skrll 	      if (m == NULL)
   4513  1.1     skrll 		goto error_return;
   4514  1.1     skrll 	      m->next = NULL;
   4515  1.1     skrll 	      m->p_type = PT_NOTE;
   4516  1.1     skrll 	      m->count = count;
   4517  1.1     skrll 	      while (count > 1)
   4518  1.1     skrll 		{
   4519  1.1     skrll 		  m->sections[m->count - count--] = s;
   4520  1.1     skrll 		  BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
   4521  1.1     skrll 		  s = s->next;
   4522  1.1     skrll 		}
   4523  1.1     skrll 	      m->sections[m->count - 1] = s;
   4524  1.1     skrll 	      BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
   4525  1.1     skrll 	      *pm = m;
   4526  1.1     skrll 	      pm = &m->next;
   4527  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4528  1.1     skrll 	  if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
   4529  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4530  1.1     skrll 	      if (! tls_count)
   4531  1.1     skrll 		first_tls = s;
   4532  1.1     skrll 	      tls_count++;
   4533  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4534  1.1     skrll 	}
   4535  1.1     skrll 
   4536  1.1     skrll       /* If there are any SHF_TLS output sections, add PT_TLS segment.  */
   4537  1.1     skrll       if (tls_count > 0)
   4538  1.1     skrll 	{
   4539  1.3  christos 	  amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   4540  1.1     skrll 	  amt += (tls_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
   4541  1.1     skrll 	  m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   4542  1.1     skrll 	  if (m == NULL)
   4543  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return;
   4544  1.1     skrll 	  m->next = NULL;
   4545  1.1     skrll 	  m->p_type = PT_TLS;
   4546  1.1     skrll 	  m->count = tls_count;
   4547  1.1     skrll 	  /* Mandated PF_R.  */
   4548  1.6  christos 	  m->p_flags = PF_R;
   4549  1.3  christos 	  m->p_flags_valid = 1;
   4550  1.1     skrll 	  s = first_tls;
   4551  1.6  christos 	  for (i = 0; i < (unsigned int) tls_count; ++i)
   4552  1.6  christos 	    {
   4553  1.6  christos 	      if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0)
   4554  1.6  christos 		{
   4555  1.6  christos 		  _bfd_error_handler
   4556  1.6  christos 		    (_("%B: TLS sections are not adjacent:"), abfd);
   4557  1.6  christos 		  s = first_tls;
   4558  1.6  christos 		  i = 0;
   4559  1.6  christos 		  while (i < (unsigned int) tls_count)
   4560  1.6  christos 		    {
   4561  1.6  christos 		      if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
   4562  1.6  christos 			{
   4563  1.6  christos 			  _bfd_error_handler (_("	    TLS: %A"), s);
   4564  1.6  christos 			  i++;
   4565  1.6  christos 			}
   4566  1.6  christos 		      else
   4567  1.6  christos 			_bfd_error_handler (_("	non-TLS: %A"), s);
   4568  1.6  christos 		      s = s->next;
   4569  1.6  christos 		    }
   4570  1.6  christos 		  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   4571  1.6  christos 		  goto error_return;
   4572  1.6  christos 		}
   4573  1.1     skrll 	      m->sections[i] = s;
   4574  1.1     skrll 	      s = s->next;
   4575  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4576  1.1     skrll 
   4577  1.1     skrll 	  *pm = m;
   4578  1.1     skrll 	  pm = &m->next;
   4579  1.1     skrll 	}
   4580  1.1     skrll 
   4581  1.6  christos       /* If there is a .eh_frame_hdr section, throw in a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
   4582  1.1     skrll 	 segment.  */
   4583  1.1     skrll       eh_frame_hdr = elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd);
   4584  1.1     skrll       if (eh_frame_hdr != NULL
   4585  1.1     skrll 	  && (eh_frame_hdr->output_section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
   4586  1.3  christos 	{
   4587  1.1     skrll 	  amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   4588  1.1     skrll 	  m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   4589  1.1     skrll 	  if (m == NULL)
   4590  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return;
   4591  1.1     skrll 	  m->next = NULL;
   4592  1.1     skrll 	  m->p_type = PT_GNU_EH_FRAME;
   4593  1.1     skrll 	  m->count = 1;
   4594  1.1     skrll 	  m->sections[0] = eh_frame_hdr->output_section;
   4595  1.1     skrll 
   4596  1.1     skrll 	  *pm = m;
   4597  1.1     skrll 	  pm = &m->next;
   4598  1.6  christos 	}
   4599  1.1     skrll 
   4600  1.1     skrll       if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
   4601  1.3  christos 	{
   4602  1.1     skrll 	  amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   4603  1.1     skrll 	  m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   4604  1.1     skrll 	  if (m == NULL)
   4605  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return;
   4606  1.6  christos 	  m->next = NULL;
   4607  1.6  christos 	  m->p_type = PT_GNU_STACK;
   4608  1.1     skrll 	  m->p_flags = elf_stack_flags (abfd);
   4609  1.6  christos 	  m->p_align = bed->stack_align;
   4610  1.6  christos 	  m->p_flags_valid = 1;
   4611  1.6  christos 	  m->p_align_valid = m->p_align != 0;
   4612  1.6  christos 	  if (info->stacksize > 0)
   4613  1.6  christos 	    {
   4614  1.6  christos 	      m->p_size = info->stacksize;
   4615  1.1     skrll 	      m->p_size_valid = 1;
   4616  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4617  1.1     skrll 
   4618  1.1     skrll 	  *pm = m;
   4619  1.1     skrll 	  pm = &m->next;
   4620  1.1     skrll 	}
   4621  1.1     skrll 
   4622  1.1     skrll       if (info != NULL && info->relro)
   4623  1.1     skrll 	{
   4624  1.5  christos 	  for (m = mfirst; m != NULL; m = m->next)
   4625  1.5  christos 	    {
   4626  1.5  christos 	      if (m->p_type == PT_LOAD
   4627  1.5  christos 		  && m->count != 0
   4628  1.5  christos 		  && m->sections[0]->vma >= info->relro_start
   4629  1.5  christos 		  && m->sections[0]->vma < info->relro_end)
   4630  1.5  christos 		{
   4631  1.5  christos 		  i = m->count;
   4632  1.5  christos 		  while (--i != (unsigned) -1)
   4633  1.5  christos 		    if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
   4634  1.5  christos 			== (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
   4635  1.6  christos 		      break;
   4636  1.1     skrll 
   4637  1.1     skrll 		  if (i != (unsigned) -1)
   4638  1.5  christos 		    break;
   4639  1.1     skrll 		}
   4640  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4641  1.1     skrll 
   4642  1.1     skrll 	  /* Make a PT_GNU_RELRO segment only when it isn't empty.  */
   4643  1.1     skrll 	  if (m != NULL)
   4644  1.3  christos 	    {
   4645  1.1     skrll 	      amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   4646  1.1     skrll 	      m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   4647  1.1     skrll 	      if (m == NULL)
   4648  1.1     skrll 		goto error_return;
   4649  1.1     skrll 	      m->next = NULL;
   4650  1.1     skrll 	      m->p_type = PT_GNU_RELRO;
   4651  1.1     skrll 	      *pm = m;
   4652  1.1     skrll 	      pm = &m->next;
   4653  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4654  1.1     skrll 	}
   4655  1.6  christos 
   4656  1.1     skrll       free (sections);
   4657  1.1     skrll       elf_seg_map (abfd) = mfirst;
   4658  1.1     skrll     }
   4659  1.1     skrll 
   4660  1.1     skrll   if (!elf_modify_segment_map (abfd, info, no_user_phdrs))
   4661  1.6  christos     return FALSE;
   4662  1.1     skrll 
   4663  1.6  christos   for (count = 0, m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
   4664  1.1     skrll     ++count;
   4665  1.1     skrll   elf_program_header_size (abfd) = count * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
   4666  1.1     skrll 
   4667  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   4668  1.1     skrll 
   4669  1.1     skrll  error_return:
   4670  1.1     skrll   if (sections != NULL)
   4671  1.1     skrll     free (sections);
   4672  1.1     skrll   return FALSE;
   4673  1.1     skrll }
   4674  1.1     skrll 
   4675  1.1     skrll /* Sort sections by address.  */
   4676  1.1     skrll 
   4677  1.1     skrll static int
   4678  1.1     skrll elf_sort_sections (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
   4679  1.1     skrll {
   4680  1.1     skrll   const asection *sec1 = *(const asection **) arg1;
   4681  1.1     skrll   const asection *sec2 = *(const asection **) arg2;
   4682  1.1     skrll   bfd_size_type size1, size2;
   4683  1.1     skrll 
   4684  1.1     skrll   /* Sort by LMA first, since this is the address used to
   4685  1.1     skrll      place the section into a segment.  */
   4686  1.1     skrll   if (sec1->lma < sec2->lma)
   4687  1.1     skrll     return -1;
   4688  1.1     skrll   else if (sec1->lma > sec2->lma)
   4689  1.1     skrll     return 1;
   4690  1.1     skrll 
   4691  1.1     skrll   /* Then sort by VMA.  Normally the LMA and the VMA will be
   4692  1.1     skrll      the same, and this will do nothing.  */
   4693  1.1     skrll   if (sec1->vma < sec2->vma)
   4694  1.1     skrll     return -1;
   4695  1.1     skrll   else if (sec1->vma > sec2->vma)
   4696  1.1     skrll     return 1;
   4697  1.1     skrll 
   4698  1.1     skrll   /* Put !SEC_LOAD sections after SEC_LOAD ones.  */
   4699  1.1     skrll 
   4700  1.1     skrll #define TOEND(x) (((x)->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0)
   4701  1.1     skrll 
   4702  1.1     skrll   if (TOEND (sec1))
   4703  1.1     skrll     {
   4704  1.1     skrll       if (TOEND (sec2))
   4705  1.1     skrll 	{
   4706  1.1     skrll 	  /* If the indicies are the same, do not return 0
   4707  1.1     skrll 	     here, but continue to try the next comparison.  */
   4708  1.1     skrll 	  if (sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index != 0)
   4709  1.1     skrll 	    return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
   4710  1.1     skrll 	}
   4711  1.1     skrll       else
   4712  1.1     skrll 	return 1;
   4713  1.1     skrll     }
   4714  1.1     skrll   else if (TOEND (sec2))
   4715  1.1     skrll     return -1;
   4716  1.1     skrll 
   4717  1.1     skrll #undef TOEND
   4718  1.1     skrll 
   4719  1.1     skrll   /* Sort by size, to put zero sized sections
   4720  1.1     skrll      before others at the same address.  */
   4721  1.1     skrll 
   4722  1.1     skrll   size1 = (sec1->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec1->size : 0;
   4723  1.1     skrll   size2 = (sec2->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec2->size : 0;
   4724  1.1     skrll 
   4725  1.1     skrll   if (size1 < size2)
   4726  1.1     skrll     return -1;
   4727  1.1     skrll   if (size1 > size2)
   4728  1.1     skrll     return 1;
   4729  1.1     skrll 
   4730  1.1     skrll   return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
   4731  1.1     skrll }
   4732  1.1     skrll 
   4733  1.1     skrll /* Ian Lance Taylor writes:
   4734  1.1     skrll 
   4735  1.1     skrll    We shouldn't be using % with a negative signed number.  That's just
   4736  1.1     skrll    not good.  We have to make sure either that the number is not
   4737  1.1     skrll    negative, or that the number has an unsigned type.  When the types
   4738  1.1     skrll    are all the same size they wind up as unsigned.  When file_ptr is a
   4739  1.1     skrll    larger signed type, the arithmetic winds up as signed long long,
   4740  1.1     skrll    which is wrong.
   4741  1.1     skrll 
   4742  1.1     skrll    What we're trying to say here is something like ``increase OFF by
   4743  1.1     skrll    the least amount that will cause it to be equal to the VMA modulo
   4744  1.1     skrll    the page size.''  */
   4745  1.1     skrll /* In other words, something like:
   4746  1.1     skrll 
   4747  1.1     skrll    vma_offset = m->sections[0]->vma % bed->maxpagesize;
   4748  1.1     skrll    off_offset = off % bed->maxpagesize;
   4749  1.1     skrll    if (vma_offset < off_offset)
   4750  1.1     skrll      adjustment = vma_offset + bed->maxpagesize - off_offset;
   4751  1.1     skrll    else
   4752  1.1     skrll      adjustment = vma_offset - off_offset;
   4753  1.1     skrll 
   4754  1.1     skrll    which can can be collapsed into the expression below.  */
   4755  1.1     skrll 
   4756  1.1     skrll static file_ptr
   4757  1.6  christos vma_page_aligned_bias (bfd_vma vma, ufile_ptr off, bfd_vma maxpagesize)
   4758  1.6  christos {
   4759  1.6  christos   /* PR binutils/16199: Handle an alignment of zero.  */
   4760  1.1     skrll   if (maxpagesize == 0)
   4761  1.1     skrll     maxpagesize = 1;
   4762  1.1     skrll   return ((vma - off) % maxpagesize);
   4763  1.1     skrll }
   4764  1.1     skrll 
   4765  1.1     skrll static void
   4766  1.1     skrll print_segment_map (const struct elf_segment_map *m)
   4767  1.1     skrll {
   4768  1.1     skrll   unsigned int j;
   4769  1.1     skrll   const char *pt = get_segment_type (m->p_type);
   4770  1.1     skrll   char buf[32];
   4771  1.1     skrll 
   4772  1.1     skrll   if (pt == NULL)
   4773  1.1     skrll     {
   4774  1.1     skrll       if (m->p_type >= PT_LOPROC && m->p_type <= PT_HIPROC)
   4775  1.1     skrll 	sprintf (buf, "LOPROC+%7.7x",
   4776  1.1     skrll 		 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOPROC));
   4777  1.1     skrll       else if (m->p_type >= PT_LOOS && m->p_type <= PT_HIOS)
   4778  1.1     skrll 	sprintf (buf, "LOOS+%7.7x",
   4779  1.1     skrll 		 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOOS));
   4780  1.1     skrll       else
   4781  1.1     skrll 	snprintf (buf, sizeof (buf), "%8.8x",
   4782  1.1     skrll 		  (unsigned int) m->p_type);
   4783  1.3  christos       pt = buf;
   4784  1.1     skrll     }
   4785  1.1     skrll   fflush (stdout);
   4786  1.1     skrll   fprintf (stderr, "%s:", pt);
   4787  1.1     skrll   for (j = 0; j < m->count; j++)
   4788  1.3  christos     fprintf (stderr, " %s", m->sections [j]->name);
   4789  1.3  christos   putc ('\n',stderr);
   4790  1.3  christos   fflush (stderr);
   4791  1.3  christos }
   4792  1.3  christos 
   4793  1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   4794  1.3  christos write_zeros (bfd *abfd, file_ptr pos, bfd_size_type len)
   4795  1.3  christos {
   4796  1.3  christos   void *buf;
   4797  1.3  christos   bfd_boolean ret;
   4798  1.3  christos 
   4799  1.3  christos   if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0)
   4800  1.3  christos     return FALSE;
   4801  1.3  christos   buf = bfd_zmalloc (len);
   4802  1.3  christos   if (buf == NULL)
   4803  1.3  christos     return FALSE;
   4804  1.3  christos   ret = bfd_bwrite (buf, len, abfd) == len;
   4805  1.1     skrll   free (buf);
   4806  1.1     skrll   return ret;
   4807  1.1     skrll }
   4808  1.1     skrll 
   4809  1.1     skrll /* Assign file positions to the sections based on the mapping from
   4810  1.1     skrll    sections to segments.  This function also sets up some fields in
   4811  1.1     skrll    the file header.  */
   4812  1.1     skrll 
   4813  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   4814  1.1     skrll assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
   4815  1.1     skrll 					 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
   4816  1.1     skrll {
   4817  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   4818  1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *m;
   4819  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
   4820  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
   4821  1.1     skrll   file_ptr off;
   4822  1.1     skrll   bfd_size_type maxpagesize;
   4823  1.2     skrll   unsigned int alloc;
   4824  1.1     skrll   unsigned int i, j;
   4825  1.1     skrll   bfd_vma header_pad = 0;
   4826  1.1     skrll 
   4827  1.1     skrll   if (link_info == NULL
   4828  1.1     skrll       && !_bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (abfd, link_info))
   4829  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   4830  1.6  christos 
   4831  1.2     skrll   alloc = 0;
   4832  1.2     skrll   for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
   4833  1.2     skrll     {
   4834  1.2     skrll       ++alloc;
   4835  1.2     skrll       if (m->header_size)
   4836  1.1     skrll 	header_pad = m->header_size;
   4837  1.5  christos     }
   4838  1.5  christos 
   4839  1.5  christos   if (alloc)
   4840  1.5  christos     {
   4841  1.5  christos       elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   4842  1.5  christos       elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
   4843  1.5  christos     }
   4844  1.5  christos   else
   4845  1.5  christos     {
   4846  1.5  christos       /* PR binutils/12467.  */
   4847  1.5  christos       elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = 0;
   4848  1.5  christos       elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = 0;
   4849  1.1     skrll     }
   4850  1.1     skrll 
   4851  1.6  christos   elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum = alloc;
   4852  1.6  christos 
   4853  1.1     skrll   if (elf_program_header_size (abfd) == (bfd_size_type) -1)
   4854  1.6  christos     elf_program_header_size (abfd) = alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
   4855  1.1     skrll   else
   4856  1.1     skrll     BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd)
   4857  1.1     skrll 		>= alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr);
   4858  1.1     skrll 
   4859  1.6  christos   if (alloc == 0)
   4860  1.1     skrll     {
   4861  1.1     skrll       elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   4862  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   4863  1.6  christos     }
   4864  1.2     skrll 
   4865  1.2     skrll   /* We're writing the size in elf_program_header_size (abfd),
   4866  1.6  christos      see assign_file_positions_except_relocs, so make sure we have
   4867  1.6  christos      that amount allocated, with trailing space cleared.
   4868  1.2     skrll      The variable alloc contains the computed need, while
   4869  1.2     skrll      elf_program_header_size (abfd) contains the size used for the
   4870  1.2     skrll      layout.
   4871  1.2     skrll      See ld/emultempl/elf-generic.em:gld${EMULATION_NAME}_map_segments
   4872  1.6  christos      where the layout is forced to according to a larger size in the
   4873  1.2     skrll      last iterations for the testcase ld-elf/header.  */
   4874  1.3  christos   BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd) % bed->s->sizeof_phdr
   4875  1.3  christos 	      == 0);
   4876  1.6  christos   phdrs = (Elf_Internal_Phdr *)
   4877  1.3  christos      bfd_zalloc2 (abfd,
   4878  1.1     skrll                   (elf_program_header_size (abfd) / bed->s->sizeof_phdr),
   4879  1.1     skrll                   sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
   4880  1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr = phdrs;
   4881  1.1     skrll   if (phdrs == NULL)
   4882  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   4883  1.1     skrll 
   4884  1.1     skrll   maxpagesize = 1;
   4885  1.1     skrll   if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
   4886  1.1     skrll     maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
   4887  1.1     skrll 
   4888  1.2     skrll   off = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   4889  1.2     skrll   off += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
   4890  1.2     skrll   if (header_pad < (bfd_vma) off)
   4891  1.2     skrll     header_pad = 0;
   4892  1.2     skrll   else
   4893  1.1     skrll     header_pad -= off;
   4894  1.6  christos   off += header_pad;
   4895  1.1     skrll 
   4896  1.1     skrll   for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs, j = 0;
   4897  1.1     skrll        m != NULL;
   4898  1.1     skrll        m = m->next, p++, j++)
   4899  1.1     skrll     {
   4900  1.1     skrll       asection **secpp;
   4901  1.1     skrll       bfd_vma off_adjust;
   4902  1.1     skrll       bfd_boolean no_contents;
   4903  1.1     skrll 
   4904  1.1     skrll       /* If elf_segment_map is not from map_sections_to_segments, the
   4905  1.1     skrll 	 sections may not be correctly ordered.  NOTE: sorting should
   4906  1.1     skrll 	 not be done to the PT_NOTE section of a corefile, which may
   4907  1.1     skrll 	 contain several pseudo-sections artificially created by bfd.
   4908  1.1     skrll 	 Sorting these pseudo-sections breaks things badly.  */
   4909  1.1     skrll       if (m->count > 1
   4910  1.1     skrll 	  && !(elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_type == ET_CORE
   4911  1.1     skrll 	       && m->p_type == PT_NOTE))
   4912  1.1     skrll 	qsort (m->sections, (size_t) m->count, sizeof (asection *),
   4913  1.1     skrll 	       elf_sort_sections);
   4914  1.1     skrll 
   4915  1.1     skrll       /* An ELF segment (described by Elf_Internal_Phdr) may contain a
   4916  1.1     skrll 	 number of sections with contents contributing to both p_filesz
   4917  1.1     skrll 	 and p_memsz, followed by a number of sections with no contents
   4918  1.1     skrll 	 that just contribute to p_memsz.  In this loop, OFF tracks next
   4919  1.1     skrll 	 available file offset for PT_LOAD and PT_NOTE segments.  */
   4920  1.1     skrll       p->p_type = m->p_type;
   4921  1.1     skrll       p->p_flags = m->p_flags;
   4922  1.1     skrll 
   4923  1.1     skrll       if (m->count == 0)
   4924  1.1     skrll 	p->p_vaddr = 0;
   4925  1.1     skrll       else
   4926  1.1     skrll 	p->p_vaddr = m->sections[0]->vma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
   4927  1.1     skrll 
   4928  1.1     skrll       if (m->p_paddr_valid)
   4929  1.1     skrll 	p->p_paddr = m->p_paddr;
   4930  1.1     skrll       else if (m->count == 0)
   4931  1.1     skrll 	p->p_paddr = 0;
   4932  1.1     skrll       else
   4933  1.1     skrll 	p->p_paddr = m->sections[0]->lma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
   4934  1.1     skrll 
   4935  1.1     skrll       if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
   4936  1.1     skrll 	  && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
   4937  1.1     skrll 	{
   4938  1.1     skrll 	  /* p_align in demand paged PT_LOAD segments effectively stores
   4939  1.1     skrll 	     the maximum page size.  When copying an executable with
   4940  1.1     skrll 	     objcopy, we set m->p_align from the input file.  Use this
   4941  1.1     skrll 	     value for maxpagesize rather than bed->maxpagesize, which
   4942  1.1     skrll 	     may be different.  Note that we use maxpagesize for PT_TLS
   4943  1.1     skrll 	     segment alignment later in this function, so we are relying
   4944  1.1     skrll 	     on at least one PT_LOAD segment appearing before a PT_TLS
   4945  1.1     skrll 	     segment.  */
   4946  1.1     skrll 	  if (m->p_align_valid)
   4947  1.1     skrll 	    maxpagesize = m->p_align;
   4948  1.1     skrll 
   4949  1.1     skrll 	  p->p_align = maxpagesize;
   4950  1.1     skrll 	}
   4951  1.1     skrll       else if (m->p_align_valid)
   4952  1.1     skrll 	p->p_align = m->p_align;
   4953  1.1     skrll       else if (m->count == 0)
   4954  1.1     skrll 	p->p_align = 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
   4955  1.1     skrll       else
   4956  1.1     skrll 	p->p_align = 0;
   4957  1.1     skrll 
   4958  1.1     skrll       no_contents = FALSE;
   4959  1.1     skrll       off_adjust = 0;
   4960  1.1     skrll       if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
   4961  1.1     skrll 	  && m->count > 0)
   4962  1.1     skrll 	{
   4963  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_size_type align;
   4964  1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int align_power = 0;
   4965  1.1     skrll 
   4966  1.1     skrll 	  if (m->p_align_valid)
   4967  1.1     skrll 	    align = p->p_align;
   4968  1.1     skrll 	  else
   4969  1.1     skrll 	    {
   4970  1.1     skrll 	      for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
   4971  1.1     skrll 		{
   4972  1.1     skrll 		  unsigned int secalign;
   4973  1.1     skrll 
   4974  1.1     skrll 		  secalign = bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, *secpp);
   4975  1.1     skrll 		  if (secalign > align_power)
   4976  1.1     skrll 		    align_power = secalign;
   4977  1.1     skrll 		}
   4978  1.1     skrll 	      align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << align_power;
   4979  1.1     skrll 	      if (align < maxpagesize)
   4980  1.1     skrll 		align = maxpagesize;
   4981  1.1     skrll 	    }
   4982  1.1     skrll 
   4983  1.1     skrll 	  for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
   4984  1.1     skrll 	    if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
   4985  1.1     skrll 	      /* If we aren't making room for this section, then
   4986  1.1     skrll 		 it must be SHT_NOBITS regardless of what we've
   4987  1.1     skrll 		 set via struct bfd_elf_special_section.  */
   4988  1.1     skrll 	      elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOBITS;
   4989  1.1     skrll 
   4990  1.1     skrll 	  /* Find out whether this segment contains any loadable
   4991  1.1     skrll 	     sections.  */
   4992  1.1     skrll 	  no_contents = TRUE;
   4993  1.1     skrll 	  for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
   4994  1.1     skrll 	    if (elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) != SHT_NOBITS)
   4995  1.1     skrll 	      {
   4996  1.1     skrll 		no_contents = FALSE;
   4997  1.1     skrll 		break;
   4998  1.3  christos 	      }
   4999  1.1     skrll 
   5000  1.1     skrll 	  off_adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (p->p_vaddr, off, align);
   5001  1.1     skrll 	  off += off_adjust;
   5002  1.1     skrll 	  if (no_contents)
   5003  1.1     skrll 	    {
   5004  1.1     skrll 	      /* We shouldn't need to align the segment on disk since
   5005  1.1     skrll 		 the segment doesn't need file space, but the gABI
   5006  1.1     skrll 		 arguably requires the alignment and glibc ld.so
   5007  1.1     skrll 		 checks it.  So to comply with the alignment
   5008  1.1     skrll 		 requirement but not waste file space, we adjust
   5009  1.1     skrll 		 p_offset for just this segment.  (OFF_ADJUST is
   5010  1.1     skrll 		 subtracted from OFF later.)  This may put p_offset
   5011  1.1     skrll 		 past the end of file, but that shouldn't matter.  */
   5012  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5013  1.1     skrll 	  else
   5014  1.1     skrll 	    off_adjust = 0;
   5015  1.1     skrll 	}
   5016  1.1     skrll       /* Make sure the .dynamic section is the first section in the
   5017  1.1     skrll 	 PT_DYNAMIC segment.  */
   5018  1.1     skrll       else if (p->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC
   5019  1.1     skrll 	       && m->count > 1
   5020  1.1     skrll 	       && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") != 0)
   5021  1.1     skrll 	{
   5022  1.1     skrll 	  _bfd_error_handler
   5023  1.1     skrll 	    (_("%B: The first section in the PT_DYNAMIC segment is not the .dynamic section"),
   5024  1.1     skrll 	     abfd);
   5025  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   5026  1.1     skrll 	  return FALSE;
   5027  1.1     skrll 	}
   5028  1.1     skrll       /* Set the note section type to SHT_NOTE.  */
   5029  1.1     skrll       else if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE)
   5030  1.1     skrll 	for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
   5031  1.1     skrll 	  elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOTE;
   5032  1.1     skrll 
   5033  1.1     skrll       p->p_offset = 0;
   5034  1.1     skrll       p->p_filesz = 0;
   5035  1.1     skrll       p->p_memsz = 0;
   5036  1.1     skrll 
   5037  1.1     skrll       if (m->includes_filehdr)
   5038  1.1     skrll 	{
   5039  1.1     skrll 	  if (!m->p_flags_valid)
   5040  1.1     skrll 	    p->p_flags |= PF_R;
   5041  1.1     skrll 	  p->p_filesz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   5042  1.1     skrll 	  p->p_memsz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   5043  1.1     skrll 	  if (m->count > 0)
   5044  1.1     skrll 	    {
   5045  1.1     skrll 	      if (p->p_vaddr < (bfd_vma) off)
   5046  1.1     skrll 		{
   5047  1.1     skrll 		  (*_bfd_error_handler)
   5048  1.1     skrll 		    (_("%B: Not enough room for program headers, try linking with -N"),
   5049  1.1     skrll 		     abfd);
   5050  1.1     skrll 		  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   5051  1.1     skrll 		  return FALSE;
   5052  1.1     skrll 		}
   5053  1.1     skrll 
   5054  1.1     skrll 	      p->p_vaddr -= off;
   5055  1.1     skrll 	      if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
   5056  1.1     skrll 		p->p_paddr -= off;
   5057  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5058  1.1     skrll 	}
   5059  1.1     skrll 
   5060  1.1     skrll       if (m->includes_phdrs)
   5061  1.1     skrll 	{
   5062  1.1     skrll 	  if (!m->p_flags_valid)
   5063  1.1     skrll 	    p->p_flags |= PF_R;
   5064  1.1     skrll 
   5065  1.1     skrll 	  if (!m->includes_filehdr)
   5066  1.1     skrll 	    {
   5067  1.1     skrll 	      p->p_offset = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   5068  1.1     skrll 
   5069  1.1     skrll 	      if (m->count > 0)
   5070  1.1     skrll 		{
   5071  1.1     skrll 		  p->p_vaddr -= off - p->p_offset;
   5072  1.1     skrll 		  if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
   5073  1.1     skrll 		    p->p_paddr -= off - p->p_offset;
   5074  1.1     skrll 		}
   5075  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5076  1.1     skrll 
   5077  1.2     skrll 	  p->p_filesz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
   5078  1.2     skrll 	  p->p_memsz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
   5079  1.2     skrll 	  if (m->count)
   5080  1.2     skrll 	    {
   5081  1.2     skrll 	      p->p_filesz += header_pad;
   5082  1.1     skrll 	      p->p_memsz += header_pad;
   5083  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5084  1.1     skrll 	}
   5085  1.1     skrll 
   5086  1.1     skrll       if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
   5087  1.1     skrll 	  || (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core))
   5088  1.1     skrll 	{
   5089  1.1     skrll 	  if (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs)
   5090  1.1     skrll 	    p->p_offset = off;
   5091  1.1     skrll 	  else
   5092  1.1     skrll 	    {
   5093  1.1     skrll 	      file_ptr adjust;
   5094  1.1     skrll 
   5095  1.1     skrll 	      adjust = off - (p->p_offset + p->p_filesz);
   5096  1.1     skrll 	      if (!no_contents)
   5097  1.1     skrll 		p->p_filesz += adjust;
   5098  1.1     skrll 	      p->p_memsz += adjust;
   5099  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5100  1.1     skrll 	}
   5101  1.1     skrll 
   5102  1.1     skrll       /* Set up p_filesz, p_memsz, p_align and p_flags from the section
   5103  1.1     skrll 	 maps.  Set filepos for sections in PT_LOAD segments, and in
   5104  1.1     skrll 	 core files, for sections in PT_NOTE segments.
   5105  1.1     skrll 	 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections will set filepos
   5106  1.1     skrll 	 for other sections and update p_filesz for other segments.  */
   5107  1.1     skrll       for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
   5108  1.1     skrll 	{
   5109  1.1     skrll 	  asection *sec;
   5110  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_size_type align;
   5111  1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
   5112  1.1     skrll 
   5113  1.1     skrll 	  sec = *secpp;
   5114  1.1     skrll 	  this_hdr = &elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr;
   5115  1.1     skrll 	  align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, sec);
   5116  1.1     skrll 
   5117  1.1     skrll 	  if ((p->p_type == PT_LOAD
   5118  1.1     skrll 	       || p->p_type == PT_TLS)
   5119  1.1     skrll 	      && (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
   5120  1.1     skrll 		  || ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
   5121  1.1     skrll 		      && ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0
   5122  1.3  christos 			  || p->p_type == PT_TLS))))
   5123  1.3  christos 	    {
   5124  1.3  christos 	      bfd_vma p_start = p->p_paddr;
   5125  1.3  christos 	      bfd_vma p_end = p_start + p->p_memsz;
   5126  1.3  christos 	      bfd_vma s_start = sec->lma;
   5127  1.3  christos 	      bfd_vma adjust = s_start - p_end;
   5128  1.3  christos 
   5129  1.3  christos 	      if (adjust != 0
   5130  1.1     skrll 		  && (s_start < p_end
   5131  1.1     skrll 		      || p_end < p_start))
   5132  1.3  christos 		{
   5133  1.3  christos 		  (*_bfd_error_handler)
   5134  1.1     skrll 		    (_("%B: section %A lma %#lx adjusted to %#lx"), abfd, sec,
   5135  1.3  christos 		     (unsigned long) s_start, (unsigned long) p_end);
   5136  1.1     skrll 		  adjust = 0;
   5137  1.1     skrll 		  sec->lma = p_end;
   5138  1.1     skrll 		}
   5139  1.1     skrll 	      p->p_memsz += adjust;
   5140  1.1     skrll 
   5141  1.3  christos 	      if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
   5142  1.3  christos 		{
   5143  1.3  christos 		  if (p->p_filesz + adjust < p->p_memsz)
   5144  1.3  christos 		    {
   5145  1.3  christos 		      /* We have a PROGBITS section following NOBITS ones.
   5146  1.3  christos 		         Allocate file space for the NOBITS section(s) and
   5147  1.3  christos 			 zero it.  */
   5148  1.3  christos 		      adjust = p->p_memsz - p->p_filesz;
   5149  1.3  christos 		      if (!write_zeros (abfd, off, adjust))
   5150  1.1     skrll 			return FALSE;
   5151  1.1     skrll 		    }
   5152  1.1     skrll 		  off += adjust;
   5153  1.1     skrll 		  p->p_filesz += adjust;
   5154  1.1     skrll 		}
   5155  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5156  1.1     skrll 
   5157  1.1     skrll 	  if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
   5158  1.1     skrll 	    {
   5159  1.1     skrll 	      /* The section at i == 0 is the one that actually contains
   5160  1.1     skrll 		 everything.  */
   5161  1.1     skrll 	      if (i == 0)
   5162  1.1     skrll 		{
   5163  1.1     skrll 		  this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
   5164  1.1     skrll 		  off += this_hdr->sh_size;
   5165  1.1     skrll 		  p->p_filesz = this_hdr->sh_size;
   5166  1.1     skrll 		  p->p_memsz = 0;
   5167  1.1     skrll 		  p->p_align = 1;
   5168  1.1     skrll 		}
   5169  1.1     skrll 	      else
   5170  1.1     skrll 		{
   5171  1.1     skrll 		  /* The rest are fake sections that shouldn't be written.  */
   5172  1.1     skrll 		  sec->filepos = 0;
   5173  1.1     skrll 		  sec->size = 0;
   5174  1.1     skrll 		  sec->flags = 0;
   5175  1.1     skrll 		  continue;
   5176  1.1     skrll 		}
   5177  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5178  1.1     skrll 	  else
   5179  1.1     skrll 	    {
   5180  1.1     skrll 	      if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
   5181  1.1     skrll 		{
   5182  1.1     skrll 		  this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
   5183  1.1     skrll 		  if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
   5184  1.3  christos 		    off += this_hdr->sh_size;
   5185  1.3  christos 		}
   5186  1.3  christos 	      else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
   5187  1.3  christos 		       && (this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0
   5188  1.3  christos 		       && this_hdr->sh_offset == 0)
   5189  1.3  christos 		{
   5190  1.3  christos 		  /* This is a .tbss section that didn't get a PT_LOAD.
   5191  1.3  christos 		     (See _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments "Create a
   5192  1.3  christos 		     final PT_LOAD".)  Set sh_offset to the value it
   5193  1.3  christos 		     would have if we had created a zero p_filesz and
   5194  1.3  christos 		     p_memsz PT_LOAD header for the section.  This
   5195  1.3  christos 		     also makes the PT_TLS header have the same
   5196  1.3  christos 		     p_offset value.  */
   5197  1.3  christos 		  bfd_vma adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (this_hdr->sh_addr,
   5198  1.3  christos 							  off, align);
   5199  1.1     skrll 		  this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off + adjust;
   5200  1.1     skrll 		}
   5201  1.1     skrll 
   5202  1.1     skrll 	      if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
   5203  1.1     skrll 		{
   5204  1.1     skrll 		  p->p_filesz += this_hdr->sh_size;
   5205  1.1     skrll 		  /* A load section without SHF_ALLOC is something like
   5206  1.1     skrll 		     a note section in a PT_NOTE segment.  These take
   5207  1.1     skrll 		     file space but are not loaded into memory.  */
   5208  1.1     skrll 		  if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
   5209  1.1     skrll 		    p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
   5210  1.1     skrll 		}
   5211  1.1     skrll 	      else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
   5212  1.1     skrll 		{
   5213  1.1     skrll 		  if (p->p_type == PT_TLS)
   5214  1.1     skrll 		    p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
   5215  1.1     skrll 
   5216  1.1     skrll 		  /* .tbss is special.  It doesn't contribute to p_memsz of
   5217  1.1     skrll 		     normal segments.  */
   5218  1.1     skrll 		  else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
   5219  1.1     skrll 		    p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
   5220  1.1     skrll 		}
   5221  1.1     skrll 
   5222  1.1     skrll 	      if (align > p->p_align
   5223  1.1     skrll 		  && !m->p_align_valid
   5224  1.1     skrll 		  && (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
   5225  1.1     skrll 		      || (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0))
   5226  1.1     skrll 		p->p_align = align;
   5227  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5228  1.1     skrll 
   5229  1.1     skrll 	  if (!m->p_flags_valid)
   5230  1.1     skrll 	    {
   5231  1.1     skrll 	      p->p_flags |= PF_R;
   5232  1.1     skrll 	      if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
   5233  1.1     skrll 		p->p_flags |= PF_X;
   5234  1.1     skrll 	      if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) != 0)
   5235  1.1     skrll 		p->p_flags |= PF_W;
   5236  1.6  christos 	    }
   5237  1.1     skrll 	}
   5238  1.1     skrll 
   5239  1.1     skrll       off -= off_adjust;
   5240  1.1     skrll 
   5241  1.1     skrll       /* Check that all sections are in a PT_LOAD segment.
   5242  1.3  christos 	 Don't check funky gdb generated core files.  */
   5243  1.3  christos       if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
   5244  1.1     skrll 	{
   5245  1.3  christos 	  bfd_boolean check_vma = TRUE;
   5246  1.3  christos 
   5247  1.3  christos 	  for (i = 1; i < m->count; i++)
   5248  1.3  christos 	    if (m->sections[i]->vma == m->sections[i - 1]->vma
   5249  1.3  christos 		&& ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i])
   5250  1.3  christos 				       ->this_hdr), p) != 0
   5251  1.1     skrll 		&& ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i - 1])
   5252  1.3  christos 				       ->this_hdr), p) != 0)
   5253  1.3  christos 	      {
   5254  1.3  christos 		/* Looks like we have overlays packed into the segment.  */
   5255  1.1     skrll 		check_vma = FALSE;
   5256  1.3  christos 		break;
   5257  1.3  christos 	      }
   5258  1.3  christos 
   5259  1.3  christos 	  for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
   5260  1.3  christos 	    {
   5261  1.3  christos 	      Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
   5262  1.3  christos 	      asection *sec;
   5263  1.3  christos 
   5264  1.3  christos 	      sec = m->sections[i];
   5265  1.3  christos 	      this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(sec)->this_hdr);
   5266  1.3  christos 	      if (!ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT_1 (this_hdr, p, check_vma, 0)
   5267  1.3  christos 		  && !ELF_TBSS_SPECIAL (this_hdr, p))
   5268  1.3  christos 		{
   5269  1.3  christos 		  (*_bfd_error_handler)
   5270  1.3  christos 		    (_("%B: section `%A' can't be allocated in segment %d"),
   5271  1.3  christos 		     abfd, sec, j);
   5272  1.3  christos 		  print_segment_map (m);
   5273  1.3  christos 		}
   5274  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5275  1.1     skrll 	}
   5276  1.6  christos     }
   5277  1.1     skrll 
   5278  1.1     skrll   elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
   5279  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   5280  1.1     skrll }
   5281  1.1     skrll 
   5282  1.1     skrll /* Assign file positions for the other sections.  */
   5283  1.1     skrll 
   5284  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   5285  1.1     skrll assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
   5286  1.1     skrll 					     struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
   5287  1.1     skrll {
   5288  1.6  christos   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   5289  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrpp;
   5290  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp, **end_hdrpp;
   5291  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
   5292  1.5  christos   Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
   5293  1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *m;
   5294  1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *hdrs_segment;
   5295  1.1     skrll   bfd_vma filehdr_vaddr, filehdr_paddr;
   5296  1.1     skrll   bfd_vma phdrs_vaddr, phdrs_paddr;
   5297  1.1     skrll   file_ptr off;
   5298  1.1     skrll   unsigned int count;
   5299  1.6  christos 
   5300  1.6  christos   i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
   5301  1.6  christos   end_hdrpp = i_shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
   5302  1.1     skrll   off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
   5303  1.1     skrll   for (hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; hdrpp < end_hdrpp; hdrpp++)
   5304  1.1     skrll     {
   5305  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
   5306  1.1     skrll 
   5307  1.1     skrll       hdr = *hdrpp;
   5308  1.1     skrll       if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
   5309  1.1     skrll 	  && (hdr->bfd_section->filepos != 0
   5310  1.1     skrll 	      || (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
   5311  1.1     skrll 		  && hdr->contents == NULL)))
   5312  1.1     skrll 	BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_offset == hdr->bfd_section->filepos);
   5313  1.5  christos       else if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
   5314  1.5  christos 	{
   5315  1.5  christos 	  if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
   5316  1.5  christos 	    (*_bfd_error_handler)
   5317  1.5  christos 	      (_("%B: warning: allocated section `%s' not in segment"),
   5318  1.5  christos 	       abfd,
   5319  1.5  christos 	       (hdr->bfd_section == NULL
   5320  1.1     skrll 		? "*unknown*"
   5321  1.1     skrll 		: hdr->bfd_section->name));
   5322  1.1     skrll 	  /* We don't need to page align empty sections.  */
   5323  1.1     skrll 	  if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0 && hdr->sh_size != 0)
   5324  1.1     skrll 	    off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
   5325  1.1     skrll 					  bed->maxpagesize);
   5326  1.1     skrll 	  else
   5327  1.1     skrll 	    off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
   5328  1.1     skrll 					  hdr->sh_addralign);
   5329  1.1     skrll 	  off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off,
   5330  1.1     skrll 							   FALSE);
   5331  1.1     skrll 	}
   5332  1.6  christos       else if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
   5333  1.6  christos 		&& hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
   5334  1.6  christos 	       || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
   5335  1.6  christos 		   && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS))
   5336  1.6  christos 		   /* Compress DWARF debug sections.  */
   5337  1.6  christos 	       || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]
   5338  1.6  christos 	       || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
   5339  1.6  christos 		   && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
   5340  1.1     skrll 	       || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)]
   5341  1.1     skrll 	       || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)])
   5342  1.1     skrll 	hdr->sh_offset = -1;
   5343  1.1     skrll       else
   5344  1.1     skrll 	off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
   5345  1.1     skrll     }
   5346  1.1     skrll 
   5347  1.1     skrll   /* Now that we have set the section file positions, we can set up
   5348  1.1     skrll      the file positions for the non PT_LOAD segments.  */
   5349  1.1     skrll   count = 0;
   5350  1.1     skrll   filehdr_vaddr = 0;
   5351  1.1     skrll   filehdr_paddr = 0;
   5352  1.5  christos   phdrs_vaddr = bed->maxpagesize + bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   5353  1.1     skrll   phdrs_paddr = 0;
   5354  1.6  christos   hdrs_segment = NULL;
   5355  1.1     skrll   phdrs = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
   5356  1.1     skrll   for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
   5357  1.1     skrll     {
   5358  1.1     skrll       ++count;
   5359  1.1     skrll       if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD)
   5360  1.1     skrll 	continue;
   5361  1.1     skrll 
   5362  1.1     skrll       if (m->includes_filehdr)
   5363  1.1     skrll 	{
   5364  1.1     skrll 	  filehdr_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
   5365  1.1     skrll 	  filehdr_paddr = p->p_paddr;
   5366  1.1     skrll 	}
   5367  1.1     skrll       if (m->includes_phdrs)
   5368  1.1     skrll 	{
   5369  1.1     skrll 	  phdrs_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
   5370  1.1     skrll 	  phdrs_paddr = p->p_paddr;
   5371  1.5  christos 	  if (m->includes_filehdr)
   5372  1.1     skrll 	    {
   5373  1.1     skrll 	      hdrs_segment = m;
   5374  1.1     skrll 	      phdrs_vaddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   5375  1.1     skrll 	      phdrs_paddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   5376  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5377  1.1     skrll 	}
   5378  1.5  christos     }
   5379  1.5  christos 
   5380  1.5  christos   if (hdrs_segment != NULL && link_info != NULL)
   5381  1.5  christos     {
   5382  1.5  christos       /* There is a segment that contains both the file headers and the
   5383  1.5  christos 	 program headers, so provide a symbol __ehdr_start pointing there.
   5384  1.5  christos 	 A program can use this to examine itself robustly.  */
   5385  1.5  christos 
   5386  1.5  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash
   5387  1.5  christos 	= elf_link_hash_lookup (elf_hash_table (link_info), "__ehdr_start",
   5388  1.5  christos 				FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
   5389  1.5  christos       /* If the symbol was referenced and not defined, define it.  */
   5390  1.5  christos       if (hash != NULL
   5391  1.5  christos 	  && (hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new
   5392  1.5  christos 	      || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
   5393  1.5  christos 	      || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
   5394  1.5  christos 	      || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_common))
   5395  1.5  christos 	{
   5396  1.5  christos 	  asection *s = NULL;
   5397  1.5  christos 	  if (hdrs_segment->count != 0)
   5398  1.5  christos 	    /* The segment contains sections, so use the first one.  */
   5399  1.5  christos 	    s = hdrs_segment->sections[0];
   5400  1.6  christos 	  else
   5401  1.5  christos 	    /* Use the first (i.e. lowest-addressed) section in any segment.  */
   5402  1.5  christos 	    for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
   5403  1.5  christos 	      if (m->count != 0)
   5404  1.5  christos 		{
   5405  1.5  christos 		  s = m->sections[0];
   5406  1.5  christos 		  break;
   5407  1.5  christos 		}
   5408  1.5  christos 
   5409  1.5  christos 	  if (s != NULL)
   5410  1.5  christos 	    {
   5411  1.5  christos 	      hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr - s->vma;
   5412  1.5  christos 	      hash->root.u.def.section = s;
   5413  1.5  christos 	    }
   5414  1.5  christos 	  else
   5415  1.5  christos 	    {
   5416  1.5  christos 	      hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr;
   5417  1.5  christos 	      hash->root.u.def.section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
   5418  1.5  christos 	    }
   5419  1.5  christos 
   5420  1.5  christos 	  hash->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
   5421  1.5  christos 	  hash->def_regular = 1;
   5422  1.5  christos 	  hash->non_elf = 0;
   5423  1.5  christos 	}
   5424  1.6  christos     }
   5425  1.1     skrll 
   5426  1.1     skrll   for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
   5427  1.1     skrll     {
   5428  1.1     skrll       if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
   5429  1.5  christos 	{
   5430  1.1     skrll 	  const Elf_Internal_Phdr *lp;
   5431  1.1     skrll 	  struct elf_segment_map *lm;
   5432  1.1     skrll 
   5433  1.1     skrll 	  if (link_info != NULL)
   5434  1.1     skrll 	    {
   5435  1.6  christos 	      /* During linking the range of the RELRO segment is passed
   5436  1.5  christos 		 in link_info.  */
   5437  1.5  christos 	      for (lm = elf_seg_map (abfd), lp = phdrs;
   5438  1.1     skrll 		   lm != NULL;
   5439  1.1     skrll 		   lm = lm->next, lp++)
   5440  1.1     skrll 		{
   5441  1.5  christos 		  if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
   5442  1.5  christos 		      && lp->p_vaddr < link_info->relro_end
   5443  1.1     skrll 		      && lm->count != 0
   5444  1.1     skrll 		      && lm->sections[0]->vma >= link_info->relro_start)
   5445  1.5  christos 		    break;
   5446  1.5  christos 		}
   5447  1.1     skrll 
   5448  1.1     skrll 	      BFD_ASSERT (lm != NULL);
   5449  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5450  1.1     skrll 	  else
   5451  1.1     skrll 	    {
   5452  1.1     skrll 	      /* Otherwise we are copying an executable or shared
   5453  1.1     skrll 		 library, but we need to use the same linker logic.  */
   5454  1.1     skrll 	      for (lp = phdrs; lp < phdrs + count; ++lp)
   5455  1.1     skrll 		{
   5456  1.1     skrll 		  if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
   5457  1.1     skrll 		      && lp->p_paddr == p->p_paddr)
   5458  1.1     skrll 		    break;
   5459  1.1     skrll 		}
   5460  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5461  1.1     skrll 
   5462  1.1     skrll 	  if (lp < phdrs + count)
   5463  1.1     skrll 	    {
   5464  1.1     skrll 	      p->p_vaddr = lp->p_vaddr;
   5465  1.1     skrll 	      p->p_paddr = lp->p_paddr;
   5466  1.1     skrll 	      p->p_offset = lp->p_offset;
   5467  1.1     skrll 	      if (link_info != NULL)
   5468  1.1     skrll 		p->p_filesz = link_info->relro_end - lp->p_vaddr;
   5469  1.1     skrll 	      else if (m->p_size_valid)
   5470  1.1     skrll 		p->p_filesz = m->p_size;
   5471  1.1     skrll 	      else
   5472  1.5  christos 		abort ();
   5473  1.5  christos 	      p->p_memsz = p->p_filesz;
   5474  1.5  christos 	      /* Preserve the alignment and flags if they are valid. The
   5475  1.5  christos 	         gold linker generates RW/4 for the PT_GNU_RELRO section.
   5476  1.5  christos 		 It is better for objcopy/strip to honor these attributes
   5477  1.5  christos 		 otherwise gdb will choke when using separate debug files.
   5478  1.5  christos 	       */
   5479  1.5  christos 	      if (!m->p_align_valid)
   5480  1.6  christos 		p->p_align = 1;
   5481  1.1     skrll 	      if (!m->p_flags_valid)
   5482  1.3  christos 		p->p_flags = PF_R;
   5483  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5484  1.1     skrll 	  else
   5485  1.1     skrll 	    {
   5486  1.1     skrll 	      memset (p, 0, sizeof *p);
   5487  1.1     skrll 	      p->p_type = PT_NULL;
   5488  1.6  christos 	    }
   5489  1.6  christos 	}
   5490  1.6  christos       else if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
   5491  1.6  christos 	{
   5492  1.6  christos 	  if (m->p_size_valid)
   5493  1.1     skrll 	    p->p_memsz = m->p_size;
   5494  1.1     skrll 	}
   5495  1.6  christos       else if (m->count != 0)
   5496  1.1     skrll 	{
   5497  1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int i;
   5498  1.1     skrll 	  if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
   5499  1.1     skrll 	      && (p->p_type != PT_NOTE
   5500  1.6  christos 		  || bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core))
   5501  1.6  christos 	    {
   5502  1.6  christos 	      if (m->includes_filehdr || m->includes_phdrs)
   5503  1.6  christos 		{
   5504  1.6  christos 		  /* PR 17512: file: 2195325e.  */
   5505  1.6  christos 		  (*_bfd_error_handler)
   5506  1.6  christos 		    (_("%B: warning: non-load segment includes file header and/or program header"),
   5507  1.6  christos 		     abfd);
   5508  1.1     skrll 		  return FALSE;
   5509  1.3  christos 		}
   5510  1.1     skrll 
   5511  1.3  christos 	      p->p_filesz = 0;
   5512  1.3  christos 	      p->p_offset = m->sections[0]->filepos;
   5513  1.3  christos 	      for (i = m->count; i-- != 0;)
   5514  1.3  christos 		{
   5515  1.3  christos 		  asection *sect = m->sections[i];
   5516  1.3  christos 		  Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_section_data (sect)->this_hdr;
   5517  1.3  christos 		  if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
   5518  1.3  christos 		    {
   5519  1.3  christos 		      p->p_filesz = (sect->filepos - m->sections[0]->filepos
   5520  1.3  christos 				     + hdr->sh_size);
   5521  1.3  christos 		      break;
   5522  1.1     skrll 		    }
   5523  1.1     skrll 		}
   5524  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5525  1.1     skrll 	}
   5526  1.1     skrll       else if (m->includes_filehdr)
   5527  1.1     skrll 	{
   5528  1.1     skrll 	  p->p_vaddr = filehdr_vaddr;
   5529  1.1     skrll 	  if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
   5530  1.1     skrll 	    p->p_paddr = filehdr_paddr;
   5531  1.1     skrll 	}
   5532  1.1     skrll       else if (m->includes_phdrs)
   5533  1.1     skrll 	{
   5534  1.1     skrll 	  p->p_vaddr = phdrs_vaddr;
   5535  1.1     skrll 	  if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
   5536  1.1     skrll 	    p->p_paddr = phdrs_paddr;
   5537  1.1     skrll 	}
   5538  1.6  christos     }
   5539  1.1     skrll 
   5540  1.1     skrll   elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
   5541  1.1     skrll 
   5542  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   5543  1.6  christos }
   5544  1.6  christos 
   5545  1.6  christos static elf_section_list *
   5546  1.6  christos find_section_in_list (unsigned int i, elf_section_list * list)
   5547  1.6  christos {
   5548  1.6  christos   for (;list != NULL; list = list->next)
   5549  1.6  christos     if (list->ndx == i)
   5550  1.6  christos       break;
   5551  1.6  christos   return list;
   5552  1.1     skrll }
   5553  1.1     skrll 
   5554  1.1     skrll /* Work out the file positions of all the sections.  This is called by
   5555  1.1     skrll    _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions.  All the section sizes and
   5556  1.1     skrll    VMAs must be known before this is called.
   5557  1.1     skrll 
   5558  1.1     skrll    Reloc sections come in two flavours: Those processed specially as
   5559  1.1     skrll    "side-channel" data attached to a section to which they apply, and
   5560  1.1     skrll    those that bfd doesn't process as relocations.  The latter sort are
   5561  1.1     skrll    stored in a normal bfd section by bfd_section_from_shdr.   We don't
   5562  1.1     skrll    consider the former sort here, unless they form part of the loadable
   5563  1.1     skrll    image.  Reloc sections not assigned here will be handled later by
   5564  1.1     skrll    assign_file_positions_for_relocs.
   5565  1.1     skrll 
   5566  1.1     skrll    We also don't set the positions of the .symtab and .strtab here.  */
   5567  1.1     skrll 
   5568  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   5569  1.1     skrll assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *abfd,
   5570  1.1     skrll 				     struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
   5571  1.1     skrll {
   5572  1.1     skrll   struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
   5573  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
   5574  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   5575  1.1     skrll 
   5576  1.1     skrll   if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0
   5577  1.1     skrll       && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
   5578  1.1     skrll     {
   5579  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Shdr ** const i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
   5580  1.1     skrll       unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
   5581  1.6  christos       Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
   5582  1.1     skrll       unsigned int i;
   5583  1.1     skrll       file_ptr off;
   5584  1.1     skrll 
   5585  1.1     skrll       /* Start after the ELF header.  */
   5586  1.1     skrll       off = i_ehdrp->e_ehsize;
   5587  1.1     skrll 
   5588  1.1     skrll       /* We are not creating an executable, which means that we are
   5589  1.1     skrll 	 not creating a program header, and that the actual order of
   5590  1.1     skrll 	 the sections in the file is unimportant.  */
   5591  1.1     skrll       for (i = 1, hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; i < num_sec; i++, hdrpp++)
   5592  1.1     skrll 	{
   5593  1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
   5594  1.1     skrll 
   5595  1.1     skrll 	  hdr = *hdrpp;
   5596  1.6  christos 	  if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
   5597  1.6  christos 	       && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
   5598  1.6  christos 	      || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
   5599  1.6  christos 		  && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS))
   5600  1.6  christos 		  /* Compress DWARF debug sections.  */
   5601  1.6  christos 	      || i == elf_onesymtab (abfd)
   5602  1.6  christos 	      || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
   5603  1.6  christos 		  && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
   5604  1.1     skrll 	      || i == elf_strtab_sec (abfd)
   5605  1.1     skrll 	      || i == elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd))
   5606  1.1     skrll 	    {
   5607  1.1     skrll 	      hdr->sh_offset = -1;
   5608  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5609  1.1     skrll 	  else
   5610  1.6  christos 	    off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
   5611  1.6  christos 	}
   5612  1.1     skrll 
   5613  1.1     skrll       elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
   5614  1.1     skrll     }
   5615  1.1     skrll   else
   5616  1.1     skrll     {
   5617  1.1     skrll       unsigned int alloc;
   5618  1.1     skrll 
   5619  1.1     skrll       /* Assign file positions for the loaded sections based on the
   5620  1.1     skrll 	 assignment of sections to segments.  */
   5621  1.1     skrll       if (!assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
   5622  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   5623  1.1     skrll 
   5624  1.1     skrll       /* And for non-load sections.  */
   5625  1.1     skrll       if (!assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
   5626  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   5627  1.1     skrll 
   5628  1.1     skrll       if (bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers != NULL)
   5629  1.1     skrll 	{
   5630  1.1     skrll 	  if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers) (abfd, link_info))
   5631  1.1     skrll 	    return FALSE;
   5632  1.6  christos 	}
   5633  1.6  christos 
   5634  1.6  christos       /* Set e_type in ELF header to ET_EXEC for -pie -Ttext-segment=.  */
   5635  1.6  christos       if (link_info != NULL && bfd_link_pie (link_info))
   5636  1.6  christos 	{
   5637  1.6  christos 	  unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
   5638  1.6  christos 	  Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
   5639  1.6  christos 	  Elf_Internal_Phdr *end_segment = &segment[num_segments];
   5640  1.6  christos 
   5641  1.6  christos 	  /* Find the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD segments.  */
   5642  1.6  christos 	  bfd_vma p_vaddr = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5643  1.6  christos 	  for (; segment < end_segment; segment++)
   5644  1.6  christos 	    if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && p_vaddr > segment->p_vaddr)
   5645  1.6  christos 	      p_vaddr = segment->p_vaddr;
   5646  1.6  christos 
   5647  1.6  christos 	  /* Set e_type to ET_EXEC if the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD
   5648  1.6  christos 	     segments is non-zero.  */
   5649  1.6  christos 	  if (p_vaddr)
   5650  1.6  christos 	    i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
   5651  1.1     skrll 	}
   5652  1.6  christos 
   5653  1.1     skrll       /* Write out the program headers.  */
   5654  1.1     skrll       alloc = elf_program_header_size (abfd) / bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
   5655  1.1     skrll       if (bfd_seek (abfd, (bfd_signed_vma) bed->s->sizeof_ehdr, SEEK_SET) != 0
   5656  1.1     skrll 	  || bed->s->write_out_phdrs (abfd, tdata->phdr, alloc) != 0)
   5657  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   5658  1.1     skrll     }
   5659  1.1     skrll 
   5660  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   5661  1.1     skrll }
   5662  1.1     skrll 
   5663  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   5664  1.3  christos prep_headers (bfd *abfd)
   5665  1.1     skrll {
   5666  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp;	/* Elf file header, internal form.  */
   5667  1.1     skrll   struct elf_strtab_hash *shstrtab;
   5668  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   5669  1.1     skrll 
   5670  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
   5671  1.1     skrll 
   5672  1.1     skrll   shstrtab = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
   5673  1.1     skrll   if (shstrtab == NULL)
   5674  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   5675  1.1     skrll 
   5676  1.1     skrll   elf_shstrtab (abfd) = shstrtab;
   5677  1.1     skrll 
   5678  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG0] = ELFMAG0;
   5679  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG1] = ELFMAG1;
   5680  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG2] = ELFMAG2;
   5681  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG3] = ELFMAG3;
   5682  1.1     skrll 
   5683  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_CLASS] = bed->s->elfclass;
   5684  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_DATA] =
   5685  1.1     skrll     bfd_big_endian (abfd) ? ELFDATA2MSB : ELFDATA2LSB;
   5686  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_VERSION] = bed->s->ev_current;
   5687  1.1     skrll 
   5688  1.1     skrll   if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
   5689  1.1     skrll     i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_DYN;
   5690  1.1     skrll   else if ((abfd->flags & EXEC_P) != 0)
   5691  1.1     skrll     i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
   5692  1.1     skrll   else if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
   5693  1.1     skrll     i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_CORE;
   5694  1.1     skrll   else
   5695  1.1     skrll     i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_REL;
   5696  1.1     skrll 
   5697  1.1     skrll   switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
   5698  1.1     skrll     {
   5699  1.1     skrll     case bfd_arch_unknown:
   5700  1.1     skrll       i_ehdrp->e_machine = EM_NONE;
   5701  1.1     skrll       break;
   5702  1.1     skrll 
   5703  1.1     skrll       /* There used to be a long list of cases here, each one setting
   5704  1.1     skrll 	 e_machine to the same EM_* macro #defined as ELF_MACHINE_CODE
   5705  1.1     skrll 	 in the corresponding bfd definition.  To avoid duplication,
   5706  1.1     skrll 	 the switch was removed.  Machines that need special handling
   5707  1.1     skrll 	 can generally do it in elf_backend_final_write_processing(),
   5708  1.1     skrll 	 unless they need the information earlier than the final write.
   5709  1.1     skrll 	 Such need can generally be supplied by replacing the tests for
   5710  1.1     skrll 	 e_machine with the conditions used to determine it.  */
   5711  1.1     skrll     default:
   5712  1.1     skrll       i_ehdrp->e_machine = bed->elf_machine_code;
   5713  1.1     skrll     }
   5714  1.1     skrll 
   5715  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_version = bed->s->ev_current;
   5716  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_ehsize = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   5717  1.1     skrll 
   5718  1.1     skrll   /* No program header, for now.  */
   5719  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
   5720  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
   5721  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_phnum = 0;
   5722  1.1     skrll 
   5723  1.1     skrll   /* Each bfd section is section header entry.  */
   5724  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_entry = bfd_get_start_address (abfd);
   5725  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_shentsize = bed->s->sizeof_shdr;
   5726  1.1     skrll 
   5727  1.1     skrll   /* If we're building an executable, we'll need a program header table.  */
   5728  1.1     skrll   if (abfd->flags & EXEC_P)
   5729  1.1     skrll     /* It all happens later.  */
   5730  1.1     skrll     ;
   5731  1.1     skrll   else
   5732  1.1     skrll     {
   5733  1.1     skrll       i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
   5734  1.1     skrll       i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
   5735  1.1     skrll     }
   5736  1.1     skrll 
   5737  1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name =
   5738  1.1     skrll     (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".symtab", FALSE);
   5739  1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name =
   5740  1.1     skrll     (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".strtab", FALSE);
   5741  1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name =
   5742  1.6  christos     (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".shstrtab", FALSE);
   5743  1.1     skrll   if (elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
   5744  1.1     skrll       || elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
   5745  1.1     skrll       || elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
   5746  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   5747  1.1     skrll 
   5748  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   5749  1.1     skrll }
   5750  1.6  christos 
   5751  1.1     skrll /* Assign file positions for all the reloc sections which are not part
   5752  1.6  christos    of the loadable file image, and the file position of section headers.  */
   5753  1.6  christos 
   5754  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   5755  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (bfd *abfd)
   5756  1.6  christos {
   5757  1.6  christos   file_ptr off;
   5758  1.6  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr **shdrpp, **end_shdrpp;
   5759  1.6  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdrp;
   5760  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp;
   5761  1.6  christos   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   5762  1.1     skrll 
   5763  1.6  christos   off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
   5764  1.6  christos 
   5765  1.6  christos   shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
   5766  1.1     skrll   end_shdrpp = shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
   5767  1.6  christos   for (shdrpp++; shdrpp < end_shdrpp; shdrpp++)
   5768  1.6  christos     {
   5769  1.6  christos       shdrp = *shdrpp;
   5770  1.6  christos       if (shdrp->sh_offset == -1)
   5771  1.6  christos 	{
   5772  1.6  christos 	  asection *sec = shdrp->bfd_section;
   5773  1.6  christos 	  bfd_boolean is_rel = (shdrp->sh_type == SHT_REL
   5774  1.6  christos 				|| shdrp->sh_type == SHT_RELA);
   5775  1.6  christos 	  if (is_rel
   5776  1.6  christos 	      || (sec != NULL && (sec->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS)))
   5777  1.6  christos 	    {
   5778  1.6  christos 	      if (!is_rel)
   5779  1.6  christos 		{
   5780  1.6  christos 		  const char *name = sec->name;
   5781  1.6  christos 		  struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
   5782  1.6  christos 
   5783  1.6  christos 		  /* Compress DWARF debug sections.  */
   5784  1.6  christos 		  if (!bfd_compress_section (abfd, sec,
   5785  1.1     skrll 					     shdrp->contents))
   5786  1.6  christos 		    return FALSE;
   5787  1.6  christos 
   5788  1.6  christos 		  if (sec->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE
   5789  1.6  christos 		      && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) == 0)
   5790  1.6  christos 		    {
   5791  1.6  christos 		      /* If section is compressed with zlib-gnu, convert
   5792  1.6  christos 			 section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_*.  */
   5793  1.6  christos 		      char *new_name
   5794  1.6  christos 			= convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
   5795  1.6  christos 		      if (new_name == NULL)
   5796  1.6  christos 			return FALSE;
   5797  1.6  christos 		      name = new_name;
   5798  1.6  christos 		    }
   5799  1.6  christos 		  /* Add setion name to section name section.  */
   5800  1.6  christos 		  if (shdrp->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
   5801  1.6  christos 		    abort ();
   5802  1.6  christos 		  shdrp->sh_name
   5803  1.6  christos 		    = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
   5804  1.6  christos 							  name, FALSE);
   5805  1.6  christos 		  d = elf_section_data (sec);
   5806  1.6  christos 
   5807  1.6  christos 		  /* Add reloc setion name to section name section.  */
   5808  1.6  christos 		  if (d->rel.hdr
   5809  1.6  christos 		      && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
   5810  1.6  christos 						      d->rel.hdr,
   5811  1.6  christos 						      name, FALSE))
   5812  1.6  christos 		    return FALSE;
   5813  1.6  christos 		  if (d->rela.hdr
   5814  1.6  christos 		      && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
   5815  1.6  christos 						      d->rela.hdr,
   5816  1.6  christos 						      name, TRUE))
   5817  1.6  christos 		    return FALSE;
   5818  1.6  christos 
   5819  1.6  christos 		  /* Update section size and contents.  */
   5820  1.6  christos 		  shdrp->sh_size = sec->size;
   5821  1.6  christos 		  shdrp->contents = sec->contents;
   5822  1.6  christos 		  shdrp->bfd_section->contents = NULL;
   5823  1.6  christos 		}
   5824  1.6  christos 	      off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp,
   5825  1.6  christos 							       off,
   5826  1.6  christos 							       TRUE);
   5827  1.1     skrll 	    }
   5828  1.1     skrll 	}
   5829  1.6  christos     }
   5830  1.6  christos 
   5831  1.6  christos   /* Place section name section after DWARF debug sections have been
   5832  1.6  christos      compressed.  */
   5833  1.6  christos   _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
   5834  1.6  christos   shdrp = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
   5835  1.6  christos   shdrp->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
   5836  1.6  christos   off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp, off, TRUE);
   5837  1.6  christos 
   5838  1.6  christos   /* Place the section headers.  */
   5839  1.6  christos   i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
   5840  1.6  christos   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   5841  1.6  christos   off = align_file_position (off, 1 << bed->s->log_file_align);
   5842  1.6  christos   i_ehdrp->e_shoff = off;
   5843  1.6  christos   off += i_ehdrp->e_shnum * i_ehdrp->e_shentsize;
   5844  1.6  christos   elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
   5845  1.1     skrll 
   5846  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   5847  1.1     skrll }
   5848  1.1     skrll 
   5849  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   5850  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (bfd *abfd)
   5851  1.1     skrll {
   5852  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   5853  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
   5854  1.6  christos   bfd_boolean failed;
   5855  1.1     skrll   unsigned int count, num_sec;
   5856  1.1     skrll   struct elf_obj_tdata *t;
   5857  1.1     skrll 
   5858  1.1     skrll   if (! abfd->output_has_begun
   5859  1.1     skrll       && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
   5860  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   5861  1.1     skrll 
   5862  1.1     skrll   i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
   5863  1.1     skrll 
   5864  1.1     skrll   failed = FALSE;
   5865  1.1     skrll   bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bed->s->write_relocs, &failed);
   5866  1.1     skrll   if (failed)
   5867  1.6  christos     return FALSE;
   5868  1.6  christos 
   5869  1.1     skrll   if (!_bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (abfd))
   5870  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   5871  1.1     skrll 
   5872  1.1     skrll   /* After writing the headers, we need to write the sections too...  */
   5873  1.1     skrll   num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
   5874  1.6  christos   for (count = 1; count < num_sec; count++)
   5875  1.6  christos     {
   5876  1.6  christos       i_shdrp[count]->sh_name
   5877  1.1     skrll 	= _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
   5878  1.1     skrll 				  i_shdrp[count]->sh_name);
   5879  1.1     skrll       if (bed->elf_backend_section_processing)
   5880  1.1     skrll 	(*bed->elf_backend_section_processing) (abfd, i_shdrp[count]);
   5881  1.1     skrll       if (i_shdrp[count]->contents)
   5882  1.1     skrll 	{
   5883  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_size_type amt = i_shdrp[count]->sh_size;
   5884  1.1     skrll 
   5885  1.1     skrll 	  if (bfd_seek (abfd, i_shdrp[count]->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
   5886  1.1     skrll 	      || bfd_bwrite (i_shdrp[count]->contents, amt, abfd) != amt)
   5887  1.1     skrll 	    return FALSE;
   5888  1.1     skrll 	}
   5889  1.1     skrll     }
   5890  1.6  christos 
   5891  1.1     skrll   /* Write out the section header names.  */
   5892  1.6  christos   t = elf_tdata (abfd);
   5893  1.1     skrll   if (elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL
   5894  1.1     skrll       && (bfd_seek (abfd, t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
   5895  1.1     skrll 	  || !_bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, elf_shstrtab (abfd))))
   5896  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   5897  1.6  christos 
   5898  1.1     skrll   if (bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing)
   5899  1.1     skrll     (*bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing) (abfd, elf_linker (abfd));
   5900  1.1     skrll 
   5901  1.1     skrll   if (!bed->s->write_shdrs_and_ehdr (abfd))
   5902  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   5903  1.6  christos 
   5904  1.6  christos   /* This is last since write_shdrs_and_ehdr can touch i_shdrp[0].  */
   5905  1.1     skrll   if (t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents != NULL)
   5906  1.1     skrll     return (*t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents) (abfd);
   5907  1.1     skrll 
   5908  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   5909  1.1     skrll }
   5910  1.1     skrll 
   5911  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   5912  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_write_corefile_contents (bfd *abfd)
   5913  1.1     skrll {
   5914  1.1     skrll   /* Hopefully this can be done just like an object file.  */
   5915  1.1     skrll   return _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (abfd);
   5916  1.1     skrll }
   5917  1.1     skrll 
   5918  1.1     skrll /* Given a section, search the header to find them.  */
   5919  1.1     skrll 
   5920  1.1     skrll unsigned int
   5921  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_section *asect)
   5922  1.3  christos {
   5923  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   5924  1.1     skrll   unsigned int sec_index;
   5925  1.1     skrll 
   5926  1.1     skrll   if (elf_section_data (asect) != NULL
   5927  1.1     skrll       && elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx != 0)
   5928  1.1     skrll     return elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx;
   5929  1.3  christos 
   5930  1.1     skrll   if (bfd_is_abs_section (asect))
   5931  1.3  christos     sec_index = SHN_ABS;
   5932  1.1     skrll   else if (bfd_is_com_section (asect))
   5933  1.3  christos     sec_index = SHN_COMMON;
   5934  1.1     skrll   else if (bfd_is_und_section (asect))
   5935  1.3  christos     sec_index = SHN_UNDEF;
   5936  1.1     skrll   else
   5937  1.1     skrll     sec_index = SHN_BAD;
   5938  1.1     skrll 
   5939  1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   5940  1.3  christos   if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section)
   5941  1.1     skrll     {
   5942  1.1     skrll       int retval = sec_index;
   5943  1.1     skrll 
   5944  1.1     skrll       if ((*bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section) (abfd, asect, &retval))
   5945  1.1     skrll 	return retval;
   5946  1.3  christos     }
   5947  1.1     skrll 
   5948  1.1     skrll   if (sec_index == SHN_BAD)
   5949  1.3  christos     bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
   5950  1.1     skrll 
   5951  1.1     skrll   return sec_index;
   5952  1.1     skrll }
   5953  1.1     skrll 
   5954  1.1     skrll /* Given a BFD symbol, return the index in the ELF symbol table, or -1
   5955  1.1     skrll    on error.  */
   5956  1.1     skrll 
   5957  1.1     skrll int
   5958  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (bfd *abfd, asymbol **asym_ptr_ptr)
   5959  1.1     skrll {
   5960  1.1     skrll   asymbol *asym_ptr = *asym_ptr_ptr;
   5961  1.1     skrll   int idx;
   5962  1.1     skrll   flagword flags = asym_ptr->flags;
   5963  1.1     skrll 
   5964  1.1     skrll   /* When gas creates relocations against local labels, it creates its
   5965  1.1     skrll      own symbol for the section, but does put the symbol into the
   5966  1.1     skrll      symbol chain, so udata is 0.  When the linker is generating
   5967  1.1     skrll      relocatable output, this section symbol may be for one of the
   5968  1.1     skrll      input sections rather than the output section.  */
   5969  1.1     skrll   if (asym_ptr->udata.i == 0
   5970  1.1     skrll       && (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
   5971  1.1     skrll       && asym_ptr->section)
   5972  1.1     skrll     {
   5973  1.1     skrll       asection *sec;
   5974  1.1     skrll       int indx;
   5975  1.1     skrll 
   5976  1.1     skrll       sec = asym_ptr->section;
   5977  1.1     skrll       if (sec->owner != abfd && sec->output_section != NULL)
   5978  1.1     skrll 	sec = sec->output_section;
   5979  1.1     skrll       if (sec->owner == abfd
   5980  1.1     skrll 	  && (indx = sec->index) < elf_num_section_syms (abfd)
   5981  1.1     skrll 	  && elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx] != NULL)
   5982  1.1     skrll 	asym_ptr->udata.i = elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx]->udata.i;
   5983  1.1     skrll     }
   5984  1.1     skrll 
   5985  1.1     skrll   idx = asym_ptr->udata.i;
   5986  1.1     skrll 
   5987  1.1     skrll   if (idx == 0)
   5988  1.1     skrll     {
   5989  1.1     skrll       /* This case can occur when using --strip-symbol on a symbol
   5990  1.1     skrll 	 which is used in a relocation entry.  */
   5991  1.1     skrll       (*_bfd_error_handler)
   5992  1.1     skrll 	(_("%B: symbol `%s' required but not present"),
   5993  1.1     skrll 	 abfd, bfd_asymbol_name (asym_ptr));
   5994  1.1     skrll       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_symbols);
   5995  1.1     skrll       return -1;
   5996  1.1     skrll     }
   5997  1.1     skrll 
   5998  1.1     skrll #if DEBUG & 4
   5999  1.3  christos   {
   6000  1.3  christos     fprintf (stderr,
   6001  1.1     skrll 	     "elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol 0x%.8lx, name = %s, sym num = %d, flags = 0x%.8lx\n",
   6002  1.1     skrll 	     (long) asym_ptr, asym_ptr->name, idx, (long) flags);
   6003  1.1     skrll     fflush (stderr);
   6004  1.1     skrll   }
   6005  1.1     skrll #endif
   6006  1.1     skrll 
   6007  1.1     skrll   return idx;
   6008  1.1     skrll }
   6009  1.1     skrll 
   6010  1.1     skrll /* Rewrite program header information.  */
   6011  1.1     skrll 
   6012  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   6013  1.1     skrll rewrite_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
   6014  1.1     skrll {
   6015  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
   6016  1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *map;
   6017  1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
   6018  1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
   6019  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
   6020  1.1     skrll   asection *section;
   6021  1.1     skrll   unsigned int i;
   6022  1.1     skrll   unsigned int num_segments;
   6023  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
   6024  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
   6025  1.1     skrll   bfd_vma maxpagesize;
   6026  1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *phdr_adjust_seg = NULL;
   6027  1.1     skrll   unsigned int phdr_adjust_num = 0;
   6028  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   6029  1.1     skrll 
   6030  1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
   6031  1.1     skrll   iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
   6032  1.1     skrll 
   6033  1.1     skrll   map_first = NULL;
   6034  1.1     skrll   pointer_to_map = &map_first;
   6035  1.1     skrll 
   6036  1.1     skrll   num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
   6037  1.1     skrll   maxpagesize = get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize;
   6038  1.1     skrll 
   6039  1.1     skrll   /* Returns the end address of the segment + 1.  */
   6040  1.1     skrll #define SEGMENT_END(segment, start)					\
   6041  1.1     skrll   (start + (segment->p_memsz > segment->p_filesz			\
   6042  1.1     skrll 	    ? segment->p_memsz : segment->p_filesz))
   6043  1.1     skrll 
   6044  1.1     skrll #define SECTION_SIZE(section, segment)					\
   6045  1.1     skrll   (((section->flags & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))		\
   6046  1.1     skrll     != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL || segment->p_type == PT_TLS)			\
   6047  1.1     skrll    ? section->size : 0)
   6048  1.1     skrll 
   6049  1.1     skrll   /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
   6050  1.1     skrll      the given segment.  VMA addresses are compared.  */
   6051  1.1     skrll #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA(section, segment)				\
   6052  1.1     skrll   (section->vma >= segment->p_vaddr					\
   6053  1.1     skrll    && (section->vma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment)			\
   6054  1.1     skrll        <= (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr))))
   6055  1.1     skrll 
   6056  1.1     skrll   /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
   6057  1.1     skrll      the given segment.  LMA addresses are compared.  */
   6058  1.1     skrll #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA(section, segment, base)			\
   6059  1.1     skrll   (section->lma >= base							\
   6060  1.1     skrll    && (section->lma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment)			\
   6061  1.1     skrll        <= SEGMENT_END (segment, base)))
   6062  1.1     skrll 
   6063  1.1     skrll   /* Handle PT_NOTE segment.  */
   6064  1.1     skrll #define IS_NOTE(p, s)							\
   6065  1.1     skrll   (p->p_type == PT_NOTE							\
   6066  1.1     skrll    && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE					\
   6067  1.1     skrll    && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset				\
   6068  1.1     skrll    && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size					\
   6069  1.1     skrll        <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
   6070  1.1     skrll 
   6071  1.1     skrll   /* Special case: corefile "NOTE" section containing regs, prpsinfo
   6072  1.1     skrll      etc.  */
   6073  1.1     skrll #define IS_COREFILE_NOTE(p, s)						\
   6074  1.1     skrll   (IS_NOTE (p, s)							\
   6075  1.1     skrll    && bfd_get_format (ibfd) == bfd_core					\
   6076  1.1     skrll    && s->vma == 0							\
   6077  1.1     skrll    && s->lma == 0)
   6078  1.1     skrll 
   6079  1.1     skrll   /* The complicated case when p_vaddr is 0 is to handle the Solaris
   6080  1.1     skrll      linker, which generates a PT_INTERP section with p_vaddr and
   6081  1.1     skrll      p_memsz set to 0.  */
   6082  1.1     skrll #define IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP(p, s)					\
   6083  1.1     skrll   (p->p_vaddr == 0							\
   6084  1.1     skrll    && p->p_paddr == 0							\
   6085  1.1     skrll    && p->p_memsz == 0							\
   6086  1.1     skrll    && p->p_filesz > 0							\
   6087  1.1     skrll    && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0				\
   6088  1.1     skrll    && s->size > 0							\
   6089  1.1     skrll    && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset				\
   6090  1.1     skrll    && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size					\
   6091  1.1     skrll        <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
   6092  1.1     skrll 
   6093  1.1     skrll   /* Decide if the given section should be included in the given segment.
   6094  1.1     skrll      A section will be included if:
   6095  1.1     skrll        1. It is within the address space of the segment -- we use the LMA
   6096  1.5  christos 	  if that is set for the segment and the VMA otherwise,
   6097  1.1     skrll        2. It is an allocated section or a NOTE section in a PT_NOTE
   6098  1.1     skrll 	  segment.
   6099  1.1     skrll        3. There is an output section associated with it,
   6100  1.1     skrll        4. The section has not already been allocated to a previous segment.
   6101  1.1     skrll        5. PT_GNU_STACK segments do not include any sections.
   6102  1.1     skrll        6. PT_TLS segment includes only SHF_TLS sections.
   6103  1.1     skrll        7. SHF_TLS sections are only in PT_TLS or PT_LOAD segments.
   6104  1.1     skrll        8. PT_DYNAMIC should not contain empty sections at the beginning
   6105  1.1     skrll 	  (with the possible exception of .dynamic).  */
   6106  1.1     skrll #define IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed)		\
   6107  1.1     skrll   ((((segment->p_paddr							\
   6108  1.1     skrll       ? IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (section, segment, segment->p_paddr)	\
   6109  1.1     skrll       : IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (section, segment))				\
   6110  1.1     skrll      && (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)				\
   6111  1.1     skrll     || IS_NOTE (segment, section))					\
   6112  1.1     skrll    && segment->p_type != PT_GNU_STACK					\
   6113  1.1     skrll    && (segment->p_type != PT_TLS					\
   6114  1.1     skrll        || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))				\
   6115  1.1     skrll    && (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD					\
   6116  1.1     skrll        || segment->p_type == PT_TLS					\
   6117  1.1     skrll        || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0)			\
   6118  1.1     skrll    && (segment->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC					\
   6119  1.1     skrll        || SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) > 0				\
   6120  1.1     skrll        || (segment->p_paddr						\
   6121  1.1     skrll 	   ? segment->p_paddr != section->lma				\
   6122  1.1     skrll 	   : segment->p_vaddr != section->vma)				\
   6123  1.1     skrll        || (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (ibfd, section), ".dynamic")	\
   6124  1.1     skrll 	   == 0))							\
   6125  1.1     skrll    && !section->segment_mark)
   6126  1.1     skrll 
   6127  1.1     skrll /* If the output section of a section in the input segment is NULL,
   6128  1.1     skrll    it is removed from the corresponding output segment.   */
   6129  1.1     skrll #define INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed)		\
   6130  1.1     skrll   (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed)		\
   6131  1.1     skrll    && section->output_section != NULL)
   6132  1.1     skrll 
   6133  1.1     skrll   /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 starts after the end of seg2.  */
   6134  1.1     skrll #define SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT(seg1, seg2, field)			\
   6135  1.1     skrll   (seg1->field >= SEGMENT_END (seg2, seg2->field))
   6136  1.1     skrll 
   6137  1.1     skrll   /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 and seg2 overlap. Segments overlap iff both
   6138  1.1     skrll      their VMA address ranges and their LMA address ranges overlap.
   6139  1.1     skrll      It is possible to have overlapping VMA ranges without overlapping LMA
   6140  1.1     skrll      ranges.  RedBoot images for example can have both .data and .bss mapped
   6141  1.1     skrll      to the same VMA range, but with the .data section mapped to a different
   6142  1.1     skrll      LMA.  */
   6143  1.1     skrll #define SEGMENT_OVERLAPS(seg1, seg2)					\
   6144  1.1     skrll   (   !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_vaddr)			\
   6145  1.1     skrll 	|| SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_vaddr))			\
   6146  1.1     skrll    && !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_paddr)			\
   6147  1.1     skrll 	|| SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_paddr)))
   6148  1.1     skrll 
   6149  1.1     skrll   /* Initialise the segment mark field.  */
   6150  1.1     skrll   for (section = ibfd->sections; section != NULL; section = section->next)
   6151  1.1     skrll     section->segment_mark = FALSE;
   6152  1.1     skrll 
   6153  1.1     skrll   /* The Solaris linker creates program headers in which all the
   6154  1.1     skrll      p_paddr fields are zero.  When we try to objcopy or strip such a
   6155  1.1     skrll      file, we get confused.  Check for this case, and if we find it
   6156  1.1     skrll      don't set the p_paddr_valid fields.  */
   6157  1.1     skrll   p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
   6158  1.1     skrll   for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
   6159  1.1     skrll        i < num_segments;
   6160  1.1     skrll        i++, segment++)
   6161  1.1     skrll     if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
   6162  1.1     skrll       {
   6163  1.1     skrll 	p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
   6164  1.1     skrll 	break;
   6165  1.1     skrll       }
   6166  1.1     skrll 
   6167  1.1     skrll   /* Scan through the segments specified in the program header
   6168  1.1     skrll      of the input BFD.  For this first scan we look for overlaps
   6169  1.1     skrll      in the loadable segments.  These can be created by weird
   6170  1.1     skrll      parameters to objcopy.  Also, fix some solaris weirdness.  */
   6171  1.1     skrll   for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
   6172  1.1     skrll        i < num_segments;
   6173  1.1     skrll        i++, segment++)
   6174  1.1     skrll     {
   6175  1.1     skrll       unsigned int j;
   6176  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment2;
   6177  1.1     skrll 
   6178  1.1     skrll       if (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP)
   6179  1.1     skrll 	for (section = ibfd->sections; section; section = section->next)
   6180  1.1     skrll 	  if (IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP (segment, section))
   6181  1.1     skrll 	    {
   6182  1.1     skrll 	      /* Mininal change so that the normal section to segment
   6183  1.1     skrll 		 assignment code will work.  */
   6184  1.1     skrll 	      segment->p_vaddr = section->vma;
   6185  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   6186  1.1     skrll 	    }
   6187  1.1     skrll 
   6188  1.1     skrll       if (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
   6189  1.1     skrll 	{
   6190  1.1     skrll 	  /* Remove PT_GNU_RELRO segment.  */
   6191  1.1     skrll 	  if (segment->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
   6192  1.1     skrll 	    segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
   6193  1.1     skrll 	  continue;
   6194  1.1     skrll 	}
   6195  1.1     skrll 
   6196  1.1     skrll       /* Determine if this segment overlaps any previous segments.  */
   6197  1.1     skrll       for (j = 0, segment2 = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr; j < i; j++, segment2++)
   6198  1.1     skrll 	{
   6199  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_signed_vma extra_length;
   6200  1.1     skrll 
   6201  1.1     skrll 	  if (segment2->p_type != PT_LOAD
   6202  1.1     skrll 	      || !SEGMENT_OVERLAPS (segment, segment2))
   6203  1.1     skrll 	    continue;
   6204  1.1     skrll 
   6205  1.1     skrll 	  /* Merge the two segments together.  */
   6206  1.1     skrll 	  if (segment2->p_vaddr < segment->p_vaddr)
   6207  1.1     skrll 	    {
   6208  1.1     skrll 	      /* Extend SEGMENT2 to include SEGMENT and then delete
   6209  1.1     skrll 		 SEGMENT.  */
   6210  1.1     skrll 	      extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr)
   6211  1.1     skrll 			      - SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr));
   6212  1.1     skrll 
   6213  1.1     skrll 	      if (extra_length > 0)
   6214  1.1     skrll 		{
   6215  1.1     skrll 		  segment2->p_memsz += extra_length;
   6216  1.1     skrll 		  segment2->p_filesz += extra_length;
   6217  1.1     skrll 		}
   6218  1.1     skrll 
   6219  1.1     skrll 	      segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
   6220  1.1     skrll 
   6221  1.1     skrll 	      /* Since we have deleted P we must restart the outer loop.  */
   6222  1.1     skrll 	      i = 0;
   6223  1.1     skrll 	      segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
   6224  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   6225  1.1     skrll 	    }
   6226  1.1     skrll 	  else
   6227  1.1     skrll 	    {
   6228  1.1     skrll 	      /* Extend SEGMENT to include SEGMENT2 and then delete
   6229  1.1     skrll 		 SEGMENT2.  */
   6230  1.1     skrll 	      extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr)
   6231  1.1     skrll 			      - SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr));
   6232  1.1     skrll 
   6233  1.1     skrll 	      if (extra_length > 0)
   6234  1.1     skrll 		{
   6235  1.1     skrll 		  segment->p_memsz += extra_length;
   6236  1.1     skrll 		  segment->p_filesz += extra_length;
   6237  1.1     skrll 		}
   6238  1.1     skrll 
   6239  1.1     skrll 	      segment2->p_type = PT_NULL;
   6240  1.1     skrll 	    }
   6241  1.1     skrll 	}
   6242  1.1     skrll     }
   6243  1.1     skrll 
   6244  1.1     skrll   /* The second scan attempts to assign sections to segments.  */
   6245  1.1     skrll   for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
   6246  1.1     skrll        i < num_segments;
   6247  1.1     skrll        i++, segment++)
   6248  1.1     skrll     {
   6249  1.1     skrll       unsigned int section_count;
   6250  1.1     skrll       asection **sections;
   6251  1.1     skrll       asection *output_section;
   6252  1.1     skrll       unsigned int isec;
   6253  1.1     skrll       bfd_vma matching_lma;
   6254  1.1     skrll       bfd_vma suggested_lma;
   6255  1.1     skrll       unsigned int j;
   6256  1.1     skrll       bfd_size_type amt;
   6257  1.1     skrll       asection *first_section;
   6258  1.1     skrll       bfd_boolean first_matching_lma;
   6259  1.1     skrll       bfd_boolean first_suggested_lma;
   6260  1.1     skrll 
   6261  1.1     skrll       if (segment->p_type == PT_NULL)
   6262  1.1     skrll 	continue;
   6263  1.1     skrll 
   6264  1.1     skrll       first_section = NULL;
   6265  1.1     skrll       /* Compute how many sections might be placed into this segment.  */
   6266  1.1     skrll       for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
   6267  1.1     skrll 	   section != NULL;
   6268  1.1     skrll 	   section = section->next)
   6269  1.1     skrll 	{
   6270  1.1     skrll 	  /* Find the first section in the input segment, which may be
   6271  1.1     skrll 	     removed from the corresponding output segment.   */
   6272  1.1     skrll 	  if (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
   6273  1.1     skrll 	    {
   6274  1.1     skrll 	      if (first_section == NULL)
   6275  1.1     skrll 		first_section = section;
   6276  1.1     skrll 	      if (section->output_section != NULL)
   6277  1.1     skrll 		++section_count;
   6278  1.1     skrll 	    }
   6279  1.1     skrll 	}
   6280  1.1     skrll 
   6281  1.1     skrll       /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
   6282  1.1     skrll 	 all of the sections we have selected.  */
   6283  1.3  christos       amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   6284  1.1     skrll       amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
   6285  1.1     skrll       map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
   6286  1.1     skrll       if (map == NULL)
   6287  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   6288  1.1     skrll 
   6289  1.1     skrll       /* Initialise the fields of the segment map.  Default to
   6290  1.1     skrll 	 using the physical address of the segment in the input BFD.  */
   6291  1.1     skrll       map->next = NULL;
   6292  1.1     skrll       map->p_type = segment->p_type;
   6293  1.1     skrll       map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
   6294  1.1     skrll       map->p_flags_valid = 1;
   6295  1.1     skrll 
   6296  1.1     skrll       /* If the first section in the input segment is removed, there is
   6297  1.1     skrll 	 no need to preserve segment physical address in the corresponding
   6298  1.1     skrll 	 output segment.  */
   6299  1.1     skrll       if (!first_section || first_section->output_section != NULL)
   6300  1.1     skrll 	{
   6301  1.1     skrll 	  map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
   6302  1.1     skrll 	  map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
   6303  1.1     skrll 	}
   6304  1.1     skrll 
   6305  1.1     skrll       /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
   6306  1.1     skrll 	 and if it contains the program headers themselves.  */
   6307  1.1     skrll       map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
   6308  1.1     skrll 			       && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
   6309  1.1     skrll       map->includes_phdrs = 0;
   6310  1.1     skrll 
   6311  1.1     skrll       if (!phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
   6312  1.1     skrll 	{
   6313  1.1     skrll 	  map->includes_phdrs =
   6314  1.1     skrll 	    (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
   6315  1.1     skrll 	     && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
   6316  1.1     skrll 		 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
   6317  1.1     skrll 		     + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
   6318  1.1     skrll 
   6319  1.1     skrll 	  if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
   6320  1.1     skrll 	    phdr_included = TRUE;
   6321  1.1     skrll 	}
   6322  1.1     skrll 
   6323  1.1     skrll       if (section_count == 0)
   6324  1.1     skrll 	{
   6325  1.1     skrll 	  /* Special segments, such as the PT_PHDR segment, may contain
   6326  1.1     skrll 	     no sections, but ordinary, loadable segments should contain
   6327  1.1     skrll 	     something.  They are allowed by the ELF spec however, so only
   6328  1.6  christos 	     a warning is produced.  */
   6329  1.6  christos 	  if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD)
   6330  1.1     skrll 	    (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("\
   6331  1.1     skrll %B: warning: Empty loadable segment detected, is this intentional ?"),
   6332  1.1     skrll 				   ibfd);
   6333  1.1     skrll 
   6334  1.1     skrll 	  map->count = 0;
   6335  1.1     skrll 	  *pointer_to_map = map;
   6336  1.1     skrll 	  pointer_to_map = &map->next;
   6337  1.1     skrll 
   6338  1.1     skrll 	  continue;
   6339  1.1     skrll 	}
   6340  1.1     skrll 
   6341  1.1     skrll       /* Now scan the sections in the input BFD again and attempt
   6342  1.1     skrll 	 to add their corresponding output sections to the segment map.
   6343  1.1     skrll 	 The problem here is how to handle an output section which has
   6344  1.1     skrll 	 been moved (ie had its LMA changed).  There are four possibilities:
   6345  1.1     skrll 
   6346  1.1     skrll 	 1. None of the sections have been moved.
   6347  1.1     skrll 	    In this case we can continue to use the segment LMA from the
   6348  1.1     skrll 	    input BFD.
   6349  1.1     skrll 
   6350  1.1     skrll 	 2. All of the sections have been moved by the same amount.
   6351  1.1     skrll 	    In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
   6352  1.1     skrll 	    of the first section.
   6353  1.1     skrll 
   6354  1.1     skrll 	 3. Some of the sections have been moved, others have not.
   6355  1.1     skrll 	    In this case those sections which have not been moved can be
   6356  1.1     skrll 	    placed in the current segment which will have to have its size,
   6357  1.1     skrll 	    and possibly its LMA changed, and a new segment or segments will
   6358  1.1     skrll 	    have to be created to contain the other sections.
   6359  1.1     skrll 
   6360  1.1     skrll 	 4. The sections have been moved, but not by the same amount.
   6361  1.1     skrll 	    In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
   6362  1.1     skrll 	    of the first section and we will have to create a new segment
   6363  1.1     skrll 	    or segments to contain the other sections.
   6364  1.1     skrll 
   6365  1.1     skrll 	 In order to save time, we allocate an array to hold the section
   6366  1.1     skrll 	 pointers that we are interested in.  As these sections get assigned
   6367  1.3  christos 	 to a segment, they are removed from this array.  */
   6368  1.1     skrll 
   6369  1.1     skrll       sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (section_count, sizeof (asection *));
   6370  1.1     skrll       if (sections == NULL)
   6371  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   6372  1.1     skrll 
   6373  1.1     skrll       /* Step One: Scan for segment vs section LMA conflicts.
   6374  1.1     skrll 	 Also add the sections to the section array allocated above.
   6375  1.1     skrll 	 Also add the sections to the current segment.  In the common
   6376  1.1     skrll 	 case, where the sections have not been moved, this means that
   6377  1.1     skrll 	 we have completely filled the segment, and there is nothing
   6378  1.1     skrll 	 more to do.  */
   6379  1.1     skrll       isec = 0;
   6380  1.1     skrll       matching_lma = 0;
   6381  1.1     skrll       suggested_lma = 0;
   6382  1.1     skrll       first_matching_lma = TRUE;
   6383  1.1     skrll       first_suggested_lma = TRUE;
   6384  1.1     skrll 
   6385  1.1     skrll       for (section = ibfd->sections;
   6386  1.1     skrll 	   section != NULL;
   6387  1.1     skrll 	   section = section->next)
   6388  1.1     skrll 	if (section == first_section)
   6389  1.1     skrll 	  break;
   6390  1.1     skrll 
   6391  1.1     skrll       for (j = 0; section != NULL; section = section->next)
   6392  1.1     skrll 	{
   6393  1.1     skrll 	  if (INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
   6394  1.1     skrll 	    {
   6395  1.1     skrll 	      output_section = section->output_section;
   6396  1.1     skrll 
   6397  1.1     skrll 	      sections[j++] = section;
   6398  1.1     skrll 
   6399  1.1     skrll 	      /* The Solaris native linker always sets p_paddr to 0.
   6400  1.1     skrll 		 We try to catch that case here, and set it to the
   6401  1.1     skrll 		 correct value.  Note - some backends require that
   6402  1.1     skrll 		 p_paddr be left as zero.  */
   6403  1.1     skrll 	      if (!p_paddr_valid
   6404  1.1     skrll 		  && segment->p_vaddr != 0
   6405  1.1     skrll 		  && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
   6406  1.1     skrll 		  && isec == 0
   6407  1.1     skrll 		  && output_section->lma != 0
   6408  1.1     skrll 		  && output_section->vma == (segment->p_vaddr
   6409  1.1     skrll 					     + (map->includes_filehdr
   6410  1.1     skrll 						? iehdr->e_ehsize
   6411  1.1     skrll 						: 0)
   6412  1.1     skrll 					     + (map->includes_phdrs
   6413  1.1     skrll 						? (iehdr->e_phnum
   6414  1.1     skrll 						   * iehdr->e_phentsize)
   6415  1.1     skrll 						: 0)))
   6416  1.1     skrll 		map->p_paddr = segment->p_vaddr;
   6417  1.1     skrll 
   6418  1.1     skrll 	      /* Match up the physical address of the segment with the
   6419  1.1     skrll 		 LMA address of the output section.  */
   6420  1.1     skrll 	      if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
   6421  1.1     skrll 		  || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section)
   6422  1.1     skrll 		  || (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
   6423  1.1     skrll 		      && IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (output_section, segment)))
   6424  1.1     skrll 		{
   6425  1.1     skrll 		  if (first_matching_lma || output_section->lma < matching_lma)
   6426  1.1     skrll 		    {
   6427  1.1     skrll 		      matching_lma = output_section->lma;
   6428  1.1     skrll 		      first_matching_lma = FALSE;
   6429  1.1     skrll 		    }
   6430  1.1     skrll 
   6431  1.1     skrll 		  /* We assume that if the section fits within the segment
   6432  1.1     skrll 		     then it does not overlap any other section within that
   6433  1.1     skrll 		     segment.  */
   6434  1.1     skrll 		  map->sections[isec++] = output_section;
   6435  1.1     skrll 		}
   6436  1.1     skrll 	      else if (first_suggested_lma)
   6437  1.1     skrll 		{
   6438  1.1     skrll 		  suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
   6439  1.1     skrll 		  first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
   6440  1.1     skrll 		}
   6441  1.1     skrll 
   6442  1.1     skrll 	      if (j == section_count)
   6443  1.1     skrll 		break;
   6444  1.1     skrll 	    }
   6445  1.1     skrll 	}
   6446  1.1     skrll 
   6447  1.1     skrll       BFD_ASSERT (j == section_count);
   6448  1.1     skrll 
   6449  1.1     skrll       /* Step Two: Adjust the physical address of the current segment,
   6450  1.1     skrll 	 if necessary.  */
   6451  1.1     skrll       if (isec == section_count)
   6452  1.1     skrll 	{
   6453  1.1     skrll 	  /* All of the sections fitted within the segment as currently
   6454  1.1     skrll 	     specified.  This is the default case.  Add the segment to
   6455  1.1     skrll 	     the list of built segments and carry on to process the next
   6456  1.1     skrll 	     program header in the input BFD.  */
   6457  1.1     skrll 	  map->count = section_count;
   6458  1.1     skrll 	  *pointer_to_map = map;
   6459  1.1     skrll 	  pointer_to_map = &map->next;
   6460  1.1     skrll 
   6461  1.1     skrll 	  if (p_paddr_valid
   6462  1.1     skrll 	      && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
   6463  1.1     skrll 	      && matching_lma != map->p_paddr
   6464  1.1     skrll 	      && !map->includes_filehdr
   6465  1.1     skrll 	      && !map->includes_phdrs)
   6466  1.1     skrll 	    /* There is some padding before the first section in the
   6467  1.1     skrll 	       segment.  So, we must account for that in the output
   6468  1.1     skrll 	       segment's vma.  */
   6469  1.1     skrll 	    map->p_vaddr_offset = matching_lma - map->p_paddr;
   6470  1.1     skrll 
   6471  1.1     skrll 	  free (sections);
   6472  1.1     skrll 	  continue;
   6473  1.1     skrll 	}
   6474  1.1     skrll       else
   6475  1.1     skrll 	{
   6476  1.1     skrll 	  if (!first_matching_lma)
   6477  1.1     skrll 	    {
   6478  1.1     skrll 	      /* At least one section fits inside the current segment.
   6479  1.1     skrll 		 Keep it, but modify its physical address to match the
   6480  1.1     skrll 		 LMA of the first section that fitted.  */
   6481  1.1     skrll 	      map->p_paddr = matching_lma;
   6482  1.1     skrll 	    }
   6483  1.1     skrll 	  else
   6484  1.1     skrll 	    {
   6485  1.1     skrll 	      /* None of the sections fitted inside the current segment.
   6486  1.1     skrll 		 Change the current segment's physical address to match
   6487  1.1     skrll 		 the LMA of the first section.  */
   6488  1.1     skrll 	      map->p_paddr = suggested_lma;
   6489  1.1     skrll 	    }
   6490  1.1     skrll 
   6491  1.1     skrll 	  /* Offset the segment physical address from the lma
   6492  1.1     skrll 	     to allow for space taken up by elf headers.  */
   6493  1.1     skrll 	  if (map->includes_filehdr)
   6494  1.1     skrll 	    {
   6495  1.1     skrll 	      if (map->p_paddr >= iehdr->e_ehsize)
   6496  1.1     skrll 		map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_ehsize;
   6497  1.1     skrll 	      else
   6498  1.1     skrll 		{
   6499  1.1     skrll 		  map->includes_filehdr = FALSE;
   6500  1.1     skrll 		  map->includes_phdrs = FALSE;
   6501  1.1     skrll 		}
   6502  1.1     skrll 	    }
   6503  1.1     skrll 
   6504  1.1     skrll 	  if (map->includes_phdrs)
   6505  1.1     skrll 	    {
   6506  1.1     skrll 	      if (map->p_paddr >= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)
   6507  1.1     skrll 		{
   6508  1.1     skrll 		  map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
   6509  1.1     skrll 
   6510  1.1     skrll 		  /* iehdr->e_phnum is just an estimate of the number
   6511  1.1     skrll 		     of program headers that we will need.  Make a note
   6512  1.1     skrll 		     here of the number we used and the segment we chose
   6513  1.1     skrll 		     to hold these headers, so that we can adjust the
   6514  1.1     skrll 		     offset when we know the correct value.  */
   6515  1.1     skrll 		  phdr_adjust_num = iehdr->e_phnum;
   6516  1.1     skrll 		  phdr_adjust_seg = map;
   6517  1.1     skrll 		}
   6518  1.1     skrll 	      else
   6519  1.1     skrll 		map->includes_phdrs = FALSE;
   6520  1.1     skrll 	    }
   6521  1.1     skrll 	}
   6522  1.1     skrll 
   6523  1.1     skrll       /* Step Three: Loop over the sections again, this time assigning
   6524  1.1     skrll 	 those that fit to the current segment and removing them from the
   6525  1.1     skrll 	 sections array; but making sure not to leave large gaps.  Once all
   6526  1.1     skrll 	 possible sections have been assigned to the current segment it is
   6527  1.1     skrll 	 added to the list of built segments and if sections still remain
   6528  1.1     skrll 	 to be assigned, a new segment is constructed before repeating
   6529  1.1     skrll 	 the loop.  */
   6530  1.1     skrll       isec = 0;
   6531  1.1     skrll       do
   6532  1.1     skrll 	{
   6533  1.1     skrll 	  map->count = 0;
   6534  1.1     skrll 	  suggested_lma = 0;
   6535  1.1     skrll 	  first_suggested_lma = TRUE;
   6536  1.1     skrll 
   6537  1.1     skrll 	  /* Fill the current segment with sections that fit.  */
   6538  1.1     skrll 	  for (j = 0; j < section_count; j++)
   6539  1.1     skrll 	    {
   6540  1.1     skrll 	      section = sections[j];
   6541  1.1     skrll 
   6542  1.1     skrll 	      if (section == NULL)
   6543  1.1     skrll 		continue;
   6544  1.1     skrll 
   6545  1.1     skrll 	      output_section = section->output_section;
   6546  1.1     skrll 
   6547  1.1     skrll 	      BFD_ASSERT (output_section != NULL);
   6548  1.1     skrll 
   6549  1.1     skrll 	      if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
   6550  1.1     skrll 		  || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section))
   6551  1.1     skrll 		{
   6552  1.1     skrll 		  if (map->count == 0)
   6553  1.1     skrll 		    {
   6554  1.1     skrll 		      /* If the first section in a segment does not start at
   6555  1.1     skrll 			 the beginning of the segment, then something is
   6556  1.1     skrll 			 wrong.  */
   6557  1.1     skrll 		      if (output_section->lma
   6558  1.1     skrll 			  != (map->p_paddr
   6559  1.1     skrll 			      + (map->includes_filehdr ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
   6560  1.1     skrll 			      + (map->includes_phdrs
   6561  1.1     skrll 				 ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
   6562  1.1     skrll 				 : 0)))
   6563  1.1     skrll 			abort ();
   6564  1.1     skrll 		    }
   6565  1.1     skrll 		  else
   6566  1.1     skrll 		    {
   6567  1.1     skrll 		      asection *prev_sec;
   6568  1.1     skrll 
   6569  1.1     skrll 		      prev_sec = map->sections[map->count - 1];
   6570  1.1     skrll 
   6571  1.1     skrll 		      /* If the gap between the end of the previous section
   6572  1.1     skrll 			 and the start of this section is more than
   6573  1.1     skrll 			 maxpagesize then we need to start a new segment.  */
   6574  1.1     skrll 		      if ((BFD_ALIGN (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size,
   6575  1.1     skrll 				      maxpagesize)
   6576  1.1     skrll 			   < BFD_ALIGN (output_section->lma, maxpagesize))
   6577  1.1     skrll 			  || (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size
   6578  1.1     skrll 			      > output_section->lma))
   6579  1.1     skrll 			{
   6580  1.1     skrll 			  if (first_suggested_lma)
   6581  1.1     skrll 			    {
   6582  1.1     skrll 			      suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
   6583  1.1     skrll 			      first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
   6584  1.1     skrll 			    }
   6585  1.1     skrll 
   6586  1.1     skrll 			  continue;
   6587  1.1     skrll 			}
   6588  1.1     skrll 		    }
   6589  1.1     skrll 
   6590  1.1     skrll 		  map->sections[map->count++] = output_section;
   6591  1.1     skrll 		  ++isec;
   6592  1.1     skrll 		  sections[j] = NULL;
   6593  1.1     skrll 		  section->segment_mark = TRUE;
   6594  1.1     skrll 		}
   6595  1.1     skrll 	      else if (first_suggested_lma)
   6596  1.1     skrll 		{
   6597  1.1     skrll 		  suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
   6598  1.1     skrll 		  first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
   6599  1.1     skrll 		}
   6600  1.1     skrll 	    }
   6601  1.1     skrll 
   6602  1.1     skrll 	  BFD_ASSERT (map->count > 0);
   6603  1.1     skrll 
   6604  1.1     skrll 	  /* Add the current segment to the list of built segments.  */
   6605  1.1     skrll 	  *pointer_to_map = map;
   6606  1.1     skrll 	  pointer_to_map = &map->next;
   6607  1.1     skrll 
   6608  1.1     skrll 	  if (isec < section_count)
   6609  1.1     skrll 	    {
   6610  1.1     skrll 	      /* We still have not allocated all of the sections to
   6611  1.1     skrll 		 segments.  Create a new segment here, initialise it
   6612  1.1     skrll 		 and carry on looping.  */
   6613  1.5  christos 	      amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   6614  1.1     skrll 	      amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
   6615  1.1     skrll 	      map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
   6616  1.1     skrll 	      if (map == NULL)
   6617  1.1     skrll 		{
   6618  1.1     skrll 		  free (sections);
   6619  1.1     skrll 		  return FALSE;
   6620  1.1     skrll 		}
   6621  1.1     skrll 
   6622  1.1     skrll 	      /* Initialise the fields of the segment map.  Set the physical
   6623  1.1     skrll 		 physical address to the LMA of the first section that has
   6624  1.1     skrll 		 not yet been assigned.  */
   6625  1.1     skrll 	      map->next = NULL;
   6626  1.1     skrll 	      map->p_type = segment->p_type;
   6627  1.1     skrll 	      map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
   6628  1.1     skrll 	      map->p_flags_valid = 1;
   6629  1.1     skrll 	      map->p_paddr = suggested_lma;
   6630  1.1     skrll 	      map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
   6631  1.1     skrll 	      map->includes_filehdr = 0;
   6632  1.1     skrll 	      map->includes_phdrs = 0;
   6633  1.1     skrll 	    }
   6634  1.1     skrll 	}
   6635  1.1     skrll       while (isec < section_count);
   6636  1.1     skrll 
   6637  1.1     skrll       free (sections);
   6638  1.6  christos     }
   6639  1.1     skrll 
   6640  1.1     skrll   elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
   6641  1.1     skrll 
   6642  1.1     skrll   /* If we had to estimate the number of program headers that were
   6643  1.1     skrll      going to be needed, then check our estimate now and adjust
   6644  1.1     skrll      the offset if necessary.  */
   6645  1.1     skrll   if (phdr_adjust_seg != NULL)
   6646  1.1     skrll     {
   6647  1.1     skrll       unsigned int count;
   6648  1.1     skrll 
   6649  1.1     skrll       for (count = 0, map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
   6650  1.1     skrll 	count++;
   6651  1.1     skrll 
   6652  1.1     skrll       if (count > phdr_adjust_num)
   6653  1.1     skrll 	phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr
   6654  1.1     skrll 	  -= (count - phdr_adjust_num) * iehdr->e_phentsize;
   6655  1.1     skrll     }
   6656  1.1     skrll 
   6657  1.1     skrll #undef SEGMENT_END
   6658  1.1     skrll #undef SECTION_SIZE
   6659  1.1     skrll #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA
   6660  1.1     skrll #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA
   6661  1.1     skrll #undef IS_NOTE
   6662  1.1     skrll #undef IS_COREFILE_NOTE
   6663  1.1     skrll #undef IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP
   6664  1.1     skrll #undef IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT
   6665  1.1     skrll #undef INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT
   6666  1.1     skrll #undef SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT
   6667  1.1     skrll #undef SEGMENT_OVERLAPS
   6668  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   6669  1.1     skrll }
   6670  1.1     skrll 
   6671  1.1     skrll /* Copy ELF program header information.  */
   6672  1.1     skrll 
   6673  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   6674  1.1     skrll copy_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
   6675  1.1     skrll {
   6676  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
   6677  1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *map;
   6678  1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
   6679  1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
   6680  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
   6681  1.1     skrll   unsigned int i;
   6682  1.1     skrll   unsigned int num_segments;
   6683  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
   6684  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
   6685  1.1     skrll 
   6686  1.1     skrll   iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
   6687  1.1     skrll 
   6688  1.1     skrll   map_first = NULL;
   6689  1.1     skrll   pointer_to_map = &map_first;
   6690  1.1     skrll 
   6691  1.1     skrll   /* If all the segment p_paddr fields are zero, don't set
   6692  1.1     skrll      map->p_paddr_valid.  */
   6693  1.1     skrll   p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
   6694  1.1     skrll   num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
   6695  1.1     skrll   for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
   6696  1.1     skrll        i < num_segments;
   6697  1.1     skrll        i++, segment++)
   6698  1.1     skrll     if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
   6699  1.1     skrll       {
   6700  1.1     skrll 	p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
   6701  1.1     skrll 	break;
   6702  1.1     skrll       }
   6703  1.1     skrll 
   6704  1.1     skrll   for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
   6705  1.1     skrll        i < num_segments;
   6706  1.1     skrll        i++, segment++)
   6707  1.1     skrll     {
   6708  1.1     skrll       asection *section;
   6709  1.1     skrll       unsigned int section_count;
   6710  1.1     skrll       bfd_size_type amt;
   6711  1.3  christos       Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
   6712  1.1     skrll       asection *first_section = NULL;
   6713  1.1     skrll       asection *lowest_section;
   6714  1.1     skrll 
   6715  1.1     skrll       /* Compute how many sections are in this segment.  */
   6716  1.1     skrll       for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
   6717  1.1     skrll 	   section != NULL;
   6718  1.1     skrll 	   section = section->next)
   6719  1.3  christos 	{
   6720  1.1     skrll 	  this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
   6721  1.3  christos 	  if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
   6722  1.3  christos 	    {
   6723  1.1     skrll 	      if (first_section == NULL)
   6724  1.1     skrll 		first_section = section;
   6725  1.1     skrll 	      section_count++;
   6726  1.1     skrll 	    }
   6727  1.1     skrll 	}
   6728  1.1     skrll 
   6729  1.1     skrll       /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
   6730  1.1     skrll 	 all of the sections we have selected.  */
   6731  1.1     skrll       amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   6732  1.3  christos       if (section_count != 0)
   6733  1.1     skrll 	amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
   6734  1.1     skrll       map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
   6735  1.1     skrll       if (map == NULL)
   6736  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   6737  1.1     skrll 
   6738  1.1     skrll       /* Initialize the fields of the output segment map with the
   6739  1.1     skrll 	 input segment.  */
   6740  1.1     skrll       map->next = NULL;
   6741  1.1     skrll       map->p_type = segment->p_type;
   6742  1.1     skrll       map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
   6743  1.1     skrll       map->p_flags_valid = 1;
   6744  1.1     skrll       map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
   6745  1.1     skrll       map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
   6746  1.1     skrll       map->p_align = segment->p_align;
   6747  1.1     skrll       map->p_align_valid = 1;
   6748  1.6  christos       map->p_vaddr_offset = 0;
   6749  1.6  christos 
   6750  1.1     skrll       if (map->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO
   6751  1.1     skrll 	  || map->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
   6752  1.1     skrll 	{
   6753  1.1     skrll 	  /* The PT_GNU_RELRO segment may contain the first a few
   6754  1.6  christos 	     bytes in the .got.plt section even if the whole .got.plt
   6755  1.6  christos 	     section isn't in the PT_GNU_RELRO segment.  We won't
   6756  1.6  christos 	     change the size of the PT_GNU_RELRO segment.
   6757  1.3  christos 	     Similarly, PT_GNU_STACK size is significant on uclinux
   6758  1.1     skrll 	     systems.    */
   6759  1.1     skrll 	  map->p_size = segment->p_memsz;
   6760  1.1     skrll 	  map->p_size_valid = 1;
   6761  1.1     skrll 	}
   6762  1.1     skrll 
   6763  1.1     skrll       /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
   6764  1.1     skrll 	 and if it contains the program headers themselves.  */
   6765  1.1     skrll       map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
   6766  1.1     skrll 			       && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
   6767  1.1     skrll 
   6768  1.1     skrll       map->includes_phdrs = 0;
   6769  1.1     skrll       if (! phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
   6770  1.1     skrll 	{
   6771  1.1     skrll 	  map->includes_phdrs =
   6772  1.1     skrll 	    (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
   6773  1.1     skrll 	     && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
   6774  1.1     skrll 		 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
   6775  1.1     skrll 		     + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
   6776  1.1     skrll 
   6777  1.1     skrll 	  if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
   6778  1.1     skrll 	    phdr_included = TRUE;
   6779  1.6  christos 	}
   6780  1.1     skrll 
   6781  1.1     skrll       lowest_section = NULL;
   6782  1.1     skrll       if (section_count != 0)
   6783  1.1     skrll 	{
   6784  1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int isec = 0;
   6785  1.1     skrll 
   6786  1.1     skrll 	  for (section = first_section;
   6787  1.1     skrll 	       section != NULL;
   6788  1.1     skrll 	       section = section->next)
   6789  1.3  christos 	    {
   6790  1.1     skrll 	      this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
   6791  1.1     skrll 	      if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
   6792  1.3  christos 		{
   6793  1.3  christos 		  map->sections[isec++] = section->output_section;
   6794  1.3  christos 		  if ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
   6795  1.3  christos 		    {
   6796  1.6  christos 		      bfd_vma seg_off;
   6797  1.6  christos 
   6798  1.6  christos 		      if (lowest_section == NULL
   6799  1.6  christos 			  || section->lma < lowest_section->lma)
   6800  1.3  christos 			lowest_section = section;
   6801  1.3  christos 
   6802  1.3  christos 		      /* Section lmas are set up from PT_LOAD header
   6803  1.3  christos 			 p_paddr in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr.
   6804  1.3  christos 			 If this header has a p_paddr that disagrees
   6805  1.3  christos 			 with the section lma, flag the p_paddr as
   6806  1.3  christos 			 invalid.  */
   6807  1.3  christos 		      if ((section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
   6808  1.3  christos 			seg_off = this_hdr->sh_offset - segment->p_offset;
   6809  1.3  christos 		      else
   6810  1.3  christos 			seg_off = this_hdr->sh_addr - segment->p_vaddr;
   6811  1.3  christos 		      if (section->lma - segment->p_paddr != seg_off)
   6812  1.1     skrll 			map->p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
   6813  1.1     skrll 		    }
   6814  1.1     skrll 		  if (isec == section_count)
   6815  1.1     skrll 		    break;
   6816  1.1     skrll 		}
   6817  1.1     skrll 	    }
   6818  1.3  christos 	}
   6819  1.3  christos 
   6820  1.3  christos       if (map->includes_filehdr && lowest_section != NULL)
   6821  1.5  christos 	/* We need to keep the space used by the headers fixed.  */
   6822  1.3  christos 	map->header_size = lowest_section->vma - segment->p_vaddr;
   6823  1.3  christos 
   6824  1.3  christos       if (!map->includes_phdrs
   6825  1.3  christos 	  && !map->includes_filehdr
   6826  1.3  christos 	  && map->p_paddr_valid)
   6827  1.3  christos 	/* There is some other padding before the first section.  */
   6828  1.3  christos 	map->p_vaddr_offset = ((lowest_section ? lowest_section->lma : 0)
   6829  1.1     skrll 			       - segment->p_paddr);
   6830  1.1     skrll 
   6831  1.1     skrll       map->count = section_count;
   6832  1.1     skrll       *pointer_to_map = map;
   6833  1.1     skrll       pointer_to_map = &map->next;
   6834  1.6  christos     }
   6835  1.1     skrll 
   6836  1.1     skrll   elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
   6837  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   6838  1.1     skrll }
   6839  1.1     skrll 
   6840  1.1     skrll /* Copy private BFD data.  This copies or rewrites ELF program header
   6841  1.1     skrll    information.  */
   6842  1.1     skrll 
   6843  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   6844  1.1     skrll copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
   6845  1.1     skrll {
   6846  1.1     skrll   if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
   6847  1.1     skrll       || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
   6848  1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   6849  1.1     skrll 
   6850  1.1     skrll   if (elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr == NULL)
   6851  1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   6852  1.1     skrll 
   6853  1.1     skrll   if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
   6854  1.1     skrll     {
   6855  1.1     skrll       /* Check to see if any sections in the input BFD
   6856  1.1     skrll 	 covered by ELF program header have changed.  */
   6857  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
   6858  1.1     skrll       asection *section, *osec;
   6859  1.1     skrll       unsigned int i, num_segments;
   6860  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
   6861  1.1     skrll       const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   6862  1.1     skrll 
   6863  1.1     skrll       bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
   6864  1.1     skrll 
   6865  1.1     skrll       /* Regenerate the segment map if p_paddr is set to 0.  */
   6866  1.1     skrll       if (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero)
   6867  1.1     skrll 	goto rewrite;
   6868  1.1     skrll 
   6869  1.1     skrll       /* Initialize the segment mark field.  */
   6870  1.1     skrll       for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
   6871  1.1     skrll 	   section = section->next)
   6872  1.1     skrll 	section->segment_mark = FALSE;
   6873  1.1     skrll 
   6874  1.1     skrll       num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
   6875  1.1     skrll       for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
   6876  1.1     skrll 	   i < num_segments;
   6877  1.1     skrll 	   i++, segment++)
   6878  1.1     skrll 	{
   6879  1.1     skrll 	  /* PR binutils/3535.  The Solaris linker always sets the p_paddr
   6880  1.1     skrll 	     and p_memsz fields of special segments (DYNAMIC, INTERP) to 0
   6881  1.1     skrll 	     which severly confuses things, so always regenerate the segment
   6882  1.1     skrll 	     map in this case.  */
   6883  1.1     skrll 	  if (segment->p_paddr == 0
   6884  1.1     skrll 	      && segment->p_memsz == 0
   6885  1.1     skrll 	      && (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP || segment->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC))
   6886  1.1     skrll 	    goto rewrite;
   6887  1.1     skrll 
   6888  1.1     skrll 	  for (section = ibfd->sections;
   6889  1.1     skrll 	       section != NULL; section = section->next)
   6890  1.1     skrll 	    {
   6891  1.1     skrll 	      /* We mark the output section so that we know it comes
   6892  1.1     skrll 		 from the input BFD.  */
   6893  1.1     skrll 	      osec = section->output_section;
   6894  1.1     skrll 	      if (osec)
   6895  1.1     skrll 		osec->segment_mark = TRUE;
   6896  1.1     skrll 
   6897  1.3  christos 	      /* Check if this section is covered by the segment.  */
   6898  1.1     skrll 	      this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
   6899  1.1     skrll 	      if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
   6900  1.1     skrll 		{
   6901  1.1     skrll 		  /* FIXME: Check if its output section is changed or
   6902  1.1     skrll 		     removed.  What else do we need to check?  */
   6903  1.1     skrll 		  if (osec == NULL
   6904  1.1     skrll 		      || section->flags != osec->flags
   6905  1.1     skrll 		      || section->lma != osec->lma
   6906  1.1     skrll 		      || section->vma != osec->vma
   6907  1.1     skrll 		      || section->size != osec->size
   6908  1.1     skrll 		      || section->rawsize != osec->rawsize
   6909  1.1     skrll 		      || section->alignment_power != osec->alignment_power)
   6910  1.1     skrll 		    goto rewrite;
   6911  1.1     skrll 		}
   6912  1.1     skrll 	    }
   6913  1.1     skrll 	}
   6914  1.1     skrll 
   6915  1.1     skrll       /* Check to see if any output section do not come from the
   6916  1.1     skrll 	 input BFD.  */
   6917  1.1     skrll       for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
   6918  1.1     skrll 	   section = section->next)
   6919  1.1     skrll 	{
   6920  1.1     skrll 	  if (section->segment_mark == FALSE)
   6921  1.1     skrll 	    goto rewrite;
   6922  1.1     skrll 	  else
   6923  1.1     skrll 	    section->segment_mark = FALSE;
   6924  1.1     skrll 	}
   6925  1.1     skrll 
   6926  1.1     skrll       return copy_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
   6927  1.1     skrll     }
   6928  1.5  christos 
   6929  1.5  christos rewrite:
   6930  1.5  christos   if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
   6931  1.5  christos     {
   6932  1.5  christos       /* When rewriting program header, set the output maxpagesize to
   6933  1.5  christos 	 the maximum alignment of input PT_LOAD segments.  */
   6934  1.5  christos       Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
   6935  1.5  christos       unsigned int i;
   6936  1.5  christos       unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
   6937  1.5  christos       bfd_vma maxpagesize = 0;
   6938  1.5  christos 
   6939  1.5  christos       for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
   6940  1.5  christos 	   i < num_segments;
   6941  1.5  christos 	   i++, segment++)
   6942  1.6  christos 	if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
   6943  1.6  christos 	    && maxpagesize < segment->p_align)
   6944  1.6  christos 	  {
   6945  1.6  christos 	    /* PR 17512: file: f17299af.  */
   6946  1.6  christos 	    if (segment->p_align > (bfd_vma) 1 << ((sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 2))
   6947  1.6  christos 	      (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("\
   6948  1.6  christos %B: warning: segment alignment of 0x%llx is too large"),
   6949  1.6  christos 				     ibfd, (long long) segment->p_align);
   6950  1.6  christos 	    else
   6951  1.5  christos 	      maxpagesize = segment->p_align;
   6952  1.5  christos 	  }
   6953  1.5  christos 
   6954  1.5  christos       if (maxpagesize != get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize)
   6955  1.5  christos 	bfd_emul_set_maxpagesize (bfd_get_target (obfd), maxpagesize);
   6956  1.1     skrll     }
   6957  1.1     skrll 
   6958  1.1     skrll   return rewrite_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
   6959  1.1     skrll }
   6960  1.1     skrll 
   6961  1.1     skrll /* Initialize private output section information from input section.  */
   6962  1.1     skrll 
   6963  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   6964  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
   6965  1.1     skrll 				    asection *isec,
   6966  1.1     skrll 				    bfd *obfd,
   6967  1.1     skrll 				    asection *osec,
   6968  1.1     skrll 				    struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
   6969  1.1     skrll 
   6970  1.6  christos {
   6971  1.6  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
   6972  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean final_link = (link_info != NULL
   6973  1.1     skrll 			    && !bfd_link_relocatable (link_info));
   6974  1.1     skrll 
   6975  1.1     skrll   if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
   6976  1.1     skrll       || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
   6977  1.5  christos     return TRUE;
   6978  1.5  christos 
   6979  1.3  christos   BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (osec) != NULL);
   6980  1.3  christos 
   6981  1.3  christos   /* For objcopy and relocatable link, don't copy the output ELF
   6982  1.3  christos      section type from input if the output BFD section flags have been
   6983  1.1     skrll      set to something different.  For a final link allow some flags
   6984  1.3  christos      that the linker clears to differ.  */
   6985  1.3  christos   if (elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NULL
   6986  1.3  christos       && (osec->flags == isec->flags
   6987  1.3  christos 	  || (final_link
   6988  1.1     skrll 	      && ((osec->flags ^ isec->flags)
   6989  1.1     skrll 		  & ~(SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES | SEC_RELOC)) == 0)))
   6990  1.1     skrll     elf_section_type (osec) = elf_section_type (isec);
   6991  1.1     skrll 
   6992  1.1     skrll   /* FIXME: Is this correct for all OS/PROC specific flags?  */
   6993  1.1     skrll   elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
   6994  1.1     skrll 			       & (SHF_MASKOS | SHF_MASKPROC));
   6995  1.1     skrll 
   6996  1.1     skrll   /* Set things up for objcopy and relocatable link.  The output
   6997  1.1     skrll      SHT_GROUP section will have its elf_next_in_group pointing back
   6998  1.3  christos      to the input group members.  Ignore linker created group section.
   6999  1.1     skrll      See elfNN_ia64_object_p in elfxx-ia64.c.  */
   7000  1.1     skrll   if (!final_link)
   7001  1.1     skrll     {
   7002  1.1     skrll       if (elf_sec_group (isec) == NULL
   7003  1.1     skrll 	  || (elf_sec_group (isec)->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
   7004  1.1     skrll 	{
   7005  1.1     skrll 	  if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GROUP)
   7006  1.2     skrll 	    elf_section_flags (osec) |= SHF_GROUP;
   7007  1.1     skrll 	  elf_next_in_group (osec) = elf_next_in_group (isec);
   7008  1.6  christos 	  elf_section_data (osec)->group = elf_section_data (isec)->group;
   7009  1.6  christos 	}
   7010  1.6  christos 
   7011  1.6  christos       /* If not decompress, preserve SHF_COMPRESSED.  */
   7012  1.6  christos       if ((ibfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS) == 0)
   7013  1.1     skrll 	elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
   7014  1.1     skrll 				     & SHF_COMPRESSED);
   7015  1.1     skrll     }
   7016  1.1     skrll 
   7017  1.1     skrll   ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
   7018  1.1     skrll 
   7019  1.1     skrll   /* We need to handle elf_linked_to_section for SHF_LINK_ORDER. We
   7020  1.1     skrll      don't use the output section of the linked-to section since it
   7021  1.1     skrll      may be NULL at this point.  */
   7022  1.1     skrll   if ((ihdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
   7023  1.1     skrll     {
   7024  1.1     skrll       ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
   7025  1.1     skrll       ohdr->sh_flags |= SHF_LINK_ORDER;
   7026  1.1     skrll       elf_linked_to_section (osec) = elf_linked_to_section (isec);
   7027  1.1     skrll     }
   7028  1.1     skrll 
   7029  1.1     skrll   osec->use_rela_p = isec->use_rela_p;
   7030  1.1     skrll 
   7031  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   7032  1.1     skrll }
   7033  1.1     skrll 
   7034  1.1     skrll /* Copy private section information.  This copies over the entsize
   7035  1.1     skrll    field, and sometimes the info field.  */
   7036  1.1     skrll 
   7037  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   7038  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
   7039  1.1     skrll 				    asection *isec,
   7040  1.1     skrll 				    bfd *obfd,
   7041  1.1     skrll 				    asection *osec)
   7042  1.1     skrll {
   7043  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
   7044  1.1     skrll 
   7045  1.1     skrll   if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
   7046  1.1     skrll       || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
   7047  1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   7048  1.1     skrll 
   7049  1.1     skrll   ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
   7050  1.1     skrll   ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
   7051  1.1     skrll 
   7052  1.1     skrll   ohdr->sh_entsize = ihdr->sh_entsize;
   7053  1.1     skrll 
   7054  1.1     skrll   if (ihdr->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
   7055  1.1     skrll       || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM
   7056  1.1     skrll       || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verneed
   7057  1.1     skrll       || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verdef)
   7058  1.1     skrll     ohdr->sh_info = ihdr->sh_info;
   7059  1.1     skrll 
   7060  1.1     skrll   return _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (ibfd, isec, obfd, osec,
   7061  1.1     skrll 					     NULL);
   7062  1.3  christos }
   7063  1.3  christos 
   7064  1.3  christos /* Look at all the SHT_GROUP sections in IBFD, making any adjustments
   7065  1.3  christos    necessary if we are removing either the SHT_GROUP section or any of
   7066  1.3  christos    the group member sections.  DISCARDED is the value that a section's
   7067  1.3  christos    output_section has if the section will be discarded, NULL when this
   7068  1.1     skrll    function is called from objcopy, bfd_abs_section_ptr when called
   7069  1.1     skrll    from the linker.  */
   7070  1.3  christos 
   7071  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   7072  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (bfd *ibfd, asection *discarded)
   7073  1.1     skrll {
   7074  1.1     skrll   asection *isec;
   7075  1.3  christos 
   7076  1.1     skrll   for (isec = ibfd->sections; isec != NULL; isec = isec->next)
   7077  1.1     skrll     if (elf_section_type (isec) == SHT_GROUP)
   7078  1.1     skrll       {
   7079  1.3  christos 	asection *first = elf_next_in_group (isec);
   7080  1.3  christos 	asection *s = first;
   7081  1.1     skrll 	bfd_size_type removed = 0;
   7082  1.1     skrll 
   7083  1.3  christos 	while (s != NULL)
   7084  1.3  christos 	  {
   7085  1.3  christos 	    /* If this member section is being output but the
   7086  1.3  christos 	       SHT_GROUP section is not, then clear the group info
   7087  1.3  christos 	       set up by _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data.  */
   7088  1.1     skrll 	    if (s->output_section != discarded
   7089  1.1     skrll 		&& isec->output_section == discarded)
   7090  1.1     skrll 	      {
   7091  1.1     skrll 		elf_section_flags (s->output_section) &= ~SHF_GROUP;
   7092  1.3  christos 		elf_group_name (s->output_section) = NULL;
   7093  1.3  christos 	      }
   7094  1.3  christos 	    /* Conversely, if the member section is not being output
   7095  1.3  christos 	       but the SHT_GROUP section is, then adjust its size.  */
   7096  1.3  christos 	    else if (s->output_section == discarded
   7097  1.1     skrll 		     && isec->output_section != discarded)
   7098  1.1     skrll 	      removed += 4;
   7099  1.1     skrll 	    s = elf_next_in_group (s);
   7100  1.1     skrll 	    if (s == first)
   7101  1.3  christos 	      break;
   7102  1.3  christos 	  }
   7103  1.3  christos 	if (removed != 0)
   7104  1.3  christos 	  {
   7105  1.3  christos 	    if (discarded != NULL)
   7106  1.3  christos 	      {
   7107  1.3  christos 		/* If we've been called for ld -r, then we need to
   7108  1.3  christos 		   adjust the input section size.  This function may
   7109  1.3  christos 		   be called multiple times, so save the original
   7110  1.3  christos 		   size.  */
   7111  1.3  christos 		if (isec->rawsize == 0)
   7112  1.3  christos 		  isec->rawsize = isec->size;
   7113  1.3  christos 		isec->size = isec->rawsize - removed;
   7114  1.3  christos 	      }
   7115  1.3  christos 	    else
   7116  1.3  christos 	      {
   7117  1.3  christos 		/* Adjust the output section size when called from
   7118  1.3  christos 		   objcopy. */
   7119  1.3  christos 		isec->output_section->size -= removed;
   7120  1.1     skrll 	      }
   7121  1.1     skrll 	  }
   7122  1.1     skrll       }
   7123  1.1     skrll 
   7124  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   7125  1.3  christos }
   7126  1.3  christos 
   7127  1.3  christos /* Copy private header information.  */
   7128  1.3  christos 
   7129  1.3  christos bfd_boolean
   7130  1.3  christos _bfd_elf_copy_private_header_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
   7131  1.3  christos {
   7132  1.3  christos   if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
   7133  1.3  christos       || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
   7134  1.3  christos     return TRUE;
   7135  1.3  christos 
   7136  1.3  christos   /* Copy over private BFD data if it has not already been copied.
   7137  1.3  christos      This must be done here, rather than in the copy_private_bfd_data
   7138  1.3  christos      entry point, because the latter is called after the section
   7139  1.6  christos      contents have been set, which means that the program headers have
   7140  1.3  christos      already been worked out.  */
   7141  1.3  christos   if (elf_seg_map (obfd) == NULL && elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr != NULL)
   7142  1.3  christos     {
   7143  1.3  christos       if (! copy_private_bfd_data (ibfd, obfd))
   7144  1.3  christos 	return FALSE;
   7145  1.3  christos     }
   7146  1.3  christos 
   7147  1.3  christos   return _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (ibfd, NULL);
   7148  1.1     skrll }
   7149  1.1     skrll 
   7150  1.1     skrll /* Copy private symbol information.  If this symbol is in a section
   7151  1.1     skrll    which we did not map into a BFD section, try to map the section
   7152  1.1     skrll    index correctly.  We use special macro definitions for the mapped
   7153  1.1     skrll    section indices; these definitions are interpreted by the
   7154  1.1     skrll    swap_out_syms function.  */
   7155  1.1     skrll 
   7156  1.1     skrll #define MAP_ONESYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 1)
   7157  1.1     skrll #define MAP_DYNSYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 2)
   7158  1.1     skrll #define MAP_STRTAB    (SHN_HIOS + 3)
   7159  1.1     skrll #define MAP_SHSTRTAB  (SHN_HIOS + 4)
   7160  1.1     skrll #define MAP_SYM_SHNDX (SHN_HIOS + 5)
   7161  1.1     skrll 
   7162  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   7163  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_copy_private_symbol_data (bfd *ibfd,
   7164  1.1     skrll 				   asymbol *isymarg,
   7165  1.1     skrll 				   bfd *obfd,
   7166  1.1     skrll 				   asymbol *osymarg)
   7167  1.1     skrll {
   7168  1.1     skrll   elf_symbol_type *isym, *osym;
   7169  1.1     skrll 
   7170  1.1     skrll   if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
   7171  1.1     skrll       || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
   7172  1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   7173  1.1     skrll 
   7174  1.1     skrll   isym = elf_symbol_from (ibfd, isymarg);
   7175  1.1     skrll   osym = elf_symbol_from (obfd, osymarg);
   7176  1.1     skrll 
   7177  1.1     skrll   if (isym != NULL
   7178  1.1     skrll       && isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
   7179  1.1     skrll       && osym != NULL
   7180  1.1     skrll       && bfd_is_abs_section (isym->symbol.section))
   7181  1.1     skrll     {
   7182  1.1     skrll       unsigned int shndx;
   7183  1.1     skrll 
   7184  1.1     skrll       shndx = isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
   7185  1.1     skrll       if (shndx == elf_onesymtab (ibfd))
   7186  1.1     skrll 	shndx = MAP_ONESYMTAB;
   7187  1.6  christos       else if (shndx == elf_dynsymtab (ibfd))
   7188  1.1     skrll 	shndx = MAP_DYNSYMTAB;
   7189  1.6  christos       else if (shndx == elf_strtab_sec (ibfd))
   7190  1.1     skrll 	shndx = MAP_STRTAB;
   7191  1.6  christos       else if (shndx == elf_shstrtab_sec (ibfd))
   7192  1.1     skrll 	shndx = MAP_SHSTRTAB;
   7193  1.1     skrll       else if (find_section_in_list (shndx, elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)))
   7194  1.1     skrll 	shndx = MAP_SYM_SHNDX;
   7195  1.1     skrll       osym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx = shndx;
   7196  1.1     skrll     }
   7197  1.1     skrll 
   7198  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   7199  1.1     skrll }
   7200  1.1     skrll 
   7201  1.1     skrll /* Swap out the symbols.  */
   7202  1.1     skrll 
   7203  1.6  christos static bfd_boolean
   7204  1.1     skrll swap_out_syms (bfd *abfd,
   7205  1.1     skrll 	       struct elf_strtab_hash **sttp,
   7206  1.1     skrll 	       int relocatable_p)
   7207  1.1     skrll {
   7208  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   7209  1.6  christos   int symcount;
   7210  1.1     skrll   asymbol **syms;
   7211  1.1     skrll   struct elf_strtab_hash *stt;
   7212  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   7213  1.6  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_shndx_hdr;
   7214  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symstrtab_hdr;
   7215  1.1     skrll   struct elf_sym_strtab *symstrtab;
   7216  1.6  christos   bfd_byte *outbound_syms;
   7217  1.6  christos   bfd_byte *outbound_shndx;
   7218  1.1     skrll   unsigned long outbound_syms_index;
   7219  1.6  christos   unsigned long outbound_shndx_index;
   7220  1.1     skrll   int idx;
   7221  1.1     skrll   unsigned int num_locals;
   7222  1.1     skrll   bfd_size_type amt;
   7223  1.6  christos   bfd_boolean name_local_sections;
   7224  1.1     skrll 
   7225  1.1     skrll   if (!elf_map_symbols (abfd, &num_locals))
   7226  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   7227  1.6  christos 
   7228  1.1     skrll   /* Dump out the symtabs.  */
   7229  1.1     skrll   stt = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
   7230  1.1     skrll   if (stt == NULL)
   7231  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   7232  1.1     skrll 
   7233  1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   7234  1.1     skrll   symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
   7235  1.1     skrll   symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
   7236  1.1     skrll   symtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB;
   7237  1.6  christos   symtab_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
   7238  1.1     skrll   symtab_hdr->sh_size = symtab_hdr->sh_entsize * (symcount + 1);
   7239  1.1     skrll   symtab_hdr->sh_info = num_locals + 1;
   7240  1.1     skrll   symtab_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
   7241  1.1     skrll 
   7242  1.1     skrll   symstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
   7243  1.6  christos   symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
   7244  1.6  christos 
   7245  1.6  christos   /* Allocate buffer to swap out the .strtab section.  */
   7246  1.6  christos   symstrtab = (struct elf_sym_strtab *) bfd_malloc ((symcount + 1)
   7247  1.6  christos 						    * sizeof (*symstrtab));
   7248  1.6  christos   if (symstrtab == NULL)
   7249  1.6  christos     {
   7250  1.6  christos       _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
   7251  1.6  christos       return FALSE;
   7252  1.3  christos     }
   7253  1.3  christos 
   7254  1.1     skrll   outbound_syms = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount,
   7255  1.1     skrll                                            bed->s->sizeof_sym);
   7256  1.6  christos   if (outbound_syms == NULL)
   7257  1.6  christos     {
   7258  1.6  christos error_return:
   7259  1.1     skrll       _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
   7260  1.1     skrll       free (symstrtab);
   7261  1.1     skrll       return FALSE;
   7262  1.6  christos     }
   7263  1.1     skrll   symtab_hdr->contents = outbound_syms;
   7264  1.1     skrll   outbound_syms_index = 0;
   7265  1.6  christos 
   7266  1.6  christos   outbound_shndx = NULL;
   7267  1.6  christos   outbound_shndx_index = 0;
   7268  1.1     skrll 
   7269  1.6  christos   if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
   7270  1.6  christos     {
   7271  1.1     skrll       symtab_shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
   7272  1.6  christos       if (symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_name != 0)
   7273  1.6  christos 	{
   7274  1.6  christos 	  amt = (bfd_size_type) (1 + symcount) * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
   7275  1.6  christos 	  outbound_shndx =  (bfd_byte *)
   7276  1.6  christos 	    bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
   7277  1.6  christos 	  if (outbound_shndx == NULL)
   7278  1.6  christos 	    goto error_return;
   7279  1.6  christos 
   7280  1.6  christos 	  symtab_shndx_hdr->contents = outbound_shndx;
   7281  1.6  christos 	  symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX;
   7282  1.6  christos 	  symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_size = amt;
   7283  1.1     skrll 	  symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_addralign = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
   7284  1.6  christos 	  symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
   7285  1.1     skrll 	}
   7286  1.1     skrll       /* FIXME: What about any other headers in the list ?  */
   7287  1.1     skrll     }
   7288  1.1     skrll 
   7289  1.1     skrll   /* Now generate the data (for "contents").  */
   7290  1.1     skrll   {
   7291  1.1     skrll     /* Fill in zeroth symbol and swap it out.  */
   7292  1.1     skrll     Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
   7293  1.1     skrll     sym.st_name = 0;
   7294  1.1     skrll     sym.st_value = 0;
   7295  1.1     skrll     sym.st_size = 0;
   7296  1.1     skrll     sym.st_info = 0;
   7297  1.5  christos     sym.st_other = 0;
   7298  1.6  christos     sym.st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
   7299  1.6  christos     sym.st_target_internal = 0;
   7300  1.6  christos     symstrtab[0].sym = sym;
   7301  1.6  christos     symstrtab[0].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
   7302  1.1     skrll     symstrtab[0].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
   7303  1.6  christos     outbound_syms_index++;
   7304  1.1     skrll     if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
   7305  1.1     skrll       outbound_shndx_index++;
   7306  1.1     skrll   }
   7307  1.1     skrll 
   7308  1.1     skrll   name_local_sections
   7309  1.1     skrll     = (bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols
   7310  1.1     skrll        && bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols (abfd));
   7311  1.6  christos 
   7312  1.1     skrll   syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
   7313  1.1     skrll   for (idx = 0; idx < symcount;)
   7314  1.1     skrll     {
   7315  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
   7316  1.1     skrll       bfd_vma value = syms[idx]->value;
   7317  1.1     skrll       elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
   7318  1.1     skrll       flagword flags = syms[idx]->flags;
   7319  1.1     skrll       int type;
   7320  1.1     skrll 
   7321  1.1     skrll       if (!name_local_sections
   7322  1.1     skrll 	  && (flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_GLOBAL)) == BSF_SECTION_SYM)
   7323  1.6  christos 	{
   7324  1.1     skrll 	  /* Local section symbols have no name.  */
   7325  1.1     skrll 	  sym.st_name = (unsigned long) -1;
   7326  1.1     skrll 	}
   7327  1.6  christos       else
   7328  1.6  christos 	{
   7329  1.6  christos 	  /* Call _bfd_elf_strtab_offset after _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize
   7330  1.6  christos 	     to get the final offset for st_name.  */
   7331  1.6  christos 	  sym.st_name
   7332  1.1     skrll 	    = (unsigned long) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (stt, syms[idx]->name,
   7333  1.6  christos 						   FALSE);
   7334  1.1     skrll 	  if (sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
   7335  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return;
   7336  1.1     skrll 	}
   7337  1.1     skrll 
   7338  1.1     skrll       type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, syms[idx]);
   7339  1.1     skrll 
   7340  1.1     skrll       if ((flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
   7341  1.1     skrll 	  && bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
   7342  1.1     skrll 	{
   7343  1.1     skrll 	  /* ELF common symbols put the alignment into the `value' field,
   7344  1.1     skrll 	     and the size into the `size' field.  This is backwards from
   7345  1.1     skrll 	     how BFD handles it, so reverse it here.  */
   7346  1.1     skrll 	  sym.st_size = value;
   7347  1.1     skrll 	  if (type_ptr == NULL
   7348  1.1     skrll 	      || type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value == 0)
   7349  1.1     skrll 	    sym.st_value = value >= 16 ? 16 : (1 << bfd_log2 (value));
   7350  1.1     skrll 	  else
   7351  1.1     skrll 	    sym.st_value = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
   7352  1.1     skrll 	  sym.st_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
   7353  1.1     skrll 	    (abfd, syms[idx]->section);
   7354  1.1     skrll 	}
   7355  1.1     skrll       else
   7356  1.1     skrll 	{
   7357  1.1     skrll 	  asection *sec = syms[idx]->section;
   7358  1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int shndx;
   7359  1.1     skrll 
   7360  1.1     skrll 	  if (sec->output_section)
   7361  1.1     skrll 	    {
   7362  1.1     skrll 	      value += sec->output_offset;
   7363  1.1     skrll 	      sec = sec->output_section;
   7364  1.1     skrll 	    }
   7365  1.1     skrll 
   7366  1.1     skrll 	  /* Don't add in the section vma for relocatable output.  */
   7367  1.1     skrll 	  if (! relocatable_p)
   7368  1.1     skrll 	    value += sec->vma;
   7369  1.1     skrll 	  sym.st_value = value;
   7370  1.1     skrll 	  sym.st_size = type_ptr ? type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_size : 0;
   7371  1.1     skrll 
   7372  1.1     skrll 	  if (bfd_is_abs_section (sec)
   7373  1.1     skrll 	      && type_ptr != NULL
   7374  1.1     skrll 	      && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0)
   7375  1.1     skrll 	    {
   7376  1.1     skrll 	      /* This symbol is in a real ELF section which we did
   7377  1.1     skrll 		 not create as a BFD section.  Undo the mapping done
   7378  1.1     skrll 		 by copy_private_symbol_data.  */
   7379  1.1     skrll 	      shndx = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
   7380  1.1     skrll 	      switch (shndx)
   7381  1.1     skrll 		{
   7382  1.1     skrll 		case MAP_ONESYMTAB:
   7383  1.1     skrll 		  shndx = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
   7384  1.1     skrll 		  break;
   7385  1.1     skrll 		case MAP_DYNSYMTAB:
   7386  1.1     skrll 		  shndx = elf_dynsymtab (abfd);
   7387  1.6  christos 		  break;
   7388  1.1     skrll 		case MAP_STRTAB:
   7389  1.1     skrll 		  shndx = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
   7390  1.6  christos 		  break;
   7391  1.1     skrll 		case MAP_SHSTRTAB:
   7392  1.1     skrll 		  shndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
   7393  1.6  christos 		  break;
   7394  1.6  christos 		case MAP_SYM_SHNDX:
   7395  1.1     skrll 		  if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
   7396  1.1     skrll 		    shndx = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx;
   7397  1.5  christos 		  break;
   7398  1.1     skrll 		default:
   7399  1.1     skrll 		  shndx = SHN_ABS;
   7400  1.1     skrll 		  break;
   7401  1.1     skrll 		}
   7402  1.1     skrll 	    }
   7403  1.1     skrll 	  else
   7404  1.1     skrll 	    {
   7405  1.1     skrll 	      shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec);
   7406  1.1     skrll 
   7407  1.1     skrll 	      if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
   7408  1.1     skrll 		{
   7409  1.1     skrll 		  asection *sec2;
   7410  1.1     skrll 
   7411  1.1     skrll 		  /* Writing this would be a hell of a lot easier if
   7412  1.1     skrll 		     we had some decent documentation on bfd, and
   7413  1.1     skrll 		     knew what to expect of the library, and what to
   7414  1.1     skrll 		     demand of applications.  For example, it
   7415  1.1     skrll 		     appears that `objcopy' might not set the
   7416  1.1     skrll 		     section of a symbol to be a section that is
   7417  1.1     skrll 		     actually in the output file.  */
   7418  1.1     skrll 		  sec2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec->name);
   7419  1.1     skrll 		  if (sec2 == NULL)
   7420  1.1     skrll 		    {
   7421  1.1     skrll 		      _bfd_error_handler (_("\
   7422  1.1     skrll Unable to find equivalent output section for symbol '%s' from section '%s'"),
   7423  1.1     skrll 					  syms[idx]->name ? syms[idx]->name : "<Local sym>",
   7424  1.6  christos 					  sec->name);
   7425  1.1     skrll 		      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
   7426  1.1     skrll 		      goto error_return;
   7427  1.1     skrll 		    }
   7428  1.1     skrll 
   7429  1.1     skrll 		  shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec2);
   7430  1.1     skrll 		  BFD_ASSERT (shndx != SHN_BAD);
   7431  1.1     skrll 		}
   7432  1.1     skrll 	    }
   7433  1.1     skrll 
   7434  1.1     skrll 	  sym.st_shndx = shndx;
   7435  1.1     skrll 	}
   7436  1.1     skrll 
   7437  1.3  christos       if ((flags & BSF_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
   7438  1.3  christos 	type = STT_TLS;
   7439  1.1     skrll       else if ((flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION) != 0)
   7440  1.1     skrll 	type = STT_GNU_IFUNC;
   7441  1.1     skrll       else if ((flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0)
   7442  1.1     skrll 	type = STT_FUNC;
   7443  1.1     skrll       else if ((flags & BSF_OBJECT) != 0)
   7444  1.1     skrll 	type = STT_OBJECT;
   7445  1.1     skrll       else if ((flags & BSF_RELC) != 0)
   7446  1.1     skrll 	type = STT_RELC;
   7447  1.1     skrll       else if ((flags & BSF_SRELC) != 0)
   7448  1.1     skrll 	type = STT_SRELC;
   7449  1.1     skrll       else
   7450  1.1     skrll 	type = STT_NOTYPE;
   7451  1.1     skrll 
   7452  1.1     skrll       if (syms[idx]->section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
   7453  1.1     skrll 	type = STT_TLS;
   7454  1.1     skrll 
   7455  1.1     skrll       /* Processor-specific types.  */
   7456  1.1     skrll       if (type_ptr != NULL
   7457  1.1     skrll 	  && bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
   7458  1.1     skrll 	type = ((*bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
   7459  1.1     skrll 		(&type_ptr->internal_elf_sym, type));
   7460  1.1     skrll 
   7461  1.1     skrll       if (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
   7462  1.1     skrll 	{
   7463  1.1     skrll 	  if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
   7464  1.1     skrll 	    sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
   7465  1.1     skrll 	  else
   7466  1.1     skrll 	    sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_SECTION);
   7467  1.1     skrll 	}
   7468  1.1     skrll       else if (bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
   7469  1.1     skrll 	{
   7470  1.1     skrll #ifdef USE_STT_COMMON
   7471  1.1     skrll 	  if (type == STT_OBJECT)
   7472  1.3  christos 	    sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_COMMON);
   7473  1.1     skrll 	  else
   7474  1.1     skrll #endif
   7475  1.1     skrll 	    sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, type);
   7476  1.1     skrll 	}
   7477  1.1     skrll       else if (bfd_is_und_section (syms[idx]->section))
   7478  1.1     skrll 	sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (((flags & BSF_WEAK)
   7479  1.1     skrll 				    ? STB_WEAK
   7480  1.1     skrll 				    : STB_GLOBAL),
   7481  1.1     skrll 				   type);
   7482  1.1     skrll       else if (flags & BSF_FILE)
   7483  1.1     skrll 	sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FILE);
   7484  1.1     skrll       else
   7485  1.1     skrll 	{
   7486  1.1     skrll 	  int bind = STB_LOCAL;
   7487  1.1     skrll 
   7488  1.3  christos 	  if (flags & BSF_LOCAL)
   7489  1.3  christos 	    bind = STB_LOCAL;
   7490  1.1     skrll 	  else if (flags & BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)
   7491  1.1     skrll 	    bind = STB_GNU_UNIQUE;
   7492  1.1     skrll 	  else if (flags & BSF_WEAK)
   7493  1.1     skrll 	    bind = STB_WEAK;
   7494  1.1     skrll 	  else if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
   7495  1.1     skrll 	    bind = STB_GLOBAL;
   7496  1.1     skrll 
   7497  1.1     skrll 	  sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (bind, type);
   7498  1.1     skrll 	}
   7499  1.5  christos 
   7500  1.5  christos       if (type_ptr != NULL)
   7501  1.5  christos 	{
   7502  1.5  christos 	  sym.st_other = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
   7503  1.5  christos 	  sym.st_target_internal
   7504  1.1     skrll 	    = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_target_internal;
   7505  1.5  christos 	}
   7506  1.5  christos       else
   7507  1.5  christos 	{
   7508  1.5  christos 	  sym.st_other = 0;
   7509  1.1     skrll 	  sym.st_target_internal = 0;
   7510  1.6  christos 	}
   7511  1.6  christos 
   7512  1.6  christos       idx++;
   7513  1.6  christos       symstrtab[idx].sym = sym;
   7514  1.6  christos       symstrtab[idx].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
   7515  1.6  christos       symstrtab[idx].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
   7516  1.1     skrll 
   7517  1.6  christos       outbound_syms_index++;
   7518  1.1     skrll       if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
   7519  1.1     skrll 	outbound_shndx_index++;
   7520  1.6  christos     }
   7521  1.6  christos 
   7522  1.6  christos   /* Finalize the .strtab section.  */
   7523  1.6  christos   _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (stt);
   7524  1.6  christos 
   7525  1.6  christos   /* Swap out the .strtab section.  */
   7526  1.6  christos   for (idx = 0; idx <= symcount; idx++)
   7527  1.6  christos     {
   7528  1.6  christos       struct elf_sym_strtab *elfsym = &symstrtab[idx];
   7529  1.6  christos       if (elfsym->sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
   7530  1.6  christos 	elfsym->sym.st_name = 0;
   7531  1.6  christos       else
   7532  1.6  christos 	elfsym->sym.st_name = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (stt,
   7533  1.6  christos 						      elfsym->sym.st_name);
   7534  1.6  christos       bed->s->swap_symbol_out (abfd, &elfsym->sym,
   7535  1.6  christos 			       (outbound_syms
   7536  1.6  christos 				+ (elfsym->dest_index
   7537  1.6  christos 				   * bed->s->sizeof_sym)),
   7538  1.6  christos 			       (outbound_shndx
   7539  1.6  christos 				+ (elfsym->destshndx_index
   7540  1.6  christos 				   * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx))));
   7541  1.6  christos     }
   7542  1.1     skrll   free (symstrtab);
   7543  1.6  christos 
   7544  1.1     skrll   *sttp = stt;
   7545  1.1     skrll   symstrtab_hdr->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (stt);
   7546  1.1     skrll   symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
   7547  1.1     skrll 
   7548  1.1     skrll   symstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
   7549  1.1     skrll   symstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
   7550  1.1     skrll   symstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
   7551  1.1     skrll   symstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
   7552  1.1     skrll   symstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
   7553  1.1     skrll   symstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
   7554  1.1     skrll 
   7555  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   7556  1.1     skrll }
   7557  1.1     skrll 
   7558  1.1     skrll /* Return the number of bytes required to hold the symtab vector.
   7559  1.1     skrll 
   7560  1.1     skrll    Note that we base it on the count plus 1, since we will null terminate
   7561  1.1     skrll    the vector allocated based on this size.  However, the ELF symbol table
   7562  1.1     skrll    always has a dummy entry as symbol #0, so it ends up even.  */
   7563  1.1     skrll 
   7564  1.1     skrll long
   7565  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_get_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
   7566  1.1     skrll {
   7567  1.1     skrll   long symcount;
   7568  1.1     skrll   long symtab_size;
   7569  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
   7570  1.1     skrll 
   7571  1.1     skrll   symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
   7572  1.1     skrll   symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
   7573  1.1     skrll   if (symcount > 0)
   7574  1.1     skrll     symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
   7575  1.1     skrll 
   7576  1.1     skrll   return symtab_size;
   7577  1.1     skrll }
   7578  1.1     skrll 
   7579  1.1     skrll long
   7580  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
   7581  1.1     skrll {
   7582  1.1     skrll   long symcount;
   7583  1.1     skrll   long symtab_size;
   7584  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
   7585  1.1     skrll 
   7586  1.1     skrll   if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
   7587  1.1     skrll     {
   7588  1.1     skrll       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
   7589  1.1     skrll       return -1;
   7590  1.1     skrll     }
   7591  1.1     skrll 
   7592  1.1     skrll   symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
   7593  1.1     skrll   symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
   7594  1.1     skrll   if (symcount > 0)
   7595  1.1     skrll     symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
   7596  1.1     skrll 
   7597  1.1     skrll   return symtab_size;
   7598  1.1     skrll }
   7599  1.1     skrll 
   7600  1.1     skrll long
   7601  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_get_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   7602  1.1     skrll 				sec_ptr asect)
   7603  1.1     skrll {
   7604  1.1     skrll   return (asect->reloc_count + 1) * sizeof (arelent *);
   7605  1.1     skrll }
   7606  1.1     skrll 
   7607  1.1     skrll /* Canonicalize the relocs.  */
   7608  1.1     skrll 
   7609  1.1     skrll long
   7610  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_canonicalize_reloc (bfd *abfd,
   7611  1.1     skrll 			     sec_ptr section,
   7612  1.1     skrll 			     arelent **relptr,
   7613  1.1     skrll 			     asymbol **symbols)
   7614  1.1     skrll {
   7615  1.1     skrll   arelent *tblptr;
   7616  1.1     skrll   unsigned int i;
   7617  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   7618  1.1     skrll 
   7619  1.1     skrll   if (! bed->s->slurp_reloc_table (abfd, section, symbols, FALSE))
   7620  1.1     skrll     return -1;
   7621  1.1     skrll 
   7622  1.1     skrll   tblptr = section->relocation;
   7623  1.1     skrll   for (i = 0; i < section->reloc_count; i++)
   7624  1.1     skrll     *relptr++ = tblptr++;
   7625  1.1     skrll 
   7626  1.1     skrll   *relptr = NULL;
   7627  1.1     skrll 
   7628  1.1     skrll   return section->reloc_count;
   7629  1.1     skrll }
   7630  1.1     skrll 
   7631  1.1     skrll long
   7632  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_canonicalize_symtab (bfd *abfd, asymbol **allocation)
   7633  1.1     skrll {
   7634  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   7635  1.1     skrll   long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, FALSE);
   7636  1.1     skrll 
   7637  1.1     skrll   if (symcount >= 0)
   7638  1.1     skrll     bfd_get_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
   7639  1.1     skrll   return symcount;
   7640  1.1     skrll }
   7641  1.1     skrll 
   7642  1.1     skrll long
   7643  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
   7644  1.1     skrll 				      asymbol **allocation)
   7645  1.1     skrll {
   7646  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   7647  1.1     skrll   long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, TRUE);
   7648  1.1     skrll 
   7649  1.1     skrll   if (symcount >= 0)
   7650  1.1     skrll     bfd_get_dynamic_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
   7651  1.1     skrll   return symcount;
   7652  1.1     skrll }
   7653  1.1     skrll 
   7654  1.1     skrll /* Return the size required for the dynamic reloc entries.  Any loadable
   7655  1.1     skrll    section that was actually installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL
   7656  1.1     skrll    or SHT_RELA, and uses the dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a
   7657  1.1     skrll    dynamic reloc section.  */
   7658  1.1     skrll 
   7659  1.1     skrll long
   7660  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
   7661  1.1     skrll {
   7662  1.1     skrll   long ret;
   7663  1.1     skrll   asection *s;
   7664  1.1     skrll 
   7665  1.1     skrll   if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
   7666  1.1     skrll     {
   7667  1.1     skrll       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
   7668  1.1     skrll       return -1;
   7669  1.1     skrll     }
   7670  1.1     skrll 
   7671  1.1     skrll   ret = sizeof (arelent *);
   7672  1.1     skrll   for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   7673  1.1     skrll     if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
   7674  1.1     skrll 	&& (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
   7675  1.1     skrll 	    || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
   7676  1.1     skrll       ret += ((s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize)
   7677  1.1     skrll 	      * sizeof (arelent *));
   7678  1.1     skrll 
   7679  1.1     skrll   return ret;
   7680  1.1     skrll }
   7681  1.1     skrll 
   7682  1.1     skrll /* Canonicalize the dynamic relocation entries.  Note that we return the
   7683  1.1     skrll    dynamic relocations as a single block, although they are actually
   7684  1.1     skrll    associated with particular sections; the interface, which was
   7685  1.1     skrll    designed for SunOS style shared libraries, expects that there is only
   7686  1.1     skrll    one set of dynamic relocs.  Any loadable section that was actually
   7687  1.1     skrll    installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL or SHT_RELA, and uses the
   7688  1.1     skrll    dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a dynamic reloc section.  */
   7689  1.1     skrll 
   7690  1.1     skrll long
   7691  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_reloc (bfd *abfd,
   7692  1.1     skrll 				     arelent **storage,
   7693  1.1     skrll 				     asymbol **syms)
   7694  1.1     skrll {
   7695  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
   7696  1.1     skrll   asection *s;
   7697  1.1     skrll   long ret;
   7698  1.1     skrll 
   7699  1.1     skrll   if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
   7700  1.1     skrll     {
   7701  1.1     skrll       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
   7702  1.1     skrll       return -1;
   7703  1.1     skrll     }
   7704  1.1     skrll 
   7705  1.1     skrll   slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
   7706  1.1     skrll   ret = 0;
   7707  1.1     skrll   for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   7708  1.1     skrll     {
   7709  1.1     skrll       if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
   7710  1.1     skrll 	  && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
   7711  1.1     skrll 	      || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
   7712  1.1     skrll 	{
   7713  1.1     skrll 	  arelent *p;
   7714  1.1     skrll 	  long count, i;
   7715  1.1     skrll 
   7716  1.1     skrll 	  if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, s, syms, TRUE))
   7717  1.1     skrll 	    return -1;
   7718  1.1     skrll 	  count = s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize;
   7719  1.1     skrll 	  p = s->relocation;
   7720  1.1     skrll 	  for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
   7721  1.1     skrll 	    *storage++ = p++;
   7722  1.1     skrll 	  ret += count;
   7723  1.1     skrll 	}
   7724  1.1     skrll     }
   7725  1.1     skrll 
   7726  1.1     skrll   *storage = NULL;
   7727  1.1     skrll 
   7728  1.1     skrll   return ret;
   7729  1.1     skrll }
   7730  1.1     skrll 
   7731  1.1     skrll /* Read in the version information.  */
   7733  1.1     skrll 
   7734  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   7735  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean default_imported_symver)
   7736  1.1     skrll {
   7737  1.1     skrll   bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
   7738  1.1     skrll   unsigned int freeidx = 0;
   7739  1.1     skrll 
   7740  1.1     skrll   if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
   7741  1.1     skrll     {
   7742  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
   7743  1.1     skrll       Elf_External_Verneed *everneed;
   7744  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Verneed *iverneed;
   7745  1.1     skrll       unsigned int i;
   7746  1.1     skrll       bfd_byte *contents_end;
   7747  1.6  christos 
   7748  1.1     skrll       hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr;
   7749  1.6  christos 
   7750  1.6  christos       if (hdr->sh_info == 0 || hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed))
   7751  1.6  christos 	{
   7752  1.6  christos error_return_bad_verref:
   7753  1.1     skrll 	  (*_bfd_error_handler)
   7754  1.1     skrll 	    (_("%B: .gnu.version_r invalid entry"), abfd);
   7755  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   7756  1.1     skrll error_return_verref:
   7757  1.1     skrll 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = NULL;
   7758  1.6  christos 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = 0;
   7759  1.6  christos 	  goto error_return;
   7760  1.6  christos 	}
   7761  1.6  christos 
   7762  1.6  christos       contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
   7763  1.1     skrll       if (contents == NULL)
   7764  1.1     skrll 	goto error_return_verref;
   7765  1.1     skrll 
   7766  1.1     skrll       if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
   7767  1.6  christos 	  || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
   7768  1.6  christos 	goto error_return_verref;
   7769  1.6  christos 
   7770  1.6  christos       elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = (Elf_Internal_Verneed *)
   7771  1.1     skrll 	bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, hdr->sh_info, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verneed));
   7772  1.1     skrll 
   7773  1.1     skrll       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL)
   7774  1.1     skrll 	goto error_return_verref;
   7775  1.1     skrll 
   7776  1.1     skrll       BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed)
   7777  1.1     skrll 		  == sizeof (Elf_External_Vernaux));
   7778  1.1     skrll       contents_end = contents + hdr->sh_size - sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed);
   7779  1.1     skrll       everneed = (Elf_External_Verneed *) contents;
   7780  1.1     skrll       iverneed = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
   7781  1.1     skrll       for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++, iverneed++)
   7782  1.1     skrll 	{
   7783  1.1     skrll 	  Elf_External_Vernaux *evernaux;
   7784  1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Vernaux *ivernaux;
   7785  1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int j;
   7786  1.1     skrll 
   7787  1.1     skrll 	  _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (abfd, everneed, iverneed);
   7788  1.1     skrll 
   7789  1.1     skrll 	  iverneed->vn_bfd = abfd;
   7790  1.1     skrll 
   7791  1.1     skrll 	  iverneed->vn_filename =
   7792  1.6  christos 	    bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
   7793  1.1     skrll 					     iverneed->vn_file);
   7794  1.1     skrll 	  if (iverneed->vn_filename == NULL)
   7795  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return_bad_verref;
   7796  1.1     skrll 
   7797  1.1     skrll 	  if (iverneed->vn_cnt == 0)
   7798  1.3  christos 	    iverneed->vn_auxptr = NULL;
   7799  1.3  christos 	  else
   7800  1.3  christos 	    {
   7801  1.1     skrll 	      iverneed->vn_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_vernaux *)
   7802  1.1     skrll                   bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverneed->vn_cnt,
   7803  1.1     skrll                               sizeof (Elf_Internal_Vernaux));
   7804  1.1     skrll 	      if (iverneed->vn_auxptr == NULL)
   7805  1.1     skrll 		goto error_return_verref;
   7806  1.1     skrll 	    }
   7807  1.6  christos 
   7808  1.1     skrll 	  if (iverneed->vn_aux
   7809  1.1     skrll 	      > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
   7810  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return_bad_verref;
   7811  1.1     skrll 
   7812  1.1     skrll 	  evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
   7813  1.1     skrll 		      ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_aux));
   7814  1.1     skrll 	  ivernaux = iverneed->vn_auxptr;
   7815  1.1     skrll 	  for (j = 0; j < iverneed->vn_cnt; j++, ivernaux++)
   7816  1.1     skrll 	    {
   7817  1.1     skrll 	      _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (abfd, evernaux, ivernaux);
   7818  1.1     skrll 
   7819  1.1     skrll 	      ivernaux->vna_nodename =
   7820  1.6  christos 		bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
   7821  1.6  christos 						 ivernaux->vna_name);
   7822  1.6  christos 	      if (ivernaux->vna_nodename == NULL)
   7823  1.6  christos 		goto error_return_bad_verref;
   7824  1.1     skrll 
   7825  1.6  christos 	      if (ivernaux->vna_other > freeidx)
   7826  1.6  christos 		freeidx = ivernaux->vna_other;
   7827  1.6  christos 
   7828  1.6  christos 	      ivernaux->vna_nextptr = NULL;
   7829  1.6  christos 	      if (ivernaux->vna_next == 0)
   7830  1.6  christos 		{
   7831  1.1     skrll 		  iverneed->vn_cnt = j + 1;
   7832  1.1     skrll 		  break;
   7833  1.1     skrll 		}
   7834  1.1     skrll 	      if (j + 1 < iverneed->vn_cnt)
   7835  1.1     skrll 		ivernaux->vna_nextptr = ivernaux + 1;
   7836  1.6  christos 
   7837  1.1     skrll 	      if (ivernaux->vna_next
   7838  1.1     skrll 		  > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) evernaux))
   7839  1.1     skrll 		goto error_return_bad_verref;
   7840  1.1     skrll 
   7841  1.1     skrll 	      evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
   7842  1.6  christos 			  ((bfd_byte *) evernaux + ivernaux->vna_next));
   7843  1.6  christos 	    }
   7844  1.6  christos 
   7845  1.1     skrll 	  iverneed->vn_nextref = NULL;
   7846  1.1     skrll 	  if (iverneed->vn_next == 0)
   7847  1.1     skrll 	    break;
   7848  1.1     skrll 	  if (i + 1 < hdr->sh_info)
   7849  1.1     skrll 	    iverneed->vn_nextref = iverneed + 1;
   7850  1.6  christos 
   7851  1.1     skrll 	  if (iverneed->vn_next
   7852  1.1     skrll 	      > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
   7853  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return_bad_verref;
   7854  1.1     skrll 
   7855  1.6  christos 	  everneed = ((Elf_External_Verneed *)
   7856  1.1     skrll 		      ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_next));
   7857  1.1     skrll 	}
   7858  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = i;
   7859  1.1     skrll 
   7860  1.1     skrll       free (contents);
   7861  1.1     skrll       contents = NULL;
   7862  1.1     skrll     }
   7863  1.1     skrll 
   7864  1.1     skrll   if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
   7865  1.1     skrll     {
   7866  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
   7867  1.1     skrll       Elf_External_Verdef *everdef;
   7868  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
   7869  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdefarr;
   7870  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Verdef iverdefmem;
   7871  1.1     skrll       unsigned int i;
   7872  1.1     skrll       unsigned int maxidx;
   7873  1.1     skrll       bfd_byte *contents_end_def, *contents_end_aux;
   7874  1.6  christos 
   7875  1.6  christos       hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr;
   7876  1.6  christos 
   7877  1.6  christos       if (hdr->sh_info == 0 || hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef))
   7878  1.6  christos 	{
   7879  1.6  christos 	error_return_bad_verdef:
   7880  1.6  christos 	  (*_bfd_error_handler)
   7881  1.6  christos 	    (_("%B: .gnu.version_d invalid entry"), abfd);
   7882  1.6  christos 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   7883  1.6  christos 	error_return_verdef:
   7884  1.6  christos 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = NULL;
   7885  1.6  christos 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = 0;
   7886  1.3  christos 	  goto error_return;
   7887  1.1     skrll 	}
   7888  1.6  christos 
   7889  1.1     skrll       contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
   7890  1.1     skrll       if (contents == NULL)
   7891  1.6  christos 	goto error_return_verdef;
   7892  1.1     skrll       if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
   7893  1.1     skrll 	  || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
   7894  1.1     skrll 	goto error_return_verdef;
   7895  1.1     skrll 
   7896  1.1     skrll       BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef)
   7897  1.1     skrll 		  >= sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux));
   7898  1.1     skrll       contents_end_def = contents + hdr->sh_size
   7899  1.1     skrll 			 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef);
   7900  1.1     skrll       contents_end_aux = contents + hdr->sh_size
   7901  1.1     skrll 			 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux);
   7902  1.1     skrll 
   7903  1.1     skrll       /* We know the number of entries in the section but not the maximum
   7904  1.1     skrll 	 index.  Therefore we have to run through all entries and find
   7905  1.1     skrll 	 the maximum.  */
   7906  1.1     skrll       everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
   7907  1.1     skrll       maxidx = 0;
   7908  1.1     skrll       for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; ++i)
   7909  1.6  christos 	{
   7910  1.6  christos 	  _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
   7911  1.1     skrll 
   7912  1.1     skrll 	  if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) == 0)
   7913  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return_bad_verdef;
   7914  1.6  christos 	  if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) > maxidx)
   7915  1.6  christos 	    maxidx = iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION);
   7916  1.6  christos 
   7917  1.1     skrll 	  if (iverdefmem.vd_next == 0)
   7918  1.1     skrll 	    break;
   7919  1.6  christos 
   7920  1.1     skrll 	  if (iverdefmem.vd_next
   7921  1.1     skrll 	      > (size_t) (contents_end_def - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
   7922  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return_bad_verdef;
   7923  1.1     skrll 
   7924  1.1     skrll 	  everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
   7925  1.1     skrll 		     ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdefmem.vd_next));
   7926  1.1     skrll 	}
   7927  1.1     skrll 
   7928  1.1     skrll       if (default_imported_symver)
   7929  1.1     skrll 	{
   7930  1.1     skrll 	  if (freeidx > maxidx)
   7931  1.1     skrll 	    maxidx = ++freeidx;
   7932  1.6  christos 	  else
   7933  1.3  christos 	    freeidx = ++maxidx;
   7934  1.6  christos 	}
   7935  1.1     skrll 
   7936  1.6  christos       elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
   7937  1.1     skrll 	bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, maxidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
   7938  1.1     skrll       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
   7939  1.1     skrll 	goto error_return_verdef;
   7940  1.1     skrll 
   7941  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = maxidx;
   7942  1.1     skrll 
   7943  1.1     skrll       everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
   7944  1.1     skrll       iverdefarr = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef;
   7945  1.1     skrll       for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++)
   7946  1.1     skrll 	{
   7947  1.1     skrll 	  Elf_External_Verdaux *everdaux;
   7948  1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
   7949  1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int j;
   7950  1.1     skrll 
   7951  1.6  christos 	  _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
   7952  1.1     skrll 
   7953  1.1     skrll 	  if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) == 0)
   7954  1.6  christos 	    goto error_return_bad_verdef;
   7955  1.1     skrll 
   7956  1.1     skrll 	  iverdef = &iverdefarr[(iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) - 1];
   7957  1.1     skrll 	  memcpy (iverdef, &iverdefmem, offsetof (Elf_Internal_Verdef, vd_bfd));
   7958  1.1     skrll 
   7959  1.1     skrll 	  iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
   7960  1.1     skrll 
   7961  1.1     skrll 	  if (iverdef->vd_cnt == 0)
   7962  1.3  christos 	    iverdef->vd_auxptr = NULL;
   7963  1.3  christos 	  else
   7964  1.3  christos 	    {
   7965  1.1     skrll 	      iverdef->vd_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
   7966  1.1     skrll                   bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverdef->vd_cnt,
   7967  1.1     skrll                               sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux));
   7968  1.1     skrll 	      if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
   7969  1.1     skrll 		goto error_return_verdef;
   7970  1.1     skrll 	    }
   7971  1.6  christos 
   7972  1.1     skrll 	  if (iverdef->vd_aux
   7973  1.1     skrll 	      > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
   7974  1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return_bad_verdef;
   7975  1.1     skrll 
   7976  1.1     skrll 	  everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
   7977  1.1     skrll 		      ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_aux));
   7978  1.1     skrll 	  iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
   7979  1.1     skrll 	  for (j = 0; j < iverdef->vd_cnt; j++, iverdaux++)
   7980  1.1     skrll 	    {
   7981  1.1     skrll 	      _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (abfd, everdaux, iverdaux);
   7982  1.1     skrll 
   7983  1.1     skrll 	      iverdaux->vda_nodename =
   7984  1.6  christos 		bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
   7985  1.1     skrll 						 iverdaux->vda_name);
   7986  1.6  christos 	      if (iverdaux->vda_nodename == NULL)
   7987  1.6  christos 		goto error_return_bad_verdef;
   7988  1.6  christos 
   7989  1.6  christos 	      iverdaux->vda_nextptr = NULL;
   7990  1.6  christos 	      if (iverdaux->vda_next == 0)
   7991  1.6  christos 		{
   7992  1.1     skrll 		  iverdef->vd_cnt = j + 1;
   7993  1.1     skrll 		  break;
   7994  1.1     skrll 		}
   7995  1.1     skrll 	      if (j + 1 < iverdef->vd_cnt)
   7996  1.1     skrll 		iverdaux->vda_nextptr = iverdaux + 1;
   7997  1.6  christos 
   7998  1.1     skrll 	      if (iverdaux->vda_next
   7999  1.1     skrll 		  > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdaux))
   8000  1.1     skrll 		goto error_return_bad_verdef;
   8001  1.1     skrll 
   8002  1.1     skrll 	      everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
   8003  1.6  christos 			  ((bfd_byte *) everdaux + iverdaux->vda_next));
   8004  1.1     skrll 	    }
   8005  1.1     skrll 
   8006  1.1     skrll 	  iverdef->vd_nodename = NULL;
   8007  1.6  christos 	  if (iverdef->vd_cnt)
   8008  1.6  christos 	    iverdef->vd_nodename = iverdef->vd_auxptr->vda_nodename;
   8009  1.6  christos 
   8010  1.1     skrll 	  iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
   8011  1.1     skrll 	  if (iverdef->vd_next == 0)
   8012  1.1     skrll 	    break;
   8013  1.1     skrll 	  if ((size_t) (iverdef - iverdefarr) + 1 < maxidx)
   8014  1.1     skrll 	    iverdef->vd_nextdef = iverdef + 1;
   8015  1.1     skrll 
   8016  1.1     skrll 	  everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
   8017  1.1     skrll 		     ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_next));
   8018  1.1     skrll 	}
   8019  1.1     skrll 
   8020  1.1     skrll       free (contents);
   8021  1.1     skrll       contents = NULL;
   8022  1.1     skrll     }
   8023  1.1     skrll   else if (default_imported_symver)
   8024  1.1     skrll     {
   8025  1.1     skrll       if (freeidx < 3)
   8026  1.1     skrll 	freeidx = 3;
   8027  1.3  christos       else
   8028  1.3  christos 	freeidx++;
   8029  1.1     skrll 
   8030  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
   8031  1.1     skrll           bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, freeidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
   8032  1.1     skrll       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
   8033  1.1     skrll 	goto error_return;
   8034  1.1     skrll 
   8035  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = freeidx;
   8036  1.1     skrll     }
   8037  1.1     skrll 
   8038  1.1     skrll   /* Create a default version based on the soname.  */
   8039  1.1     skrll   if (default_imported_symver)
   8040  1.1     skrll     {
   8041  1.6  christos       Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
   8042  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
   8043  1.1     skrll 
   8044  1.1     skrll       iverdef = &elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[freeidx - 1];
   8045  1.1     skrll 
   8046  1.1     skrll       iverdef->vd_version = VER_DEF_CURRENT;
   8047  1.1     skrll       iverdef->vd_flags = 0;
   8048  1.1     skrll       iverdef->vd_ndx = freeidx;
   8049  1.1     skrll       iverdef->vd_cnt = 1;
   8050  1.1     skrll 
   8051  1.1     skrll       iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
   8052  1.1     skrll 
   8053  1.1     skrll       iverdef->vd_nodename = bfd_elf_get_dt_soname (abfd);
   8054  1.6  christos       if (iverdef->vd_nodename == NULL)
   8055  1.6  christos 	goto error_return_verdef;
   8056  1.1     skrll       iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
   8057  1.1     skrll       iverdef->vd_auxptr = ((struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
   8058  1.1     skrll 			    bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux)));
   8059  1.1     skrll       if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
   8060  1.1     skrll 	goto error_return_verdef;
   8061  1.1     skrll 
   8062  1.1     skrll       iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
   8063  1.1     skrll       iverdaux->vda_nodename = iverdef->vd_nodename;
   8064  1.1     skrll     }
   8065  1.1     skrll 
   8066  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   8067  1.1     skrll 
   8068  1.1     skrll  error_return:
   8069  1.1     skrll   if (contents != NULL)
   8070  1.1     skrll     free (contents);
   8071  1.1     skrll   return FALSE;
   8072  1.1     skrll }
   8073  1.1     skrll 
   8074  1.1     skrll asymbol *
   8076  1.6  christos _bfd_elf_make_empty_symbol (bfd *abfd)
   8077  1.1     skrll {
   8078  1.1     skrll   elf_symbol_type *newsym;
   8079  1.6  christos 
   8080  1.6  christos   newsym = (elf_symbol_type *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof * newsym);
   8081  1.1     skrll   if (!newsym)
   8082  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
   8083  1.1     skrll   newsym->symbol.the_bfd = abfd;
   8084  1.1     skrll   return &newsym->symbol;
   8085  1.1     skrll }
   8086  1.1     skrll 
   8087  1.1     skrll void
   8088  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_get_symbol_info (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   8089  1.1     skrll 			  asymbol *symbol,
   8090  1.1     skrll 			  symbol_info *ret)
   8091  1.1     skrll {
   8092  1.1     skrll   bfd_symbol_info (symbol, ret);
   8093  1.1     skrll }
   8094  1.1     skrll 
   8095  1.1     skrll /* Return whether a symbol name implies a local symbol.  Most targets
   8096  1.1     skrll    use this function for the is_local_label_name entry point, but some
   8097  1.1     skrll    override it.  */
   8098  1.1     skrll 
   8099  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   8100  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_is_local_label_name (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   8101  1.1     skrll 			      const char *name)
   8102  1.1     skrll {
   8103  1.1     skrll   /* Normal local symbols start with ``.L''.  */
   8104  1.1     skrll   if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == 'L')
   8105  1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   8106  1.1     skrll 
   8107  1.1     skrll   /* At least some SVR4 compilers (e.g., UnixWare 2.1 cc) generate
   8108  1.1     skrll      DWARF debugging symbols starting with ``..''.  */
   8109  1.1     skrll   if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == '.')
   8110  1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   8111  1.1     skrll 
   8112  1.1     skrll   /* gcc will sometimes generate symbols beginning with ``_.L_'' when
   8113  1.1     skrll      emitting DWARF debugging output.  I suspect this is actually a
   8114  1.1     skrll      small bug in gcc (it calls ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL when it should call
   8115  1.1     skrll      ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL, and this causes the leading
   8116  1.1     skrll      underscore to be emitted on some ELF targets).  For ease of use,
   8117  1.6  christos      we treat such symbols as local.  */
   8118  1.6  christos   if (name[0] == '_' && name[1] == '.' && name[2] == 'L' && name[3] == '_')
   8119  1.6  christos     return TRUE;
   8120  1.6  christos 
   8121  1.6  christos   /* Treat assembler generated fake symbols, dollar local labels and
   8122  1.6  christos      forward-backward labels (aka local labels) as locals.
   8123  1.6  christos      These labels have the form:
   8124  1.6  christos 
   8125  1.6  christos        L0^A.*                                  (fake symbols)
   8126  1.6  christos 
   8127  1.6  christos        [.]?L[0123456789]+{^A|^B}[0123456789]*  (local labels)
   8128  1.6  christos 
   8129  1.6  christos      Versions which start with .L will have already been matched above,
   8130  1.6  christos      so we only need to match the rest.  */
   8131  1.6  christos   if (name[0] == 'L' && ISDIGIT (name[1]))
   8132  1.6  christos     {
   8133  1.6  christos       bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
   8134  1.6  christos       const char * p;
   8135  1.6  christos       char c;
   8136  1.6  christos 
   8137  1.6  christos       for (p = name + 2; (c = *p); p++)
   8138  1.6  christos 	{
   8139  1.6  christos 	  if (c == 1 || c == 2)
   8140  1.6  christos 	    {
   8141  1.6  christos 	      if (c == 1 && p == name + 2)
   8142  1.6  christos 		/* A fake symbol.  */
   8143  1.6  christos 		return TRUE;
   8144  1.6  christos 
   8145  1.6  christos 	      /* FIXME: We are being paranoid here and treating symbols like
   8146  1.6  christos 		 L0^Bfoo as if there were non-local, on the grounds that the
   8147  1.6  christos 		 assembler will never generate them.  But can any symbol
   8148  1.6  christos 		 containing an ASCII value in the range 1-31 ever be anything
   8149  1.6  christos 		 other than some kind of local ?  */
   8150  1.6  christos 	      ret = TRUE;
   8151  1.6  christos 	    }
   8152  1.6  christos 
   8153  1.6  christos 	  if (! ISDIGIT (c))
   8154  1.6  christos 	    {
   8155  1.6  christos 	      ret = FALSE;
   8156  1.6  christos 	      break;
   8157  1.6  christos 	    }
   8158  1.1     skrll 	}
   8159  1.1     skrll       return ret;
   8160  1.1     skrll     }
   8161  1.1     skrll 
   8162  1.1     skrll   return FALSE;
   8163  1.1     skrll }
   8164  1.1     skrll 
   8165  1.1     skrll alent *
   8166  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_get_lineno (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   8167  1.1     skrll 		     asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   8168  1.1     skrll {
   8169  1.1     skrll   abort ();
   8170  1.1     skrll   return NULL;
   8171  1.1     skrll }
   8172  1.1     skrll 
   8173  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   8174  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_set_arch_mach (bfd *abfd,
   8175  1.1     skrll 			enum bfd_architecture arch,
   8176  1.1     skrll 			unsigned long machine)
   8177  1.1     skrll {
   8178  1.1     skrll   /* If this isn't the right architecture for this backend, and this
   8179  1.1     skrll      isn't the generic backend, fail.  */
   8180  1.1     skrll   if (arch != get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch
   8181  1.1     skrll       && arch != bfd_arch_unknown
   8182  1.1     skrll       && get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch != bfd_arch_unknown)
   8183  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8184  1.1     skrll 
   8185  1.1     skrll   return bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, arch, machine);
   8186  1.1     skrll }
   8187  1.1     skrll 
   8188  1.1     skrll /* Find the nearest line to a particular section and offset,
   8189  1.6  christos    for error reporting.  */
   8190  1.1     skrll 
   8191  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   8192  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd,
   8193  1.1     skrll 			    asymbol **symbols,
   8194  1.6  christos 			    asection *section,
   8195  1.6  christos 			    bfd_vma offset,
   8196  1.5  christos 			    const char **filename_ptr,
   8197  1.1     skrll 			    const char **functionname_ptr,
   8198  1.1     skrll 			    unsigned int *line_ptr,
   8199  1.6  christos 			    unsigned int *discriminator_ptr)
   8200  1.1     skrll {
   8201  1.6  christos   bfd_boolean found;
   8202  1.6  christos 
   8203  1.6  christos   if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, NULL, section, offset,
   8204  1.6  christos 				     filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
   8205  1.6  christos 				     line_ptr, discriminator_ptr,
   8206  1.6  christos 				     dwarf_debug_sections, 0,
   8207  1.1     skrll 				     &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info)
   8208  1.1     skrll       || _bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
   8209  1.6  christos 					filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
   8210  1.6  christos 					line_ptr))
   8211  1.6  christos     {
   8212  1.1     skrll       if (!*functionname_ptr)
   8213  1.1     skrll 	_bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
   8214  1.1     skrll 				*filename_ptr ? NULL : filename_ptr,
   8215  1.1     skrll 				functionname_ptr);
   8216  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   8217  1.1     skrll     }
   8218  1.1     skrll 
   8219  1.1     skrll   if (! _bfd_stab_section_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
   8220  1.1     skrll 					     &found, filename_ptr,
   8221  1.1     skrll 					     functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
   8222  1.1     skrll 					     &elf_tdata (abfd)->line_info))
   8223  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8224  1.1     skrll   if (found && (*functionname_ptr || *line_ptr))
   8225  1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   8226  1.6  christos 
   8227  1.6  christos   if (symbols == NULL)
   8228  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8229  1.1     skrll 
   8230  1.1     skrll   if (! _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
   8231  1.1     skrll 				filename_ptr, functionname_ptr))
   8232  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8233  1.1     skrll 
   8234  1.1     skrll   *line_ptr = 0;
   8235  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   8236  1.1     skrll }
   8237  1.1     skrll 
   8238  1.1     skrll /* Find the line for a symbol.  */
   8239  1.1     skrll 
   8240  1.6  christos bfd_boolean
   8241  1.6  christos _bfd_elf_find_line (bfd *abfd, asymbol **symbols, asymbol *symbol,
   8242  1.6  christos 		    const char **filename_ptr, unsigned int *line_ptr)
   8243  1.6  christos {
   8244  1.1     skrll   return _bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, symbol, NULL, 0,
   8245  1.1     skrll 					filename_ptr, NULL, line_ptr, NULL,
   8246  1.1     skrll 					dwarf_debug_sections, 0,
   8247  1.1     skrll 					&elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
   8248  1.1     skrll }
   8249  1.1     skrll 
   8250  1.1     skrll /* After a call to bfd_find_nearest_line, successive calls to
   8251  1.1     skrll    bfd_find_inliner_info can be used to get source information about
   8252  1.1     skrll    each level of function inlining that terminated at the address
   8253  1.1     skrll    passed to bfd_find_nearest_line.  Currently this is only supported
   8254  1.1     skrll    for DWARF2 with appropriate DWARF3 extensions. */
   8255  1.1     skrll 
   8256  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   8257  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
   8258  1.1     skrll 			    const char **filename_ptr,
   8259  1.1     skrll 			    const char **functionname_ptr,
   8260  1.1     skrll 			    unsigned int *line_ptr)
   8261  1.1     skrll {
   8262  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean found;
   8263  1.1     skrll   found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
   8264  1.1     skrll 					 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
   8265  1.1     skrll 					 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
   8266  1.1     skrll   return found;
   8267  1.1     skrll }
   8268  1.1     skrll 
   8269  1.1     skrll int
   8270  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_sizeof_headers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   8271  1.6  christos {
   8272  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   8273  1.6  christos   int ret = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   8274  1.1     skrll 
   8275  1.1     skrll   if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info))
   8276  1.1     skrll     {
   8277  1.1     skrll       bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
   8278  1.1     skrll 
   8279  1.1     skrll       if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
   8280  1.6  christos 	{
   8281  1.1     skrll 	  struct elf_segment_map *m;
   8282  1.1     skrll 
   8283  1.1     skrll 	  phdr_size = 0;
   8284  1.1     skrll 	  for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
   8285  1.1     skrll 	    phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
   8286  1.1     skrll 
   8287  1.6  christos 	  if (phdr_size == 0)
   8288  1.1     skrll 	    phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
   8289  1.1     skrll 	}
   8290  1.1     skrll 
   8291  1.1     skrll       elf_program_header_size (abfd) = phdr_size;
   8292  1.1     skrll       ret += phdr_size;
   8293  1.1     skrll     }
   8294  1.1     skrll 
   8295  1.1     skrll   return ret;
   8296  1.1     skrll }
   8297  1.1     skrll 
   8298  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   8299  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd,
   8300  1.1     skrll 			       sec_ptr section,
   8301  1.1     skrll 			       const void *location,
   8302  1.6  christos 			       file_ptr offset,
   8303  1.1     skrll 			       bfd_size_type count)
   8304  1.1     skrll {
   8305  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
   8306  1.1     skrll   file_ptr pos;
   8307  1.1     skrll 
   8308  1.6  christos   if (! abfd->output_has_begun
   8309  1.6  christos       && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
   8310  1.6  christos     return FALSE;
   8311  1.1     skrll 
   8312  1.6  christos   if (!count)
   8313  1.6  christos     return TRUE;
   8314  1.6  christos 
   8315  1.6  christos   hdr = &elf_section_data (section)->this_hdr;
   8316  1.6  christos   if (hdr->sh_offset == (file_ptr) -1)
   8317  1.6  christos     {
   8318  1.6  christos       /* We must compress this section.  Write output to the buffer.  */
   8319  1.6  christos       unsigned char *contents = hdr->contents;
   8320  1.6  christos       if ((offset + count) > hdr->sh_size
   8321  1.6  christos 	  || (section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS) == 0
   8322  1.6  christos 	  || contents == NULL)
   8323  1.1     skrll 	abort ();
   8324  1.1     skrll       memcpy (contents + offset, location, count);
   8325  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   8326  1.1     skrll     }
   8327  1.1     skrll   pos = hdr->sh_offset + offset;
   8328  1.1     skrll   if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
   8329  1.1     skrll       || bfd_bwrite (location, count, abfd) != count)
   8330  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8331  1.1     skrll 
   8332  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   8333  1.1     skrll }
   8334  1.1     skrll 
   8335  1.1     skrll void
   8336  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_no_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   8337  1.1     skrll 			   arelent *cache_ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   8338  1.1     skrll 			   Elf_Internal_Rela *dst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   8339  1.1     skrll {
   8340  1.1     skrll   abort ();
   8341  1.1     skrll }
   8342  1.1     skrll 
   8343  1.1     skrll /* Try to convert a non-ELF reloc into an ELF one.  */
   8344  1.1     skrll 
   8345  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   8346  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_validate_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *areloc)
   8347  1.1     skrll {
   8348  1.1     skrll   /* Check whether we really have an ELF howto.  */
   8349  1.1     skrll 
   8350  1.1     skrll   if ((*areloc->sym_ptr_ptr)->the_bfd->xvec != abfd->xvec)
   8351  1.1     skrll     {
   8352  1.1     skrll       bfd_reloc_code_real_type code;
   8353  1.1     skrll       reloc_howto_type *howto;
   8354  1.1     skrll 
   8355  1.1     skrll       /* Alien reloc: Try to determine its type to replace it with an
   8356  1.1     skrll 	 equivalent ELF reloc.  */
   8357  1.1     skrll 
   8358  1.1     skrll       if (areloc->howto->pc_relative)
   8359  1.1     skrll 	{
   8360  1.1     skrll 	  switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
   8361  1.1     skrll 	    {
   8362  1.1     skrll 	    case 8:
   8363  1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_8_PCREL;
   8364  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   8365  1.1     skrll 	    case 12:
   8366  1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_12_PCREL;
   8367  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   8368  1.1     skrll 	    case 16:
   8369  1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL;
   8370  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   8371  1.1     skrll 	    case 24:
   8372  1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_24_PCREL;
   8373  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   8374  1.1     skrll 	    case 32:
   8375  1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL;
   8376  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   8377  1.1     skrll 	    case 64:
   8378  1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL;
   8379  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   8380  1.1     skrll 	    default:
   8381  1.1     skrll 	      goto fail;
   8382  1.1     skrll 	    }
   8383  1.1     skrll 
   8384  1.1     skrll 	  howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
   8385  1.1     skrll 
   8386  1.1     skrll 	  if (areloc->howto->pcrel_offset != howto->pcrel_offset)
   8387  1.1     skrll 	    {
   8388  1.1     skrll 	      if (howto->pcrel_offset)
   8389  1.1     skrll 		areloc->addend += areloc->address;
   8390  1.1     skrll 	      else
   8391  1.1     skrll 		areloc->addend -= areloc->address; /* addend is unsigned!! */
   8392  1.1     skrll 	    }
   8393  1.1     skrll 	}
   8394  1.1     skrll       else
   8395  1.1     skrll 	{
   8396  1.1     skrll 	  switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
   8397  1.1     skrll 	    {
   8398  1.1     skrll 	    case 8:
   8399  1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_8;
   8400  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   8401  1.1     skrll 	    case 14:
   8402  1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_14;
   8403  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   8404  1.1     skrll 	    case 16:
   8405  1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_16;
   8406  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   8407  1.1     skrll 	    case 26:
   8408  1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_26;
   8409  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   8410  1.1     skrll 	    case 32:
   8411  1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_32;
   8412  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   8413  1.1     skrll 	    case 64:
   8414  1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_64;
   8415  1.1     skrll 	      break;
   8416  1.1     skrll 	    default:
   8417  1.1     skrll 	      goto fail;
   8418  1.1     skrll 	    }
   8419  1.1     skrll 
   8420  1.1     skrll 	  howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
   8421  1.1     skrll 	}
   8422  1.1     skrll 
   8423  1.1     skrll       if (howto)
   8424  1.1     skrll 	areloc->howto = howto;
   8425  1.1     skrll       else
   8426  1.1     skrll 	goto fail;
   8427  1.1     skrll     }
   8428  1.1     skrll 
   8429  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   8430  1.1     skrll 
   8431  1.1     skrll  fail:
   8432  1.1     skrll   (*_bfd_error_handler)
   8433  1.1     skrll     (_("%B: unsupported relocation type %s"),
   8434  1.1     skrll      abfd, areloc->howto->name);
   8435  1.1     skrll   bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   8436  1.1     skrll   return FALSE;
   8437  1.1     skrll }
   8438  1.5  christos 
   8439  1.5  christos bfd_boolean
   8440  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_close_and_cleanup (bfd *abfd)
   8441  1.6  christos {
   8442  1.1     skrll   struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
   8443  1.5  christos   if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_object && tdata != NULL)
   8444  1.1     skrll     {
   8445  1.1     skrll       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->o != NULL && elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL)
   8446  1.1     skrll 	_bfd_elf_strtab_free (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
   8447  1.1     skrll       _bfd_dwarf2_cleanup_debug_info (abfd, &tdata->dwarf2_find_line_info);
   8448  1.1     skrll     }
   8449  1.1     skrll 
   8450  1.1     skrll   return _bfd_generic_close_and_cleanup (abfd);
   8451  1.1     skrll }
   8452  1.1     skrll 
   8453  1.1     skrll /* For Rel targets, we encode meaningful data for BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY
   8454  1.1     skrll    in the relocation's offset.  Thus we cannot allow any sort of sanity
   8455  1.1     skrll    range-checking to interfere.  There is nothing else to do in processing
   8456  1.1     skrll    this reloc.  */
   8457  1.1     skrll 
   8458  1.1     skrll bfd_reloc_status_type
   8459  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn
   8460  1.1     skrll   (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *re ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   8461  1.1     skrll    struct bfd_symbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   8462  1.1     skrll    void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *is ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   8463  1.1     skrll    bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, char **errmsg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   8464  1.1     skrll {
   8465  1.1     skrll   return bfd_reloc_ok;
   8466  1.1     skrll }
   8467  1.1     skrll 
   8468  1.1     skrll /* Elf core file support.  Much of this only works on native
   8470  1.3  christos    toolchains, since we rely on knowing the
   8471  1.3  christos    machine-dependent procfs structure in order to pick
   8472  1.1     skrll    out details about the corefile.  */
   8473  1.1     skrll 
   8474  1.1     skrll #ifdef HAVE_SYS_PROCFS_H
   8475  1.3  christos /* Needed for new procfs interface on sparc-solaris.  */
   8476  1.3  christos # define _STRUCTURED_PROC 1
   8477  1.1     skrll # include <sys/procfs.h>
   8478  1.1     skrll #endif
   8479  1.1     skrll 
   8480  1.1     skrll /* Return a PID that identifies a "thread" for threaded cores, or the
   8481  1.3  christos    PID of the main process for non-threaded cores.  */
   8482  1.3  christos 
   8483  1.6  christos static int
   8484  1.3  christos elfcore_make_pid (bfd *abfd)
   8485  1.6  christos {
   8486  1.3  christos   int pid;
   8487  1.3  christos 
   8488  1.1     skrll   pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid;
   8489  1.1     skrll   if (pid == 0)
   8490  1.1     skrll     pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid;
   8491  1.1     skrll 
   8492  1.1     skrll   return pid;
   8493  1.1     skrll }
   8494  1.1     skrll 
   8495  1.1     skrll /* If there isn't a section called NAME, make one, using
   8496  1.1     skrll    data from SECT.  Note, this function will generate a
   8497  1.1     skrll    reference to NAME, so you shouldn't deallocate or
   8498  1.1     skrll    overwrite it.  */
   8499  1.1     skrll 
   8500  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   8501  1.1     skrll elfcore_maybe_make_sect (bfd *abfd, char *name, asection *sect)
   8502  1.1     skrll {
   8503  1.1     skrll   asection *sect2;
   8504  1.1     skrll 
   8505  1.1     skrll   if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name) != NULL)
   8506  1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   8507  1.1     skrll 
   8508  1.1     skrll   sect2 = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, name, sect->flags);
   8509  1.1     skrll   if (sect2 == NULL)
   8510  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8511  1.1     skrll 
   8512  1.1     skrll   sect2->size = sect->size;
   8513  1.1     skrll   sect2->filepos = sect->filepos;
   8514  1.1     skrll   sect2->alignment_power = sect->alignment_power;
   8515  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   8516  1.1     skrll }
   8517  1.1     skrll 
   8518  1.1     skrll /* Create a pseudosection containing SIZE bytes at FILEPOS.  This
   8519  1.1     skrll    actually creates up to two pseudosections:
   8520  1.1     skrll    - For the single-threaded case, a section named NAME, unless
   8521  1.1     skrll      such a section already exists.
   8522  1.1     skrll    - For the multi-threaded case, a section named "NAME/PID", where
   8523  1.1     skrll      PID is elfcore_make_pid (abfd).
   8524  1.1     skrll    Both pseudosections have identical contents. */
   8525  1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   8526  1.1     skrll _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
   8527  1.1     skrll 				 char *name,
   8528  1.1     skrll 				 size_t size,
   8529  1.1     skrll 				 ufile_ptr filepos)
   8530  1.1     skrll {
   8531  1.1     skrll   char buf[100];
   8532  1.1     skrll   char *threaded_name;
   8533  1.1     skrll   size_t len;
   8534  1.1     skrll   asection *sect;
   8535  1.3  christos 
   8536  1.1     skrll   /* Build the section name.  */
   8537  1.1     skrll 
   8538  1.1     skrll   sprintf (buf, "%s/%d", name, elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
   8539  1.1     skrll   len = strlen (buf) + 1;
   8540  1.1     skrll   threaded_name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
   8541  1.1     skrll   if (threaded_name == NULL)
   8542  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8543  1.1     skrll   memcpy (threaded_name, buf, len);
   8544  1.1     skrll 
   8545  1.1     skrll   sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, threaded_name,
   8546  1.1     skrll 					     SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   8547  1.1     skrll   if (sect == NULL)
   8548  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8549  1.1     skrll   sect->size = size;
   8550  1.1     skrll   sect->filepos = filepos;
   8551  1.1     skrll   sect->alignment_power = 2;
   8552  1.1     skrll 
   8553  1.1     skrll   return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, name, sect);
   8554  1.1     skrll }
   8555  1.1     skrll 
   8556  1.1     skrll /* prstatus_t exists on:
   8557  1.1     skrll      solaris 2.5+
   8558  1.1     skrll      linux 2.[01] + glibc
   8559  1.1     skrll      unixware 4.2
   8560  1.1     skrll */
   8561  1.1     skrll 
   8562  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
   8563  1.1     skrll 
   8564  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   8565  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8566  1.1     skrll {
   8567  1.1     skrll   size_t size;
   8568  1.1     skrll   int offset;
   8569  1.1     skrll 
   8570  1.1     skrll   if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus_t))
   8571  1.1     skrll     {
   8572  1.1     skrll       prstatus_t prstat;
   8573  1.1     skrll 
   8574  1.1     skrll       size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
   8575  1.6  christos       offset   = offsetof (prstatus_t, pr_reg);
   8576  1.6  christos       memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
   8577  1.6  christos 
   8578  1.6  christos       /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
   8579  1.1     skrll 	 has already been set by another thread.  */
   8580  1.1     skrll       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
   8581  1.1     skrll 	elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
   8582  1.1     skrll       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
   8583  1.1     skrll 	elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
   8584  1.1     skrll 
   8585  1.1     skrll       /* pr_who exists on:
   8586  1.1     skrll 	 solaris 2.5+
   8587  1.6  christos 	 unixware 4.2
   8588  1.3  christos 	 pr_who doesn't exist on:
   8589  1.6  christos 	 linux 2.[01]
   8590  1.1     skrll 	 */
   8591  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T_PR_WHO)
   8592  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
   8593  1.1     skrll #else
   8594  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
   8595  1.1     skrll #endif
   8596  1.1     skrll     }
   8597  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
   8598  1.1     skrll   else if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus32_t))
   8599  1.1     skrll     {
   8600  1.1     skrll       /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
   8601  1.1     skrll       prstatus32_t prstat;
   8602  1.1     skrll 
   8603  1.1     skrll       size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
   8604  1.6  christos       offset   = offsetof (prstatus32_t, pr_reg);
   8605  1.6  christos       memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
   8606  1.6  christos 
   8607  1.6  christos       /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
   8608  1.1     skrll 	 has already been set by another thread.  */
   8609  1.1     skrll       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
   8610  1.1     skrll 	elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
   8611  1.1     skrll       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
   8612  1.1     skrll 	elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
   8613  1.1     skrll 
   8614  1.1     skrll       /* pr_who exists on:
   8615  1.1     skrll 	 solaris 2.5+
   8616  1.6  christos 	 unixware 4.2
   8617  1.3  christos 	 pr_who doesn't exist on:
   8618  1.6  christos 	 linux 2.[01]
   8619  1.1     skrll 	 */
   8620  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T_PR_WHO)
   8621  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
   8622  1.1     skrll #else
   8623  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
   8624  1.1     skrll #endif
   8625  1.1     skrll     }
   8626  1.1     skrll #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T */
   8627  1.1     skrll   else
   8628  1.1     skrll     {
   8629  1.1     skrll       /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
   8630  1.1     skrll 	 note size (ie. data object type).  */
   8631  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   8632  1.1     skrll     }
   8633  1.1     skrll 
   8634  1.1     skrll   /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section.  */
   8635  1.1     skrll   return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
   8636  1.1     skrll 					  size, note->descpos + offset);
   8637  1.1     skrll }
   8638  1.1     skrll #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T) */
   8639  1.1     skrll 
   8640  1.1     skrll /* Create a pseudosection containing the exact contents of NOTE.  */
   8641  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   8642  1.1     skrll elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
   8643  1.1     skrll 				 char *name,
   8644  1.1     skrll 				 Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8645  1.1     skrll {
   8646  1.1     skrll   return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, name,
   8647  1.1     skrll 					  note->descsz, note->descpos);
   8648  1.1     skrll }
   8649  1.1     skrll 
   8650  1.1     skrll /* There isn't a consistent prfpregset_t across platforms,
   8651  1.1     skrll    but it doesn't matter, because we don't have to pick this
   8652  1.1     skrll    data structure apart.  */
   8653  1.1     skrll 
   8654  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   8655  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_prfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8656  1.1     skrll {
   8657  1.1     skrll   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
   8658  1.1     skrll }
   8659  1.1     skrll 
   8660  1.1     skrll /* Linux dumps the Intel SSE regs in a note named "LINUX" with a note
   8661  1.1     skrll    type of NT_PRXFPREG.  Just include the whole note's contents
   8662  1.1     skrll    literally.  */
   8663  1.1     skrll 
   8664  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   8665  1.3  christos elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8666  1.3  christos {
   8667  1.3  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
   8668  1.3  christos }
   8669  1.3  christos 
   8670  1.3  christos /* Linux dumps the Intel XSAVE extended state in a note named "LINUX"
   8671  1.3  christos    with a note type of NT_X86_XSTATE.  Just include the whole note's
   8672  1.3  christos    contents literally.  */
   8673  1.3  christos 
   8674  1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   8675  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8676  1.1     skrll {
   8677  1.1     skrll   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xstate", note);
   8678  1.1     skrll }
   8679  1.1     skrll 
   8680  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   8681  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8682  1.1     skrll {
   8683  1.1     skrll   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vmx", note);
   8684  1.1     skrll }
   8685  1.1     skrll 
   8686  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   8687  1.3  christos elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8688  1.3  christos {
   8689  1.3  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vsx", note);
   8690  1.3  christos }
   8691  1.3  christos 
   8692  1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   8693  1.3  christos elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8694  1.3  christos {
   8695  1.3  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-high-gprs", note);
   8696  1.3  christos }
   8697  1.3  christos 
   8698  1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   8699  1.3  christos elfcore_grok_s390_timer (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8700  1.3  christos {
   8701  1.3  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-timer", note);
   8702  1.3  christos }
   8703  1.3  christos 
   8704  1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   8705  1.3  christos elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8706  1.3  christos {
   8707  1.3  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todcmp", note);
   8708  1.3  christos }
   8709  1.3  christos 
   8710  1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   8711  1.3  christos elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8712  1.3  christos {
   8713  1.3  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todpreg", note);
   8714  1.3  christos }
   8715  1.3  christos 
   8716  1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   8717  1.3  christos elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8718  1.3  christos {
   8719  1.3  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-ctrs", note);
   8720  1.3  christos }
   8721  1.3  christos 
   8722  1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   8723  1.5  christos elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8724  1.5  christos {
   8725  1.5  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-prefix", note);
   8726  1.5  christos }
   8727  1.5  christos 
   8728  1.5  christos static bfd_boolean
   8729  1.5  christos elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8730  1.5  christos {
   8731  1.5  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-last-break", note);
   8732  1.5  christos }
   8733  1.5  christos 
   8734  1.5  christos static bfd_boolean
   8735  1.5  christos elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8736  1.6  christos {
   8737  1.6  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-system-call", note);
   8738  1.6  christos }
   8739  1.6  christos 
   8740  1.6  christos static bfd_boolean
   8741  1.6  christos elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8742  1.6  christos {
   8743  1.6  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-tdb", note);
   8744  1.6  christos }
   8745  1.6  christos 
   8746  1.6  christos static bfd_boolean
   8747  1.6  christos elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8748  1.6  christos {
   8749  1.6  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low", note);
   8750  1.6  christos }
   8751  1.6  christos 
   8752  1.6  christos static bfd_boolean
   8753  1.6  christos elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8754  1.5  christos {
   8755  1.5  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high", note);
   8756  1.5  christos }
   8757  1.5  christos 
   8758  1.5  christos static bfd_boolean
   8759  1.6  christos elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8760  1.6  christos {
   8761  1.6  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-arm-vfp", note);
   8762  1.6  christos }
   8763  1.6  christos 
   8764  1.6  christos static bfd_boolean
   8765  1.6  christos elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8766  1.6  christos {
   8767  1.6  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-tls", note);
   8768  1.6  christos }
   8769  1.6  christos 
   8770  1.6  christos static bfd_boolean
   8771  1.6  christos elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8772  1.6  christos {
   8773  1.6  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-break", note);
   8774  1.6  christos }
   8775  1.6  christos 
   8776  1.6  christos static bfd_boolean
   8777  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8778  1.1     skrll {
   8779  1.1     skrll   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch", note);
   8780  1.1     skrll }
   8781  1.1     skrll 
   8782  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T)
   8783  1.1     skrll typedef prpsinfo_t   elfcore_psinfo_t;
   8784  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T)		/* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
   8785  1.1     skrll typedef prpsinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
   8786  1.1     skrll #endif
   8787  1.1     skrll #endif
   8788  1.1     skrll 
   8789  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
   8790  1.1     skrll typedef psinfo_t   elfcore_psinfo_t;
   8791  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)		/* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
   8792  1.1     skrll typedef psinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
   8793  1.1     skrll #endif
   8794  1.1     skrll #endif
   8795  1.1     skrll 
   8796  1.1     skrll /* return a malloc'ed copy of a string at START which is at
   8797  1.1     skrll    most MAX bytes long, possibly without a terminating '\0'.
   8798  1.1     skrll    the copy will always have a terminating '\0'.  */
   8799  1.3  christos 
   8800  1.1     skrll char *
   8801  1.1     skrll _bfd_elfcore_strndup (bfd *abfd, char *start, size_t max)
   8802  1.1     skrll {
   8803  1.1     skrll   char *dups;
   8804  1.1     skrll   char *end = (char *) memchr (start, '\0', max);
   8805  1.1     skrll   size_t len;
   8806  1.1     skrll 
   8807  1.3  christos   if (end == NULL)
   8808  1.1     skrll     len = max;
   8809  1.1     skrll   else
   8810  1.1     skrll     len = end - start;
   8811  1.1     skrll 
   8812  1.1     skrll   dups = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 1);
   8813  1.1     skrll   if (dups == NULL)
   8814  1.1     skrll     return NULL;
   8815  1.1     skrll 
   8816  1.1     skrll   memcpy (dups, start, len);
   8817  1.1     skrll   dups[len] = '\0';
   8818  1.1     skrll 
   8819  1.1     skrll   return dups;
   8820  1.1     skrll }
   8821  1.1     skrll 
   8822  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
   8823  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   8824  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8825  1.1     skrll {
   8826  1.1     skrll   if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo_t))
   8827  1.3  christos     {
   8828  1.6  christos       elfcore_psinfo_t psinfo;
   8829  1.3  christos 
   8830  1.6  christos       memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
   8831  1.1     skrll 
   8832  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T_PR_PID)
   8833  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
   8834  1.6  christos #endif
   8835  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
   8836  1.1     skrll 	= _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
   8837  1.1     skrll 				sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
   8838  1.1     skrll 
   8839  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
   8840  1.1     skrll 	= _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
   8841  1.1     skrll 				sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
   8842  1.1     skrll     }
   8843  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
   8844  1.1     skrll   else if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo32_t))
   8845  1.1     skrll     {
   8846  1.3  christos       /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
   8847  1.6  christos       elfcore_psinfo32_t psinfo;
   8848  1.3  christos 
   8849  1.6  christos       memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
   8850  1.1     skrll 
   8851  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T_PR_PID)
   8852  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
   8853  1.6  christos #endif
   8854  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
   8855  1.1     skrll 	= _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
   8856  1.1     skrll 				sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
   8857  1.1     skrll 
   8858  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
   8859  1.1     skrll 	= _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
   8860  1.1     skrll 				sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
   8861  1.1     skrll     }
   8862  1.1     skrll #endif
   8863  1.1     skrll 
   8864  1.1     skrll   else
   8865  1.1     skrll     {
   8866  1.1     skrll       /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
   8867  1.1     skrll 	 note size (ie. data object type).  */
   8868  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   8869  1.1     skrll     }
   8870  1.1     skrll 
   8871  1.6  christos   /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
   8872  1.1     skrll      onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
   8873  1.1     skrll      implementations, so strip it off if it exists.  */
   8874  1.1     skrll 
   8875  1.1     skrll   {
   8876  1.1     skrll     char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
   8877  1.1     skrll     int n = strlen (command);
   8878  1.1     skrll 
   8879  1.1     skrll     if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
   8880  1.1     skrll       command[n - 1] = '\0';
   8881  1.1     skrll   }
   8882  1.1     skrll 
   8883  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   8884  1.1     skrll }
   8885  1.1     skrll #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T) */
   8886  1.1     skrll 
   8887  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
   8888  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   8889  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8890  1.1     skrll {
   8891  1.1     skrll   if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus_t)
   8892  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PXSTATUS_T)
   8893  1.1     skrll       || note->descsz == sizeof (pxstatus_t)
   8894  1.1     skrll #endif
   8895  1.1     skrll       )
   8896  1.6  christos     {
   8897  1.1     skrll       pstatus_t pstat;
   8898  1.1     skrll 
   8899  1.1     skrll       memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
   8900  1.1     skrll 
   8901  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
   8902  1.1     skrll     }
   8903  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
   8904  1.1     skrll   else if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus32_t))
   8905  1.1     skrll     {
   8906  1.6  christos       /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
   8907  1.1     skrll       pstatus32_t pstat;
   8908  1.1     skrll 
   8909  1.1     skrll       memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
   8910  1.1     skrll 
   8911  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
   8912  1.1     skrll     }
   8913  1.1     skrll #endif
   8914  1.1     skrll   /* Could grab some more details from the "representative"
   8915  1.1     skrll      lwpstatus_t in pstat.pr_lwp, but we'll catch it all in an
   8916  1.1     skrll      NT_LWPSTATUS note, presumably.  */
   8917  1.1     skrll 
   8918  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   8919  1.1     skrll }
   8920  1.1     skrll #endif /* defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T) */
   8921  1.1     skrll 
   8922  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
   8923  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   8924  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   8925  1.1     skrll {
   8926  1.1     skrll   lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
   8927  1.1     skrll   char buf[100];
   8928  1.1     skrll   char *name;
   8929  1.1     skrll   size_t len;
   8930  1.1     skrll   asection *sect;
   8931  1.1     skrll 
   8932  1.1     skrll   if (note->descsz != sizeof (lwpstat)
   8933  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPXSTATUS_T)
   8934  1.1     skrll       && note->descsz != sizeof (lwpxstatus_t)
   8935  1.1     skrll #endif
   8936  1.6  christos       )
   8937  1.3  christos     return TRUE;
   8938  1.3  christos 
   8939  1.6  christos   memcpy (&lwpstat, note->descdata, sizeof (lwpstat));
   8940  1.6  christos 
   8941  1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwpstat.pr_lwpid;
   8942  1.1     skrll   /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it has already been set by
   8943  1.1     skrll      another thread.  */
   8944  1.1     skrll   if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
   8945  1.1     skrll     elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = lwpstat.pr_cursig;
   8946  1.1     skrll 
   8947  1.1     skrll   /* Make a ".reg/999" section.  */
   8948  1.1     skrll 
   8949  1.1     skrll   sprintf (buf, ".reg/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
   8950  1.1     skrll   len = strlen (buf) + 1;
   8951  1.1     skrll   name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
   8952  1.1     skrll   if (name == NULL)
   8953  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8954  1.1     skrll   memcpy (name, buf, len);
   8955  1.1     skrll 
   8956  1.1     skrll   sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   8957  1.1     skrll   if (sect == NULL)
   8958  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8959  1.1     skrll 
   8960  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
   8961  1.1     skrll   sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
   8962  1.1     skrll   sect->filepos = note->descpos
   8963  1.1     skrll     + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
   8964  1.1     skrll #endif
   8965  1.1     skrll 
   8966  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
   8967  1.1     skrll   sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg);
   8968  1.1     skrll   sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_reg);
   8969  1.1     skrll #endif
   8970  1.1     skrll 
   8971  1.1     skrll   sect->alignment_power = 2;
   8972  1.1     skrll 
   8973  1.1     skrll   if (!elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
   8974  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8975  1.1     skrll 
   8976  1.1     skrll   /* Make a ".reg2/999" section */
   8977  1.1     skrll 
   8978  1.1     skrll   sprintf (buf, ".reg2/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
   8979  1.1     skrll   len = strlen (buf) + 1;
   8980  1.1     skrll   name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
   8981  1.1     skrll   if (name == NULL)
   8982  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8983  1.1     skrll   memcpy (name, buf, len);
   8984  1.1     skrll 
   8985  1.1     skrll   sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   8986  1.1     skrll   if (sect == NULL)
   8987  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8988  1.1     skrll 
   8989  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
   8990  1.1     skrll   sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
   8991  1.1     skrll   sect->filepos = note->descpos
   8992  1.1     skrll     + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
   8993  1.1     skrll #endif
   8994  1.1     skrll 
   8995  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_FPREG)
   8996  1.1     skrll   sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_fpreg);
   8997  1.1     skrll   sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_fpreg);
   8998  1.1     skrll #endif
   8999  1.1     skrll 
   9000  1.1     skrll   sect->alignment_power = 2;
   9001  1.1     skrll 
   9002  1.1     skrll   return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg2", sect);
   9003  1.1     skrll }
   9004  1.1     skrll #endif /* defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T) */
   9005  1.1     skrll 
   9006  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   9007  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9008  1.1     skrll {
   9009  1.1     skrll   char buf[30];
   9010  1.1     skrll   char *name;
   9011  1.1     skrll   size_t len;
   9012  1.1     skrll   asection *sect;
   9013  1.1     skrll   int type;
   9014  1.1     skrll   int is_active_thread;
   9015  1.1     skrll   bfd_vma base_addr;
   9016  1.1     skrll 
   9017  1.1     skrll   if (note->descsz < 728)
   9018  1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   9019  1.1     skrll 
   9020  1.1     skrll   if (! CONST_STRNEQ (note->namedata, "win32"))
   9021  1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   9022  1.1     skrll 
   9023  1.6  christos   type = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata);
   9024  1.1     skrll 
   9025  1.6  christos   switch (type)
   9026  1.1     skrll     {
   9027  1.6  christos     case 1 /* NOTE_INFO_PROCESS */:
   9028  1.1     skrll       /* FIXME: need to add ->core->command.  */
   9029  1.1     skrll       /* process_info.pid */
   9030  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
   9031  1.1     skrll       /* process_info.signal */
   9032  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
   9033  1.1     skrll       break;
   9034  1.1     skrll 
   9035  1.1     skrll     case 2 /* NOTE_INFO_THREAD */:
   9036  1.3  christos       /* Make a ".reg/999" section.  */
   9037  1.1     skrll       /* thread_info.tid */
   9038  1.1     skrll       sprintf (buf, ".reg/%ld", (long) bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8));
   9039  1.1     skrll 
   9040  1.1     skrll       len = strlen (buf) + 1;
   9041  1.1     skrll       name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
   9042  1.1     skrll       if (name == NULL)
   9043  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   9044  1.1     skrll 
   9045  1.1     skrll       memcpy (name, buf, len);
   9046  1.1     skrll 
   9047  1.1     skrll       sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   9048  1.1     skrll       if (sect == NULL)
   9049  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   9050  1.1     skrll 
   9051  1.1     skrll       /* sizeof (thread_info.thread_context) */
   9052  1.1     skrll       sect->size = 716;
   9053  1.1     skrll       /* offsetof (thread_info.thread_context) */
   9054  1.1     skrll       sect->filepos = note->descpos + 12;
   9055  1.1     skrll       sect->alignment_power = 2;
   9056  1.1     skrll 
   9057  1.1     skrll       /* thread_info.is_active_thread */
   9058  1.1     skrll       is_active_thread = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
   9059  1.1     skrll 
   9060  1.1     skrll       if (is_active_thread)
   9061  1.1     skrll 	if (! elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
   9062  1.1     skrll 	  return FALSE;
   9063  1.1     skrll       break;
   9064  1.1     skrll 
   9065  1.1     skrll     case 3 /* NOTE_INFO_MODULE */:
   9066  1.1     skrll       /* Make a ".module/xxxxxxxx" section.  */
   9067  1.3  christos       /* module_info.base_address */
   9068  1.1     skrll       base_addr = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 4);
   9069  1.1     skrll       sprintf (buf, ".module/%08lx", (unsigned long) base_addr);
   9070  1.1     skrll 
   9071  1.1     skrll       len = strlen (buf) + 1;
   9072  1.1     skrll       name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
   9073  1.1     skrll       if (name == NULL)
   9074  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   9075  1.1     skrll 
   9076  1.1     skrll       memcpy (name, buf, len);
   9077  1.1     skrll 
   9078  1.1     skrll       sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   9079  1.1     skrll 
   9080  1.1     skrll       if (sect == NULL)
   9081  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   9082  1.1     skrll 
   9083  1.1     skrll       sect->size = note->descsz;
   9084  1.1     skrll       sect->filepos = note->descpos;
   9085  1.1     skrll       sect->alignment_power = 2;
   9086  1.1     skrll       break;
   9087  1.1     skrll 
   9088  1.1     skrll     default:
   9089  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   9090  1.1     skrll     }
   9091  1.1     skrll 
   9092  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   9093  1.1     skrll }
   9094  1.1     skrll 
   9095  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   9096  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9097  1.1     skrll {
   9098  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   9099  1.1     skrll 
   9100  1.1     skrll   switch (note->type)
   9101  1.1     skrll     {
   9102  1.1     skrll     default:
   9103  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   9104  1.1     skrll 
   9105  1.1     skrll     case NT_PRSTATUS:
   9106  1.1     skrll       if (bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus)
   9107  1.1     skrll 	if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus) (abfd, note))
   9108  1.1     skrll 	  return TRUE;
   9109  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
   9110  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_prstatus (abfd, note);
   9111  1.1     skrll #else
   9112  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   9113  1.1     skrll #endif
   9114  1.1     skrll 
   9115  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
   9116  1.1     skrll     case NT_PSTATUS:
   9117  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_pstatus (abfd, note);
   9118  1.1     skrll #endif
   9119  1.1     skrll 
   9120  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
   9121  1.1     skrll     case NT_LWPSTATUS:
   9122  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (abfd, note);
   9123  1.1     skrll #endif
   9124  1.1     skrll 
   9125  1.1     skrll     case NT_FPREGSET:		/* FIXME: rename to NT_PRFPREG */
   9126  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
   9127  1.1     skrll 
   9128  1.1     skrll     case NT_WIN32PSTATUS:
   9129  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (abfd, note);
   9130  1.1     skrll 
   9131  1.1     skrll     case NT_PRXFPREG:		/* Linux SSE extension */
   9132  1.1     skrll       if (note->namesz == 6
   9133  1.3  christos 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9134  1.3  christos 	return elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (abfd, note);
   9135  1.3  christos       else
   9136  1.3  christos 	return TRUE;
   9137  1.6  christos 
   9138  1.6  christos     case NT_X86_XSTATE:		/* Linux XSAVE extension */
   9139  1.6  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9140  1.3  christos 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9141  1.3  christos 	return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
   9142  1.3  christos       else if (note->namesz == 8
   9143  1.1     skrll 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "FreeBSD") == 0)
   9144  1.1     skrll 	return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
   9145  1.1     skrll       else
   9146  1.1     skrll 	return TRUE;
   9147  1.1     skrll 
   9148  1.1     skrll     case NT_PPC_VMX:
   9149  1.1     skrll       if (note->namesz == 6
   9150  1.1     skrll 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9151  1.1     skrll 	return elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (abfd, note);
   9152  1.1     skrll       else
   9153  1.1     skrll 	return TRUE;
   9154  1.1     skrll 
   9155  1.1     skrll     case NT_PPC_VSX:
   9156  1.1     skrll       if (note->namesz == 6
   9157  1.3  christos           && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9158  1.3  christos         return elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (abfd, note);
   9159  1.3  christos       else
   9160  1.3  christos         return TRUE;
   9161  1.3  christos 
   9162  1.3  christos     case NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS:
   9163  1.3  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9164  1.3  christos           && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9165  1.3  christos         return elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (abfd, note);
   9166  1.3  christos       else
   9167  1.3  christos         return TRUE;
   9168  1.3  christos 
   9169  1.3  christos     case NT_S390_TIMER:
   9170  1.3  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9171  1.3  christos           && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9172  1.3  christos         return elfcore_grok_s390_timer (abfd, note);
   9173  1.3  christos       else
   9174  1.3  christos         return TRUE;
   9175  1.3  christos 
   9176  1.3  christos     case NT_S390_TODCMP:
   9177  1.3  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9178  1.3  christos           && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9179  1.3  christos         return elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (abfd, note);
   9180  1.3  christos       else
   9181  1.3  christos         return TRUE;
   9182  1.3  christos 
   9183  1.3  christos     case NT_S390_TODPREG:
   9184  1.3  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9185  1.3  christos           && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9186  1.3  christos         return elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (abfd, note);
   9187  1.3  christos       else
   9188  1.3  christos         return TRUE;
   9189  1.3  christos 
   9190  1.3  christos     case NT_S390_CTRS:
   9191  1.3  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9192  1.3  christos           && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9193  1.3  christos         return elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (abfd, note);
   9194  1.3  christos       else
   9195  1.3  christos         return TRUE;
   9196  1.3  christos 
   9197  1.3  christos     case NT_S390_PREFIX:
   9198  1.3  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9199  1.5  christos           && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9200  1.5  christos         return elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (abfd, note);
   9201  1.5  christos       else
   9202  1.5  christos         return TRUE;
   9203  1.5  christos 
   9204  1.5  christos     case NT_S390_LAST_BREAK:
   9205  1.5  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9206  1.5  christos           && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9207  1.5  christos         return elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (abfd, note);
   9208  1.5  christos       else
   9209  1.5  christos         return TRUE;
   9210  1.5  christos 
   9211  1.5  christos     case NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL:
   9212  1.5  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9213  1.6  christos           && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9214  1.6  christos         return elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (abfd, note);
   9215  1.6  christos       else
   9216  1.6  christos         return TRUE;
   9217  1.6  christos 
   9218  1.6  christos     case NT_S390_TDB:
   9219  1.6  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9220  1.6  christos           && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9221  1.6  christos         return elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (abfd, note);
   9222  1.6  christos       else
   9223  1.6  christos         return TRUE;
   9224  1.6  christos 
   9225  1.6  christos     case NT_S390_VXRS_LOW:
   9226  1.6  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9227  1.6  christos 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9228  1.6  christos 	return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, note);
   9229  1.6  christos       else
   9230  1.6  christos 	return TRUE;
   9231  1.6  christos 
   9232  1.6  christos     case NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH:
   9233  1.6  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9234  1.5  christos 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9235  1.5  christos 	return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, note);
   9236  1.5  christos       else
   9237  1.5  christos 	return TRUE;
   9238  1.5  christos 
   9239  1.5  christos     case NT_ARM_VFP:
   9240  1.5  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9241  1.6  christos 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9242  1.6  christos 	return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
   9243  1.6  christos       else
   9244  1.6  christos 	return TRUE;
   9245  1.6  christos 
   9246  1.6  christos     case NT_ARM_TLS:
   9247  1.6  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9248  1.6  christos 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9249  1.6  christos 	return elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (abfd, note);
   9250  1.6  christos       else
   9251  1.6  christos 	return TRUE;
   9252  1.6  christos 
   9253  1.6  christos     case NT_ARM_HW_BREAK:
   9254  1.6  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9255  1.6  christos 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9256  1.6  christos 	return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (abfd, note);
   9257  1.6  christos       else
   9258  1.6  christos 	return TRUE;
   9259  1.6  christos 
   9260  1.6  christos     case NT_ARM_HW_WATCH:
   9261  1.6  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9262  1.1     skrll 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9263  1.1     skrll 	return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, note);
   9264  1.1     skrll       else
   9265  1.1     skrll 	return TRUE;
   9266  1.1     skrll 
   9267  1.1     skrll     case NT_PRPSINFO:
   9268  1.1     skrll     case NT_PSINFO:
   9269  1.1     skrll       if (bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo)
   9270  1.1     skrll 	if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo) (abfd, note))
   9271  1.1     skrll 	  return TRUE;
   9272  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
   9273  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_psinfo (abfd, note);
   9274  1.1     skrll #else
   9275  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   9276  1.1     skrll #endif
   9277  1.1     skrll 
   9278  1.1     skrll     case NT_AUXV:
   9279  1.1     skrll       {
   9280  1.1     skrll 	asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
   9281  1.1     skrll 							     SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   9282  1.1     skrll 
   9283  1.1     skrll 	if (sect == NULL)
   9284  1.1     skrll 	  return FALSE;
   9285  1.1     skrll 	sect->size = note->descsz;
   9286  1.6  christos 	sect->filepos = note->descpos;
   9287  1.6  christos 	sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
   9288  1.6  christos 
   9289  1.6  christos 	return TRUE;
   9290  1.6  christos       }
   9291  1.6  christos 
   9292  1.6  christos     case NT_FILE:
   9293  1.6  christos       return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.file",
   9294  1.1     skrll 					      note);
   9295  1.1     skrll 
   9296  1.1     skrll     case NT_SIGINFO:
   9297  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.siginfo",
   9298  1.1     skrll 					      note);
   9299  1.1     skrll     }
   9300  1.6  christos }
   9301  1.6  christos 
   9302  1.6  christos static bfd_boolean
   9303  1.6  christos elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9304  1.6  christos {
   9305  1.6  christos   struct bfd_build_id* build_id;
   9306  1.6  christos 
   9307  1.1     skrll   if (note->descsz == 0)
   9308  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   9309  1.6  christos 
   9310  1.6  christos   build_id = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct bfd_build_id) - 1 + note->descsz);
   9311  1.6  christos   if (build_id == NULL)
   9312  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   9313  1.1     skrll 
   9314  1.1     skrll   build_id->size = note->descsz;
   9315  1.1     skrll   memcpy (build_id->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
   9316  1.1     skrll   abfd->build_id = build_id;
   9317  1.1     skrll 
   9318  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   9319  1.1     skrll }
   9320  1.1     skrll 
   9321  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   9322  1.1     skrll elfobj_grok_gnu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9323  1.1     skrll {
   9324  1.1     skrll   switch (note->type)
   9325  1.1     skrll     {
   9326  1.1     skrll     default:
   9327  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   9328  1.1     skrll 
   9329  1.1     skrll     case NT_GNU_BUILD_ID:
   9330  1.5  christos       return elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (abfd, note);
   9331  1.5  christos     }
   9332  1.5  christos }
   9333  1.5  christos 
   9334  1.5  christos static bfd_boolean
   9335  1.5  christos elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9336  1.5  christos {
   9337  1.5  christos   struct sdt_note *cur =
   9338  1.5  christos     (struct sdt_note *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct sdt_note)
   9339  1.5  christos 				   + note->descsz);
   9340  1.5  christos 
   9341  1.5  christos   cur->next = (struct sdt_note *) (elf_tdata (abfd))->sdt_note_head;
   9342  1.5  christos   cur->size = (bfd_size_type) note->descsz;
   9343  1.5  christos   memcpy (cur->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
   9344  1.5  christos 
   9345  1.5  christos   elf_tdata (abfd)->sdt_note_head = cur;
   9346  1.5  christos 
   9347  1.5  christos   return TRUE;
   9348  1.5  christos }
   9349  1.5  christos 
   9350  1.5  christos static bfd_boolean
   9351  1.5  christos elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9352  1.5  christos {
   9353  1.5  christos   switch (note->type)
   9354  1.5  christos     {
   9355  1.5  christos     case NT_STAPSDT:
   9356  1.5  christos       return elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (abfd, note);
   9357  1.5  christos 
   9358  1.5  christos     default:
   9359  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   9360  1.1     skrll     }
   9361  1.1     skrll }
   9362  1.1     skrll 
   9363  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   9364  1.1     skrll elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (Elf_Internal_Note *note, int *lwpidp)
   9365  1.1     skrll {
   9366  1.1     skrll   char *cp;
   9367  1.1     skrll 
   9368  1.1     skrll   cp = strchr (note->namedata, '@');
   9369  1.1     skrll   if (cp != NULL)
   9370  1.1     skrll     {
   9371  1.1     skrll       *lwpidp = atoi(cp + 1);
   9372  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   9373  1.1     skrll     }
   9374  1.1     skrll   return FALSE;
   9375  1.1     skrll }
   9376  1.6  christos 
   9377  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   9378  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9379  1.1     skrll {
   9380  1.6  christos   /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
   9381  1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
   9382  1.1     skrll     = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
   9383  1.1     skrll 
   9384  1.6  christos   /* Process ID at offset 0x50. */
   9385  1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
   9386  1.1     skrll     = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x50);
   9387  1.1     skrll 
   9388  1.1     skrll   /* Command name at 0x7c (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
   9389  1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
   9390  1.1     skrll     = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x7c, 31);
   9391  1.1     skrll 
   9392  1.1     skrll   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.netbsdcore.procinfo",
   9393  1.1     skrll 					  note);
   9394  1.1     skrll }
   9395  1.1     skrll 
   9396  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   9397  1.6  christos elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9398  1.1     skrll {
   9399  1.1     skrll   int lwp;
   9400  1.1     skrll 
   9401  1.1     skrll   if (elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (note, &lwp))
   9402  1.1     skrll     elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwp;
   9403  1.1     skrll 
   9404  1.1     skrll   if (note->type == NT_NETBSDCORE_PROCINFO)
   9405  1.1     skrll     {
   9406  1.1     skrll       /* NetBSD-specific core "procinfo".  Note that we expect to
   9407  1.1     skrll 	 find this note before any of the others, which is fine,
   9408  1.1     skrll 	 since the kernel writes this note out first when it
   9409  1.1     skrll 	 creates a core file.  */
   9410  1.1     skrll 
   9411  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
   9412  1.1     skrll     }
   9413  1.1     skrll 
   9414  1.1     skrll   /* As of Jan 2002 there are no other machine-independent notes
   9415  1.1     skrll      defined for NetBSD core files.  If the note type is less
   9416  1.1     skrll      than the start of the machine-dependent note types, we don't
   9417  1.1     skrll      understand it.  */
   9418  1.1     skrll 
   9419  1.1     skrll   if (note->type < NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH)
   9420  1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   9421  1.1     skrll 
   9422  1.1     skrll 
   9423  1.1     skrll   switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
   9424  1.1     skrll     {
   9425  1.1     skrll       /* On the Alpha, SPARC (32-bit and 64-bit), PT_GETREGS == mach+0 and
   9426  1.1     skrll 	 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+2.  */
   9427  1.1     skrll 
   9428  1.1     skrll     case bfd_arch_alpha:
   9429  1.1     skrll     case bfd_arch_sparc:
   9430  1.1     skrll       switch (note->type)
   9431  1.1     skrll 	{
   9432  1.1     skrll 	case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+0:
   9433  1.1     skrll 	  return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
   9434  1.1     skrll 
   9435  1.1     skrll 	case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+2:
   9436  1.1     skrll 	  return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
   9437  1.4       uwe 
   9438  1.4       uwe 	default:
   9439  1.4       uwe 	  return TRUE;
   9440  1.4       uwe 	}
   9441  1.4       uwe 
   9442  1.4       uwe       /* On SuperH, PT_GETREGS == mach+3 and PT_GETFPREGS == mach+5.
   9443  1.4       uwe 	 There's also old PT___GETREGS40 == mach + 1 for old reg
   9444  1.4       uwe 	 structure which lacks GBR.  */
   9445  1.4       uwe 
   9446  1.4       uwe     case bfd_arch_sh:
   9447  1.4       uwe       switch (note->type)
   9448  1.4       uwe 	{
   9449  1.4       uwe 	case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
   9450  1.4       uwe 	  return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
   9451  1.4       uwe 
   9452  1.4       uwe 	case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+5:
   9453  1.4       uwe 	  return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
   9454  1.1     skrll 
   9455  1.1     skrll 	default:
   9456  1.1     skrll 	  return TRUE;
   9457  1.1     skrll 	}
   9458  1.1     skrll 
   9459  1.1     skrll       /* On all other arch's, PT_GETREGS == mach+1 and
   9460  1.1     skrll 	 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+3.  */
   9461  1.1     skrll 
   9462  1.1     skrll     default:
   9463  1.1     skrll       switch (note->type)
   9464  1.1     skrll 	{
   9465  1.1     skrll 	case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+1:
   9466  1.1     skrll 	  return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
   9467  1.1     skrll 
   9468  1.1     skrll 	case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
   9469  1.1     skrll 	  return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
   9470  1.1     skrll 
   9471  1.1     skrll 	default:
   9472  1.1     skrll 	  return TRUE;
   9473  1.1     skrll 	}
   9474  1.3  christos     }
   9475  1.3  christos     /* NOTREACHED */
   9476  1.3  christos }
   9477  1.6  christos 
   9478  1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   9479  1.3  christos elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9480  1.3  christos {
   9481  1.6  christos   /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
   9482  1.3  christos   elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
   9483  1.3  christos     = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
   9484  1.3  christos 
   9485  1.6  christos   /* Process ID at offset 0x20. */
   9486  1.3  christos   elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
   9487  1.3  christos     = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x20);
   9488  1.3  christos 
   9489  1.3  christos   /* Command name at 0x48 (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
   9490  1.3  christos   elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
   9491  1.3  christos     = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x48, 31);
   9492  1.3  christos 
   9493  1.3  christos   return TRUE;
   9494  1.3  christos }
   9495  1.3  christos 
   9496  1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   9497  1.3  christos elfcore_grok_openbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9498  1.3  christos {
   9499  1.3  christos   if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_PROCINFO)
   9500  1.3  christos     return elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
   9501  1.3  christos 
   9502  1.3  christos   if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_REGS)
   9503  1.3  christos     return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
   9504  1.3  christos 
   9505  1.3  christos   if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_FPREGS)
   9506  1.3  christos     return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
   9507  1.3  christos 
   9508  1.3  christos   if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_XFPREGS)
   9509  1.3  christos     return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
   9510  1.3  christos 
   9511  1.3  christos   if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_AUXV)
   9512  1.3  christos     {
   9513  1.3  christos       asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
   9514  1.3  christos 							   SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   9515  1.3  christos 
   9516  1.3  christos       if (sect == NULL)
   9517  1.3  christos 	return FALSE;
   9518  1.3  christos       sect->size = note->descsz;
   9519  1.3  christos       sect->filepos = note->descpos;
   9520  1.3  christos       sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
   9521  1.3  christos 
   9522  1.3  christos       return TRUE;
   9523  1.3  christos     }
   9524  1.3  christos 
   9525  1.3  christos   if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_WCOOKIE)
   9526  1.3  christos     {
   9527  1.3  christos       asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".wcookie",
   9528  1.3  christos 							   SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   9529  1.3  christos 
   9530  1.3  christos       if (sect == NULL)
   9531  1.3  christos 	return FALSE;
   9532  1.3  christos       sect->size = note->descsz;
   9533  1.3  christos       sect->filepos = note->descpos;
   9534  1.3  christos       sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
   9535  1.3  christos 
   9536  1.3  christos       return TRUE;
   9537  1.3  christos     }
   9538  1.1     skrll 
   9539  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   9540  1.1     skrll }
   9541  1.1     skrll 
   9542  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   9543  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_nto_status (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note, long *tid)
   9544  1.1     skrll {
   9545  1.1     skrll   void *ddata = note->descdata;
   9546  1.1     skrll   char buf[100];
   9547  1.1     skrll   char *name;
   9548  1.6  christos   asection *sect;
   9549  1.1     skrll   short sig;
   9550  1.1     skrll   unsigned flags;
   9551  1.1     skrll 
   9552  1.1     skrll   /* nto_procfs_status 'pid' field is at offset 0.  */
   9553  1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata);
   9554  1.1     skrll 
   9555  1.1     skrll   /* nto_procfs_status 'tid' field is at offset 4.  Pass it back.  */
   9556  1.1     skrll   *tid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 4);
   9557  1.1     skrll 
   9558  1.1     skrll   /* nto_procfs_status 'flags' field is at offset 8.  */
   9559  1.6  christos   flags = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 8);
   9560  1.6  christos 
   9561  1.1     skrll   /* nto_procfs_status 'what' field is at offset 14.  */
   9562  1.1     skrll   if ((sig = bfd_get_16 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 14)) > 0)
   9563  1.1     skrll     {
   9564  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = sig;
   9565  1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
   9566  1.1     skrll     }
   9567  1.6  christos 
   9568  1.1     skrll   /* _DEBUG_FLAG_CURTID (current thread) is 0x80.  Some cores
   9569  1.1     skrll      do not come from signals so we make sure we set the current
   9570  1.1     skrll      thread just in case.  */
   9571  1.1     skrll   if (flags & 0x00000080)
   9572  1.3  christos     elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
   9573  1.1     skrll 
   9574  1.1     skrll   /* Make a ".qnx_core_status/%d" section.  */
   9575  1.1     skrll   sprintf (buf, ".qnx_core_status/%ld", *tid);
   9576  1.1     skrll 
   9577  1.1     skrll   name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
   9578  1.1     skrll   if (name == NULL)
   9579  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   9580  1.1     skrll   strcpy (name, buf);
   9581  1.1     skrll 
   9582  1.1     skrll   sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   9583  1.1     skrll   if (sect == NULL)
   9584  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   9585  1.1     skrll 
   9586  1.1     skrll   sect->size            = note->descsz;
   9587  1.1     skrll   sect->filepos         = note->descpos;
   9588  1.1     skrll   sect->alignment_power = 2;
   9589  1.1     skrll 
   9590  1.1     skrll   return (elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".qnx_core_status", sect));
   9591  1.1     skrll }
   9592  1.1     skrll 
   9593  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   9594  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_nto_regs (bfd *abfd,
   9595  1.1     skrll 		       Elf_Internal_Note *note,
   9596  1.1     skrll 		       long tid,
   9597  1.1     skrll 		       char *base)
   9598  1.1     skrll {
   9599  1.1     skrll   char buf[100];
   9600  1.1     skrll   char *name;
   9601  1.3  christos   asection *sect;
   9602  1.1     skrll 
   9603  1.1     skrll   /* Make a "(base)/%d" section.  */
   9604  1.1     skrll   sprintf (buf, "%s/%ld", base, tid);
   9605  1.1     skrll 
   9606  1.1     skrll   name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
   9607  1.1     skrll   if (name == NULL)
   9608  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   9609  1.1     skrll   strcpy (name, buf);
   9610  1.1     skrll 
   9611  1.1     skrll   sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   9612  1.1     skrll   if (sect == NULL)
   9613  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   9614  1.1     skrll 
   9615  1.6  christos   sect->size            = note->descsz;
   9616  1.1     skrll   sect->filepos         = note->descpos;
   9617  1.1     skrll   sect->alignment_power = 2;
   9618  1.1     skrll 
   9619  1.1     skrll   /* This is the current thread.  */
   9620  1.1     skrll   if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid == tid)
   9621  1.1     skrll     return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, base, sect);
   9622  1.1     skrll 
   9623  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   9624  1.1     skrll }
   9625  1.1     skrll 
   9626  1.1     skrll #define BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO	7
   9627  1.1     skrll #define BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS	8
   9628  1.1     skrll #define BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG	9
   9629  1.1     skrll #define BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG	10
   9630  1.1     skrll 
   9631  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   9632  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_nto_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9633  1.1     skrll {
   9634  1.1     skrll   /* Every GREG section has a STATUS section before it.  Store the
   9635  1.1     skrll      tid from the previous call to pass down to the next gregs
   9636  1.1     skrll      function.  */
   9637  1.1     skrll   static long tid = 1;
   9638  1.1     skrll 
   9639  1.1     skrll   switch (note->type)
   9640  1.1     skrll     {
   9641  1.1     skrll     case BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO:
   9642  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".qnx_core_info", note);
   9643  1.1     skrll     case BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS:
   9644  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_nto_status (abfd, note, &tid);
   9645  1.1     skrll     case BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG:
   9646  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg");
   9647  1.1     skrll     case BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG:
   9648  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg2");
   9649  1.1     skrll     default:
   9650  1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   9651  1.1     skrll     }
   9652  1.1     skrll }
   9653  1.1     skrll 
   9654  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   9655  1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_spu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9656  1.1     skrll {
   9657  1.1     skrll   char *name;
   9658  1.3  christos   asection *sect;
   9659  1.1     skrll   size_t len;
   9660  1.1     skrll 
   9661  1.1     skrll   /* Use note name as section name.  */
   9662  1.1     skrll   len = note->namesz;
   9663  1.1     skrll   name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
   9664  1.1     skrll   if (name == NULL)
   9665  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   9666  1.1     skrll   memcpy (name, note->namedata, len);
   9667  1.1     skrll   name[len - 1] = '\0';
   9668  1.1     skrll 
   9669  1.1     skrll   sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   9670  1.1     skrll   if (sect == NULL)
   9671  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   9672  1.1     skrll 
   9673  1.1     skrll   sect->size            = note->descsz;
   9674  1.1     skrll   sect->filepos         = note->descpos;
   9675  1.1     skrll   sect->alignment_power = 1;
   9676  1.1     skrll 
   9677  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   9678  1.1     skrll }
   9679  1.1     skrll 
   9680  1.1     skrll /* Function: elfcore_write_note
   9681  1.1     skrll 
   9682  1.1     skrll    Inputs:
   9683  1.1     skrll      buffer to hold note, and current size of buffer
   9684  1.1     skrll      name of note
   9685  1.1     skrll      type of note
   9686  1.1     skrll      data for note
   9687  1.1     skrll      size of data for note
   9688  1.1     skrll 
   9689  1.1     skrll    Writes note to end of buffer.  ELF64 notes are written exactly as
   9690  1.1     skrll    for ELF32, despite the current (as of 2006) ELF gabi specifying
   9691  1.1     skrll    that they ought to have 8-byte namesz and descsz field, and have
   9692  1.1     skrll    8-byte alignment.  Other writers, eg. Linux kernel, do the same.
   9693  1.1     skrll 
   9694  1.1     skrll    Return:
   9695  1.1     skrll    Pointer to realloc'd buffer, *BUFSIZ updated.  */
   9696  1.1     skrll 
   9697  1.1     skrll char *
   9698  1.1     skrll elfcore_write_note (bfd *abfd,
   9699  1.1     skrll 		    char *buf,
   9700  1.1     skrll 		    int *bufsiz,
   9701  1.1     skrll 		    const char *name,
   9702  1.1     skrll 		    int type,
   9703  1.1     skrll 		    const void *input,
   9704  1.1     skrll 		    int size)
   9705  1.1     skrll {
   9706  1.1     skrll   Elf_External_Note *xnp;
   9707  1.1     skrll   size_t namesz;
   9708  1.1     skrll   size_t newspace;
   9709  1.1     skrll   char *dest;
   9710  1.1     skrll 
   9711  1.1     skrll   namesz = 0;
   9712  1.3  christos   if (name != NULL)
   9713  1.1     skrll     namesz = strlen (name) + 1;
   9714  1.1     skrll 
   9715  1.1     skrll   newspace = 12 + ((namesz + 3) & -4) + ((size + 3) & -4);
   9716  1.1     skrll 
   9717  1.1     skrll   buf = (char *) realloc (buf, *bufsiz + newspace);
   9718  1.1     skrll   if (buf == NULL)
   9719  1.1     skrll     return buf;
   9720  1.1     skrll   dest = buf + *bufsiz;
   9721  1.1     skrll   *bufsiz += newspace;
   9722  1.1     skrll   xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) dest;
   9723  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, namesz, xnp->namesz);
   9724  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, size, xnp->descsz);
   9725  1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, type, xnp->type);
   9726  1.1     skrll   dest = xnp->name;
   9727  1.1     skrll   if (name != NULL)
   9728  1.1     skrll     {
   9729  1.1     skrll       memcpy (dest, name, namesz);
   9730  1.1     skrll       dest += namesz;
   9731  1.1     skrll       while (namesz & 3)
   9732  1.1     skrll 	{
   9733  1.1     skrll 	  *dest++ = '\0';
   9734  1.1     skrll 	  ++namesz;
   9735  1.1     skrll 	}
   9736  1.1     skrll     }
   9737  1.1     skrll   memcpy (dest, input, size);
   9738  1.1     skrll   dest += size;
   9739  1.1     skrll   while (size & 3)
   9740  1.1     skrll     {
   9741  1.1     skrll       *dest++ = '\0';
   9742  1.1     skrll       ++size;
   9743  1.1     skrll     }
   9744  1.1     skrll   return buf;
   9745  1.1     skrll }
   9746  1.1     skrll 
   9747  1.1     skrll char *
   9748  1.1     skrll elfcore_write_prpsinfo (bfd  *abfd,
   9749  1.1     skrll 			char *buf,
   9750  1.1     skrll 			int  *bufsiz,
   9751  1.1     skrll 			const char *fname,
   9752  1.1     skrll 			const char *psargs)
   9753  1.1     skrll {
   9754  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   9755  1.1     skrll 
   9756  1.1     skrll   if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
   9757  1.1     skrll     {
   9758  1.1     skrll       char *ret;
   9759  1.1     skrll       ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   9760  1.5  christos 						 NT_PRPSINFO, fname, psargs);
   9761  1.1     skrll       if (ret != NULL)
   9762  1.1     skrll 	return ret;
   9763  1.1     skrll     }
   9764  1.1     skrll 
   9765  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
   9766  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
   9767  1.1     skrll   if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
   9768  1.1     skrll     {
   9769  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
   9770  1.1     skrll       psinfo32_t data;
   9771  1.1     skrll       int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
   9772  1.1     skrll #else
   9773  1.1     skrll       prpsinfo32_t data;
   9774  1.1     skrll       int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
   9775  1.1     skrll #endif
   9776  1.5  christos 
   9777  1.1     skrll       memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
   9778  1.1     skrll       strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
   9779  1.1     skrll       strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
   9780  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   9781  1.1     skrll 				 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
   9782  1.1     skrll     }
   9783  1.1     skrll   else
   9784  1.1     skrll #endif
   9785  1.1     skrll     {
   9786  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
   9787  1.1     skrll       psinfo_t data;
   9788  1.1     skrll       int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
   9789  1.1     skrll #else
   9790  1.1     skrll       prpsinfo_t data;
   9791  1.1     skrll       int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
   9792  1.1     skrll #endif
   9793  1.5  christos 
   9794  1.1     skrll       memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
   9795  1.5  christos       strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
   9796  1.5  christos       strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
   9797  1.5  christos       return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   9798  1.5  christos 				 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
   9799  1.1     skrll     }
   9800  1.1     skrll #endif	/* PSINFO_T or PRPSINFO_T */
   9801  1.1     skrll 
   9802  1.6  christos   free (buf);
   9803  1.6  christos   return NULL;
   9804  1.6  christos }
   9805  1.6  christos 
   9806  1.6  christos char *
   9807  1.6  christos elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo32
   9808  1.6  christos   (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
   9809  1.6  christos    const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
   9810  1.6  christos {
   9811  1.6  christos   struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32 data;
   9812  1.6  christos 
   9813  1.6  christos   memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
   9814  1.6  christos   LINUX_PRPSINFO32_SWAP_FIELDS (abfd, prpsinfo, data);
   9815  1.6  christos 
   9816  1.6  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
   9817  1.6  christos 			     &data, sizeof (data));
   9818  1.6  christos }
   9819  1.6  christos 
   9820  1.6  christos char *
   9821  1.6  christos elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo64
   9822  1.6  christos   (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
   9823  1.6  christos    const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
   9824  1.6  christos {
   9825  1.6  christos   struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64 data;
   9826  1.6  christos 
   9827  1.6  christos   memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
   9828  1.6  christos   LINUX_PRPSINFO64_SWAP_FIELDS (abfd, prpsinfo, data);
   9829  1.6  christos 
   9830  1.1     skrll   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   9831  1.1     skrll 			     "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
   9832  1.1     skrll }
   9833  1.1     skrll 
   9834  1.1     skrll char *
   9835  1.1     skrll elfcore_write_prstatus (bfd *abfd,
   9836  1.1     skrll 			char *buf,
   9837  1.1     skrll 			int *bufsiz,
   9838  1.1     skrll 			long pid,
   9839  1.1     skrll 			int cursig,
   9840  1.1     skrll 			const void *gregs)
   9841  1.1     skrll {
   9842  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   9843  1.1     skrll 
   9844  1.1     skrll   if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
   9845  1.1     skrll     {
   9846  1.1     skrll       char *ret;
   9847  1.1     skrll       ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   9848  1.1     skrll 						 NT_PRSTATUS,
   9849  1.5  christos 						 pid, cursig, gregs);
   9850  1.1     skrll       if (ret != NULL)
   9851  1.1     skrll 	return ret;
   9852  1.1     skrll     }
   9853  1.1     skrll 
   9854  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
   9855  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
   9856  1.1     skrll   if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
   9857  1.1     skrll     {
   9858  1.1     skrll       prstatus32_t prstat;
   9859  1.5  christos 
   9860  1.1     skrll       memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
   9861  1.1     skrll       prstat.pr_pid = pid;
   9862  1.1     skrll       prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
   9863  1.1     skrll       memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
   9864  1.1     skrll       return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
   9865  1.1     skrll 				 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
   9866  1.1     skrll     }
   9867  1.1     skrll   else
   9868  1.1     skrll #endif
   9869  1.1     skrll     {
   9870  1.1     skrll       prstatus_t prstat;
   9871  1.5  christos 
   9872  1.1     skrll       memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
   9873  1.1     skrll       prstat.pr_pid = pid;
   9874  1.5  christos       prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
   9875  1.5  christos       memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
   9876  1.5  christos       return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
   9877  1.5  christos 				 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
   9878  1.1     skrll     }
   9879  1.1     skrll #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS_T */
   9880  1.1     skrll 
   9881  1.1     skrll   free (buf);
   9882  1.1     skrll   return NULL;
   9883  1.1     skrll }
   9884  1.1     skrll 
   9885  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
   9886  1.1     skrll char *
   9887  1.1     skrll elfcore_write_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd,
   9888  1.1     skrll 			 char *buf,
   9889  1.1     skrll 			 int *bufsiz,
   9890  1.1     skrll 			 long pid,
   9891  1.1     skrll 			 int cursig,
   9892  1.1     skrll 			 const void *gregs)
   9893  1.1     skrll {
   9894  1.1     skrll   lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
   9895  1.1     skrll   const char *note_name = "CORE";
   9896  1.6  christos 
   9897  1.1     skrll   memset (&lwpstat, 0, sizeof (lwpstat));
   9898  1.1     skrll   lwpstat.pr_lwpid  = pid >> 16;
   9899  1.1     skrll   lwpstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
   9900  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
   9901  1.1     skrll   memcpy (&lwpstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg));
   9902  1.1     skrll #elif defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
   9903  1.1     skrll #if !defined(gregs)
   9904  1.1     skrll   memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs,
   9905  1.1     skrll 	  gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs));
   9906  1.1     skrll #else
   9907  1.1     skrll   memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs,
   9908  1.1     skrll 	  gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs));
   9909  1.1     skrll #endif
   9910  1.1     skrll #endif
   9911  1.1     skrll   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
   9912  1.1     skrll 			     NT_LWPSTATUS, &lwpstat, sizeof (lwpstat));
   9913  1.1     skrll }
   9914  1.1     skrll #endif /* HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T */
   9915  1.1     skrll 
   9916  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
   9917  1.1     skrll char *
   9918  1.1     skrll elfcore_write_pstatus (bfd *abfd,
   9919  1.1     skrll 		       char *buf,
   9920  1.1     skrll 		       int *bufsiz,
   9921  1.1     skrll 		       long pid,
   9922  1.1     skrll 		       int cursig ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   9923  1.1     skrll 		       const void *gregs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   9924  1.1     skrll {
   9925  1.1     skrll   const char *note_name = "CORE";
   9926  1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
   9927  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   9928  1.1     skrll 
   9929  1.1     skrll   if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
   9930  1.1     skrll     {
   9931  1.1     skrll       pstatus32_t pstat;
   9932  1.1     skrll 
   9933  1.1     skrll       memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
   9934  1.1     skrll       pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
   9935  1.1     skrll       buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
   9936  1.1     skrll 				NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
   9937  1.1     skrll       return buf;
   9938  1.1     skrll     }
   9939  1.1     skrll   else
   9940  1.1     skrll #endif
   9941  1.1     skrll     {
   9942  1.1     skrll       pstatus_t pstat;
   9943  1.1     skrll 
   9944  1.1     skrll       memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
   9945  1.1     skrll       pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
   9946  1.1     skrll       buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
   9947  1.1     skrll 				NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
   9948  1.1     skrll       return buf;
   9949  1.1     skrll     }
   9950  1.1     skrll }
   9951  1.1     skrll #endif /* HAVE_PSTATUS_T */
   9952  1.1     skrll 
   9953  1.1     skrll char *
   9954  1.1     skrll elfcore_write_prfpreg (bfd *abfd,
   9955  1.1     skrll 		       char *buf,
   9956  1.1     skrll 		       int *bufsiz,
   9957  1.1     skrll 		       const void *fpregs,
   9958  1.1     skrll 		       int size)
   9959  1.1     skrll {
   9960  1.1     skrll   const char *note_name = "CORE";
   9961  1.1     skrll   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   9962  1.1     skrll 			     note_name, NT_FPREGSET, fpregs, size);
   9963  1.1     skrll }
   9964  1.1     skrll 
   9965  1.1     skrll char *
   9966  1.1     skrll elfcore_write_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd,
   9967  1.1     skrll 			char *buf,
   9968  1.1     skrll 			int *bufsiz,
   9969  1.1     skrll 			const void *xfpregs,
   9970  1.1     skrll 			int size)
   9971  1.1     skrll {
   9972  1.1     skrll   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   9973  1.3  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   9974  1.3  christos 			     note_name, NT_PRXFPREG, xfpregs, size);
   9975  1.3  christos }
   9976  1.6  christos 
   9977  1.6  christos char *
   9978  1.6  christos elfcore_write_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
   9979  1.6  christos 			 const void *xfpregs, int size)
   9980  1.6  christos {
   9981  1.3  christos   char *note_name;
   9982  1.3  christos   if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi == ELFOSABI_FREEBSD)
   9983  1.3  christos     note_name = "FreeBSD";
   9984  1.3  christos   else
   9985  1.3  christos     note_name = "LINUX";
   9986  1.1     skrll   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   9987  1.1     skrll 			     note_name, NT_X86_XSTATE, xfpregs, size);
   9988  1.1     skrll }
   9989  1.1     skrll 
   9990  1.1     skrll char *
   9991  1.1     skrll elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd,
   9992  1.1     skrll 		       char *buf,
   9993  1.1     skrll 		       int *bufsiz,
   9994  1.1     skrll 		       const void *ppc_vmx,
   9995  1.1     skrll 		       int size)
   9996  1.1     skrll {
   9997  1.1     skrll   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   9998  1.1     skrll   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   9999  1.1     skrll 			     note_name, NT_PPC_VMX, ppc_vmx, size);
   10000  1.1     skrll }
   10001  1.1     skrll 
   10002  1.1     skrll char *
   10003  1.1     skrll elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd,
   10004  1.1     skrll                        char *buf,
   10005  1.1     skrll                        int *bufsiz,
   10006  1.1     skrll                        const void *ppc_vsx,
   10007  1.1     skrll                        int size)
   10008  1.1     skrll {
   10009  1.3  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10010  1.3  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10011  1.3  christos                              note_name, NT_PPC_VSX, ppc_vsx, size);
   10012  1.3  christos }
   10013  1.3  christos 
   10014  1.3  christos static char *
   10015  1.3  christos elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd,
   10016  1.3  christos 			      char *buf,
   10017  1.3  christos 			      int *bufsiz,
   10018  1.3  christos 			      const void *s390_high_gprs,
   10019  1.3  christos 			      int size)
   10020  1.3  christos {
   10021  1.3  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10022  1.3  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10023  1.3  christos                              note_name, NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS,
   10024  1.3  christos 			     s390_high_gprs, size);
   10025  1.3  christos }
   10026  1.3  christos 
   10027  1.3  christos char *
   10028  1.3  christos elfcore_write_s390_timer (bfd *abfd,
   10029  1.3  christos                           char *buf,
   10030  1.3  christos                           int *bufsiz,
   10031  1.3  christos                           const void *s390_timer,
   10032  1.3  christos                           int size)
   10033  1.3  christos {
   10034  1.3  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10035  1.3  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10036  1.3  christos                              note_name, NT_S390_TIMER, s390_timer, size);
   10037  1.3  christos }
   10038  1.3  christos 
   10039  1.3  christos char *
   10040  1.3  christos elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd,
   10041  1.3  christos                            char *buf,
   10042  1.3  christos                            int *bufsiz,
   10043  1.3  christos                            const void *s390_todcmp,
   10044  1.3  christos                            int size)
   10045  1.3  christos {
   10046  1.3  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10047  1.3  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10048  1.3  christos                              note_name, NT_S390_TODCMP, s390_todcmp, size);
   10049  1.3  christos }
   10050  1.3  christos 
   10051  1.3  christos char *
   10052  1.3  christos elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd,
   10053  1.3  christos                             char *buf,
   10054  1.3  christos                             int *bufsiz,
   10055  1.3  christos                             const void *s390_todpreg,
   10056  1.3  christos                             int size)
   10057  1.3  christos {
   10058  1.3  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10059  1.3  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10060  1.3  christos                              note_name, NT_S390_TODPREG, s390_todpreg, size);
   10061  1.3  christos }
   10062  1.3  christos 
   10063  1.3  christos char *
   10064  1.3  christos elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd,
   10065  1.3  christos                          char *buf,
   10066  1.3  christos                          int *bufsiz,
   10067  1.3  christos                          const void *s390_ctrs,
   10068  1.3  christos                          int size)
   10069  1.3  christos {
   10070  1.3  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10071  1.3  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10072  1.3  christos                              note_name, NT_S390_CTRS, s390_ctrs, size);
   10073  1.3  christos }
   10074  1.3  christos 
   10075  1.3  christos char *
   10076  1.3  christos elfcore_write_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd,
   10077  1.3  christos                            char *buf,
   10078  1.3  christos                            int *bufsiz,
   10079  1.3  christos                            const void *s390_prefix,
   10080  1.3  christos                            int size)
   10081  1.3  christos {
   10082  1.1     skrll   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10083  1.5  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10084  1.5  christos                              note_name, NT_S390_PREFIX, s390_prefix, size);
   10085  1.5  christos }
   10086  1.5  christos 
   10087  1.5  christos char *
   10088  1.5  christos elfcore_write_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd,
   10089  1.5  christos 			       char *buf,
   10090  1.5  christos 			       int *bufsiz,
   10091  1.5  christos 			       const void *s390_last_break,
   10092  1.5  christos 			       int size)
   10093  1.5  christos {
   10094  1.5  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10095  1.5  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10096  1.5  christos                              note_name, NT_S390_LAST_BREAK,
   10097  1.5  christos 			     s390_last_break, size);
   10098  1.5  christos }
   10099  1.5  christos 
   10100  1.5  christos char *
   10101  1.5  christos elfcore_write_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd,
   10102  1.5  christos 				char *buf,
   10103  1.5  christos 				int *bufsiz,
   10104  1.5  christos 				const void *s390_system_call,
   10105  1.5  christos 				int size)
   10106  1.5  christos {
   10107  1.5  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10108  1.5  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10109  1.6  christos                              note_name, NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL,
   10110  1.6  christos 			     s390_system_call, size);
   10111  1.6  christos }
   10112  1.6  christos 
   10113  1.6  christos char *
   10114  1.6  christos elfcore_write_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd,
   10115  1.6  christos 			char *buf,
   10116  1.6  christos 			int *bufsiz,
   10117  1.6  christos 			const void *s390_tdb,
   10118  1.6  christos 			int size)
   10119  1.6  christos {
   10120  1.6  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10121  1.6  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10122  1.6  christos                              note_name, NT_S390_TDB, s390_tdb, size);
   10123  1.6  christos }
   10124  1.6  christos 
   10125  1.6  christos char *
   10126  1.6  christos elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd,
   10127  1.6  christos 			     char *buf,
   10128  1.6  christos 			     int *bufsiz,
   10129  1.6  christos 			     const void *s390_vxrs_low,
   10130  1.6  christos 			     int size)
   10131  1.6  christos {
   10132  1.6  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10133  1.6  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10134  1.6  christos 			     note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_LOW, s390_vxrs_low, size);
   10135  1.6  christos }
   10136  1.6  christos 
   10137  1.6  christos char *
   10138  1.6  christos elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd,
   10139  1.6  christos 			     char *buf,
   10140  1.6  christos 			     int *bufsiz,
   10141  1.6  christos 			     const void *s390_vxrs_high,
   10142  1.6  christos 			     int size)
   10143  1.6  christos {
   10144  1.6  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10145  1.6  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10146  1.5  christos 			     note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH,
   10147  1.5  christos 			     s390_vxrs_high, size);
   10148  1.5  christos }
   10149  1.5  christos 
   10150  1.5  christos char *
   10151  1.5  christos elfcore_write_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd,
   10152  1.5  christos 		       char *buf,
   10153  1.5  christos 		       int *bufsiz,
   10154  1.5  christos 		       const void *arm_vfp,
   10155  1.5  christos 		       int size)
   10156  1.5  christos {
   10157  1.5  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10158  1.6  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10159  1.6  christos 			     note_name, NT_ARM_VFP, arm_vfp, size);
   10160  1.6  christos }
   10161  1.6  christos 
   10162  1.6  christos char *
   10163  1.6  christos elfcore_write_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd,
   10164  1.6  christos 		       char *buf,
   10165  1.6  christos 		       int *bufsiz,
   10166  1.6  christos 		       const void *aarch_tls,
   10167  1.6  christos 		       int size)
   10168  1.6  christos {
   10169  1.6  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10170  1.6  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10171  1.6  christos 			     note_name, NT_ARM_TLS, aarch_tls, size);
   10172  1.6  christos }
   10173  1.6  christos 
   10174  1.6  christos char *
   10175  1.6  christos elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd,
   10176  1.6  christos 			    char *buf,
   10177  1.6  christos 			    int *bufsiz,
   10178  1.6  christos 			    const void *aarch_hw_break,
   10179  1.6  christos 			    int size)
   10180  1.6  christos {
   10181  1.6  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10182  1.6  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10183  1.6  christos 			     note_name, NT_ARM_HW_BREAK, aarch_hw_break, size);
   10184  1.6  christos }
   10185  1.6  christos 
   10186  1.6  christos char *
   10187  1.6  christos elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd,
   10188  1.6  christos 			    char *buf,
   10189  1.6  christos 			    int *bufsiz,
   10190  1.6  christos 			    const void *aarch_hw_watch,
   10191  1.6  christos 			    int size)
   10192  1.6  christos {
   10193  1.6  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10194  1.1     skrll   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10195  1.1     skrll 			     note_name, NT_ARM_HW_WATCH, aarch_hw_watch, size);
   10196  1.1     skrll }
   10197  1.1     skrll 
   10198  1.1     skrll char *
   10199  1.1     skrll elfcore_write_register_note (bfd *abfd,
   10200  1.1     skrll 			     char *buf,
   10201  1.1     skrll 			     int *bufsiz,
   10202  1.1     skrll 			     const char *section,
   10203  1.1     skrll 			     const void *data,
   10204  1.1     skrll 			     int size)
   10205  1.3  christos {
   10206  1.3  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg2") == 0)
   10207  1.1     skrll     return elfcore_write_prfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   10208  1.1     skrll   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xfp") == 0)
   10209  1.1     skrll     return elfcore_write_prxfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   10210  1.1     skrll   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xstate") == 0)
   10211  1.3  christos     return elfcore_write_xstatereg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   10212  1.3  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vmx") == 0)
   10213  1.3  christos     return elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   10214  1.3  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vsx") == 0)
   10215  1.3  christos     return elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   10216  1.3  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-high-gprs") == 0)
   10217  1.3  christos     return elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   10218  1.3  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-timer") == 0)
   10219  1.3  christos     return elfcore_write_s390_timer (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   10220  1.3  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todcmp") == 0)
   10221  1.3  christos     return elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   10222  1.3  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todpreg") == 0)
   10223  1.5  christos     return elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   10224  1.5  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-ctrs") == 0)
   10225  1.5  christos     return elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   10226  1.5  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-prefix") == 0)
   10227  1.6  christos     return elfcore_write_s390_prefix (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   10228  1.6  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-last-break") == 0)
   10229  1.6  christos     return elfcore_write_s390_last_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   10230  1.6  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-system-call") == 0)
   10231  1.6  christos     return elfcore_write_s390_system_call (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   10232  1.6  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-tdb") == 0)
   10233  1.5  christos     return elfcore_write_s390_tdb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   10234  1.5  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low") == 0)
   10235  1.6  christos     return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   10236  1.6  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high") == 0)
   10237  1.6  christos     return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   10238  1.6  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-arm-vfp") == 0)
   10239  1.6  christos     return elfcore_write_arm_vfp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   10240  1.6  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-tls") == 0)
   10241  1.1     skrll     return elfcore_write_aarch_tls (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   10242  1.1     skrll   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-break") == 0)
   10243  1.1     skrll     return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   10244  1.1     skrll   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch") == 0)
   10245  1.1     skrll     return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   10246  1.1     skrll   return NULL;
   10247  1.1     skrll }
   10248  1.1     skrll 
   10249  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   10250  1.1     skrll elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size, file_ptr offset)
   10251  1.1     skrll {
   10252  1.1     skrll   char *p;
   10253  1.1     skrll 
   10254  1.1     skrll   p = buf;
   10255  1.1     skrll   while (p < buf + size)
   10256  1.1     skrll     {
   10257  1.1     skrll       /* FIXME: bad alignment assumption.  */
   10258  1.1     skrll       Elf_External_Note *xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) p;
   10259  1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Note in;
   10260  1.1     skrll 
   10261  1.1     skrll       if (offsetof (Elf_External_Note, name) > buf - p + size)
   10262  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   10263  1.1     skrll 
   10264  1.1     skrll       in.type = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->type);
   10265  1.1     skrll 
   10266  1.1     skrll       in.namesz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->namesz);
   10267  1.1     skrll       in.namedata = xnp->name;
   10268  1.1     skrll       if (in.namesz > buf - in.namedata + size)
   10269  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   10270  1.1     skrll 
   10271  1.1     skrll       in.descsz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->descsz);
   10272  1.1     skrll       in.descdata = in.namedata + BFD_ALIGN (in.namesz, 4);
   10273  1.1     skrll       in.descpos = offset + (in.descdata - buf);
   10274  1.1     skrll       if (in.descsz != 0
   10275  1.1     skrll 	  && (in.descdata >= buf + size
   10276  1.1     skrll 	      || in.descsz > buf - in.descdata + size))
   10277  1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   10278  1.1     skrll 
   10279  1.1     skrll       switch (bfd_get_format (abfd))
   10280  1.6  christos         {
   10281  1.6  christos 	default:
   10282  1.6  christos 	  return TRUE;
   10283  1.1     skrll 
   10284  1.6  christos 	case bfd_core:
   10285  1.6  christos 	  {
   10286  1.6  christos #define GROKER_ELEMENT(S,F) {S, sizeof (S) - 1, F}
   10287  1.1     skrll 	    struct
   10288  1.6  christos 	    {
   10289  1.3  christos 	      const char * string;
   10290  1.6  christos 	      size_t len;
   10291  1.6  christos 	      bfd_boolean (* func)(bfd *, Elf_Internal_Note *);
   10292  1.6  christos 	    }
   10293  1.6  christos 	    grokers[] =
   10294  1.6  christos 	    {
   10295  1.6  christos 	      GROKER_ELEMENT ("", elfcore_grok_note),
   10296  1.6  christos 	      GROKER_ELEMENT ("NetBSD-CORE", elfcore_grok_netbsd_note),
   10297  1.6  christos 	      GROKER_ELEMENT ( "OpenBSD", elfcore_grok_openbsd_note),
   10298  1.6  christos 	      GROKER_ELEMENT ("QNX", elfcore_grok_nto_note),
   10299  1.6  christos 	      GROKER_ELEMENT ("SPU/", elfcore_grok_spu_note)
   10300  1.6  christos 	    };
   10301  1.6  christos #undef GROKER_ELEMENT
   10302  1.6  christos 	    int i;
   10303  1.6  christos 
   10304  1.6  christos 	    for (i = ARRAY_SIZE (grokers); i--;)
   10305  1.6  christos 	      {
   10306  1.6  christos 		if (in.namesz >= grokers[i].len
   10307  1.6  christos 		    && strncmp (in.namedata, grokers[i].string,
   10308  1.6  christos 				grokers[i].len) == 0)
   10309  1.6  christos 		  {
   10310  1.6  christos 		    if (! grokers[i].func (abfd, & in))
   10311  1.6  christos 		      return FALSE;
   10312  1.1     skrll 		    break;
   10313  1.1     skrll 		  }
   10314  1.1     skrll 	      }
   10315  1.1     skrll 	    break;
   10316  1.1     skrll 	  }
   10317  1.1     skrll 
   10318  1.1     skrll 	case bfd_object:
   10319  1.5  christos 	  if (in.namesz == sizeof "GNU" && strcmp (in.namedata, "GNU") == 0)
   10320  1.5  christos 	    {
   10321  1.5  christos 	      if (! elfobj_grok_gnu_note (abfd, &in))
   10322  1.5  christos 		return FALSE;
   10323  1.5  christos 	    }
   10324  1.5  christos 	  else if (in.namesz == sizeof "stapsdt"
   10325  1.1     skrll 		   && strcmp (in.namedata, "stapsdt") == 0)
   10326  1.1     skrll 	    {
   10327  1.1     skrll 	      if (! elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (abfd, &in))
   10328  1.1     skrll 		return FALSE;
   10329  1.1     skrll 	    }
   10330  1.1     skrll 	  break;
   10331  1.1     skrll 	}
   10332  1.1     skrll 
   10333  1.1     skrll       p = in.descdata + BFD_ALIGN (in.descsz, 4);
   10334  1.1     skrll     }
   10335  1.1     skrll 
   10336  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   10337  1.1     skrll }
   10338  1.1     skrll 
   10339  1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   10340  1.1     skrll elf_read_notes (bfd *abfd, file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type size)
   10341  1.1     skrll {
   10342  1.1     skrll   char *buf;
   10343  1.1     skrll 
   10344  1.1     skrll   if (size <= 0)
   10345  1.6  christos     return TRUE;
   10346  1.1     skrll 
   10347  1.1     skrll   if (bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
   10348  1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   10349  1.6  christos 
   10350  1.6  christos   buf = (char *) bfd_malloc (size + 1);
   10351  1.6  christos   if (buf == NULL)
   10352  1.6  christos     return FALSE;
   10353  1.1     skrll 
   10354  1.1     skrll   /* PR 17512: file: ec08f814
   10355  1.1     skrll      0-termintate the buffer so that string searches will not overflow.  */
   10356  1.1     skrll   buf[size] = 0;
   10357  1.1     skrll 
   10358  1.1     skrll   if (bfd_bread (buf, size, abfd) != size
   10359  1.1     skrll       || !elf_parse_notes (abfd, buf, size, offset))
   10360  1.1     skrll     {
   10361  1.1     skrll       free (buf);
   10362  1.1     skrll       return FALSE;
   10363  1.1     skrll     }
   10364  1.1     skrll 
   10365  1.1     skrll   free (buf);
   10366  1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   10367  1.1     skrll }
   10368  1.1     skrll 
   10369  1.1     skrll /* Providing external access to the ELF program header table.  */
   10371  1.1     skrll 
   10372  1.1     skrll /* Return an upper bound on the number of bytes required to store a
   10373  1.1     skrll    copy of ABFD's program header table entries.  Return -1 if an error
   10374  1.1     skrll    occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code.  */
   10375  1.1     skrll 
   10376  1.1     skrll long
   10377  1.1     skrll bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
   10378  1.1     skrll {
   10379  1.1     skrll   if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
   10380  1.1     skrll     {
   10381  1.1     skrll       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
   10382  1.1     skrll       return -1;
   10383  1.1     skrll     }
   10384  1.1     skrll 
   10385  1.1     skrll   return elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr);
   10386  1.1     skrll }
   10387  1.1     skrll 
   10388  1.1     skrll /* Copy ABFD's program header table entries to *PHDRS.  The entries
   10389  1.1     skrll    will be stored as an array of Elf_Internal_Phdr structures, as
   10390  1.1     skrll    defined in include/elf/internal.h.  To find out how large the
   10391  1.1     skrll    buffer needs to be, call bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound.
   10392  1.1     skrll 
   10393  1.1     skrll    Return the number of program header table entries read, or -1 if an
   10394  1.1     skrll    error occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code.  */
   10395  1.1     skrll 
   10396  1.1     skrll int
   10397  1.1     skrll bfd_get_elf_phdrs (bfd *abfd, void *phdrs)
   10398  1.1     skrll {
   10399  1.1     skrll   int num_phdrs;
   10400  1.1     skrll 
   10401  1.1     skrll   if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
   10402  1.1     skrll     {
   10403  1.1     skrll       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
   10404  1.1     skrll       return -1;
   10405  1.1     skrll     }
   10406  1.1     skrll 
   10407  1.1     skrll   num_phdrs = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
   10408  1.1     skrll   memcpy (phdrs, elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr,
   10409  1.6  christos 	  num_phdrs * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
   10410  1.6  christos 
   10411  1.6  christos   return num_phdrs;
   10412  1.1     skrll }
   10413  1.1     skrll 
   10414  1.1     skrll enum elf_reloc_type_class
   10415  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   10416  1.1     skrll 			   const asection *rel_sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   10417  1.1     skrll 			   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   10418  1.1     skrll {
   10419  1.1     skrll   return reloc_class_normal;
   10420  1.1     skrll }
   10421  1.1     skrll 
   10422  1.1     skrll /* For RELA architectures, return the relocation value for a
   10423  1.1     skrll    relocation against a local symbol.  */
   10424  1.1     skrll 
   10425  1.1     skrll bfd_vma
   10426  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
   10427  1.1     skrll 			 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
   10428  1.1     skrll 			 asection **psec,
   10429  1.1     skrll 			 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
   10430  1.1     skrll {
   10431  1.1     skrll   asection *sec = *psec;
   10432  1.1     skrll   bfd_vma relocation;
   10433  1.5  christos 
   10434  1.1     skrll   relocation = (sec->output_section->vma
   10435  1.1     skrll 		+ sec->output_offset
   10436  1.1     skrll 		+ sym->st_value);
   10437  1.1     skrll   if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
   10438  1.1     skrll       && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
   10439  1.1     skrll       && sec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
   10440  1.1     skrll     {
   10441  1.1     skrll       rel->r_addend =
   10442  1.1     skrll 	_bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
   10443  1.1     skrll 				    elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
   10444  1.1     skrll 				    sym->st_value + rel->r_addend);
   10445  1.1     skrll       if (sec != *psec)
   10446  1.1     skrll 	{
   10447  1.1     skrll 	  /* If we have changed the section, and our original section is
   10448  1.1     skrll 	     marked with SEC_EXCLUDE, it means that the original
   10449  1.1     skrll 	     SEC_MERGE section has been completely subsumed in some
   10450  1.1     skrll 	     other SEC_MERGE section.  In this case, we need to leave
   10451  1.1     skrll 	     some info around for --emit-relocs.  */
   10452  1.1     skrll 	  if ((sec->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
   10453  1.1     skrll 	    sec->kept_section = *psec;
   10454  1.1     skrll 	  sec = *psec;
   10455  1.1     skrll 	}
   10456  1.1     skrll       rel->r_addend -= relocation;
   10457  1.1     skrll       rel->r_addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
   10458  1.1     skrll     }
   10459  1.1     skrll   return relocation;
   10460  1.1     skrll }
   10461  1.1     skrll 
   10462  1.1     skrll bfd_vma
   10463  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
   10464  1.5  christos 			Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
   10465  1.1     skrll 			asection **psec,
   10466  1.1     skrll 			bfd_vma addend)
   10467  1.1     skrll {
   10468  1.1     skrll   asection *sec = *psec;
   10469  1.1     skrll 
   10470  1.1     skrll   if (sec->sec_info_type != SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
   10471  1.1     skrll     return sym->st_value + addend;
   10472  1.1     skrll 
   10473  1.1     skrll   return _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
   10474  1.1     skrll 				     elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
   10475  1.1     skrll 				     sym->st_value + addend);
   10476  1.1     skrll }
   10477  1.1     skrll 
   10478  1.1     skrll bfd_vma
   10479  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_section_offset (bfd *abfd,
   10480  1.5  christos 			 struct bfd_link_info *info,
   10481  1.1     skrll 			 asection *sec,
   10482  1.1     skrll 			 bfd_vma offset)
   10483  1.5  christos {
   10484  1.1     skrll   switch (sec->sec_info_type)
   10485  1.1     skrll     {
   10486  1.5  christos     case SEC_INFO_TYPE_STABS:
   10487  1.5  christos       return _bfd_stab_section_offset (sec, elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
   10488  1.5  christos 				       offset);
   10489  1.5  christos     case SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME:
   10490  1.5  christos       return _bfd_elf_eh_frame_section_offset (abfd, info, sec, offset);
   10491  1.5  christos     default:
   10492  1.1     skrll       if ((sec->flags & SEC_ELF_REVERSE_COPY) != 0)
   10493  1.1     skrll 	{
   10494  1.1     skrll 	  const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   10495  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_size_type address_size = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
   10496  1.1     skrll 	  offset = sec->size - offset - address_size;
   10497  1.1     skrll 	}
   10498  1.1     skrll       return offset;
   10499  1.1     skrll     }
   10500  1.1     skrll }
   10501  1.1     skrll 
   10502  1.1     skrll /* Create a new BFD as if by bfd_openr.  Rather than opening a file,
   10504  1.1     skrll    reconstruct an ELF file by reading the segments out of remote memory
   10505  1.1     skrll    based on the ELF file header at EHDR_VMA and the ELF program headers it
   10506  1.1     skrll    points to.  If not null, *LOADBASEP is filled in with the difference
   10507  1.1     skrll    between the VMAs from which the segments were read, and the VMAs the
   10508  1.1     skrll    file headers (and hence BFD's idea of each section's VMA) put them at.
   10509  1.1     skrll 
   10510  1.1     skrll    The function TARGET_READ_MEMORY is called to copy LEN bytes from the
   10511  1.1     skrll    remote memory at target address VMA into the local buffer at MYADDR; it
   10512  1.1     skrll    should return zero on success or an `errno' code on failure.  TEMPL must
   10513  1.6  christos    be a BFD for an ELF target with the word size and byte order found in
   10514  1.1     skrll    the remote memory.  */
   10515  1.5  christos 
   10516  1.1     skrll bfd *
   10517  1.1     skrll bfd_elf_bfd_from_remote_memory
   10518  1.6  christos   (bfd *templ,
   10519  1.1     skrll    bfd_vma ehdr_vma,
   10520  1.1     skrll    bfd_size_type size,
   10521  1.1     skrll    bfd_vma *loadbasep,
   10522  1.1     skrll    int (*target_read_memory) (bfd_vma, bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type))
   10523  1.1     skrll {
   10524  1.1     skrll   return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ)->elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory)
   10525  1.1     skrll     (templ, ehdr_vma, size, loadbasep, target_read_memory);
   10526  1.1     skrll }
   10527  1.1     skrll 
   10528  1.1     skrll long
   10530  1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
   10531  1.1     skrll 			       long symcount ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   10532  1.1     skrll 			       asymbol **syms ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   10533  1.1     skrll 			       long dynsymcount,
   10534  1.1     skrll 			       asymbol **dynsyms,
   10535  1.1     skrll 			       asymbol **ret)
   10536  1.1     skrll {
   10537  1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   10538  1.1     skrll   asection *relplt;
   10539  1.1     skrll   asymbol *s;
   10540  1.1     skrll   const char *relplt_name;
   10541  1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
   10542  1.1     skrll   arelent *p;
   10543  1.1     skrll   long count, i, n;
   10544  1.1     skrll   size_t size;
   10545  1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
   10546  1.1     skrll   char *names;
   10547  1.1     skrll   asection *plt;
   10548  1.1     skrll 
   10549  1.1     skrll   *ret = NULL;
   10550  1.1     skrll 
   10551  1.1     skrll   if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
   10552  1.1     skrll     return 0;
   10553  1.1     skrll 
   10554  1.1     skrll   if (dynsymcount <= 0)
   10555  1.1     skrll     return 0;
   10556  1.1     skrll 
   10557  1.1     skrll   if (!bed->plt_sym_val)
   10558  1.1     skrll     return 0;
   10559  1.1     skrll 
   10560  1.1     skrll   relplt_name = bed->relplt_name;
   10561  1.1     skrll   if (relplt_name == NULL)
   10562  1.1     skrll     relplt_name = bed->rela_plts_and_copies_p ? ".rela.plt" : ".rel.plt";
   10563  1.1     skrll   relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, relplt_name);
   10564  1.1     skrll   if (relplt == NULL)
   10565  1.1     skrll     return 0;
   10566  1.1     skrll 
   10567  1.1     skrll   hdr = &elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr;
   10568  1.1     skrll   if (hdr->sh_link != elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
   10569  1.1     skrll       || (hdr->sh_type != SHT_REL && hdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA))
   10570  1.1     skrll     return 0;
   10571  1.1     skrll 
   10572  1.1     skrll   plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
   10573  1.1     skrll   if (plt == NULL)
   10574  1.1     skrll     return 0;
   10575  1.1     skrll 
   10576  1.3  christos   slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
   10577  1.3  christos   if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
   10578  1.3  christos     return -1;
   10579  1.3  christos 
   10580  1.3  christos   count = relplt->size / hdr->sh_entsize;
   10581  1.3  christos   size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
   10582  1.3  christos   p = relplt->relocation;
   10583  1.3  christos   for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
   10584  1.3  christos     {
   10585  1.3  christos       size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
   10586  1.3  christos       if (p->addend != 0)
   10587  1.1     skrll 	{
   10588  1.3  christos #ifdef BFD64
   10589  1.1     skrll 	  size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8 + 8 * (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64);
   10590  1.1     skrll #else
   10591  1.1     skrll 	  size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
   10592  1.1     skrll #endif
   10593  1.1     skrll 	}
   10594  1.1     skrll     }
   10595  1.1     skrll 
   10596  1.1     skrll   s = *ret = (asymbol *) bfd_malloc (size);
   10597  1.1     skrll   if (s == NULL)
   10598  1.1     skrll     return -1;
   10599  1.1     skrll 
   10600  1.1     skrll   names = (char *) (s + count);
   10601  1.1     skrll   p = relplt->relocation;
   10602  1.1     skrll   n = 0;
   10603  1.1     skrll   for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
   10604  1.1     skrll     {
   10605  1.1     skrll       size_t len;
   10606  1.1     skrll       bfd_vma addr;
   10607  1.1     skrll 
   10608  1.1     skrll       addr = bed->plt_sym_val (i, plt, p);
   10609  1.1     skrll       if (addr == (bfd_vma) -1)
   10610  1.1     skrll 	continue;
   10611  1.1     skrll 
   10612  1.1     skrll       *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
   10613  1.1     skrll       /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set.  Since
   10614  1.1     skrll 	 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set.  */
   10615  1.1     skrll       if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
   10616  1.1     skrll 	s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
   10617  1.3  christos       s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
   10618  1.3  christos       s->section = plt;
   10619  1.3  christos       s->value = addr - plt->vma;
   10620  1.5  christos       s->name = names;
   10621  1.3  christos       s->udata.p = NULL;
   10622  1.3  christos       len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
   10623  1.3  christos       memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
   10624  1.3  christos       names += len;
   10625  1.3  christos       if (p->addend != 0)
   10626  1.3  christos 	{
   10627  1.3  christos 	  char buf[30], *a;
   10628  1.3  christos 
   10629  1.3  christos 	  memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
   10630  1.1     skrll 	  names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
   10631  1.1     skrll 	  bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, buf, p->addend);
   10632  1.1     skrll 	  for (a = buf; *a == '0'; ++a)
   10633  1.1     skrll 	    ;
   10634  1.1     skrll 	  len = strlen (a);
   10635  1.1     skrll 	  memcpy (names, a, len);
   10636  1.1     skrll 	  names += len;
   10637  1.1     skrll 	}
   10638  1.1     skrll       memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
   10639  1.1     skrll       names += sizeof ("@plt");
   10640  1.1     skrll       ++s, ++n;
   10641  1.1     skrll     }
   10642  1.1     skrll 
   10643  1.1     skrll   return n;
   10644  1.6  christos }
   10645  1.6  christos 
   10646  1.1     skrll /* It is only used by x86-64 so far.  */
   10647  1.1     skrll asection _bfd_elf_large_com_section
   10648  1.1     skrll   = BFD_FAKE_SECTION (_bfd_elf_large_com_section,
   10649  1.1     skrll 		      SEC_IS_COMMON, NULL, "LARGE_COMMON", 0);
   10650  1.1     skrll 
   10651  1.1     skrll void
   10652  1.3  christos _bfd_elf_post_process_headers (bfd * abfd,
   10653  1.3  christos 			       struct bfd_link_info * link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   10654  1.5  christos {
   10655  1.3  christos   Elf_Internal_Ehdr * i_ehdrp;	/* ELF file header, internal form.  */
   10656  1.3  christos 
   10657  1.3  christos   i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
   10658  1.5  christos 
   10659  1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi;
   10660  1.1     skrll 
   10661  1.1     skrll   /* To make things simpler for the loader on Linux systems we set the
   10662  1.1     skrll      osabi field to ELFOSABI_GNU if the binary contains symbols of
   10663  1.1     skrll      the STT_GNU_IFUNC type or STB_GNU_UNIQUE binding.  */
   10664  1.3  christos   if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] == ELFOSABI_NONE
   10665  1.1     skrll       && elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_symbols)
   10666  1.1     skrll     i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = ELFOSABI_GNU;
   10667  1.1     skrll }
   10668  1.1     skrll 
   10669  1.3  christos 
   10670  1.3  christos /* Return TRUE for ELF symbol types that represent functions.
   10671  1.1     skrll    This is the default version of this function, which is sufficient for
   10672  1.5  christos    most targets.  It returns true if TYPE is STT_FUNC or STT_GNU_IFUNC.  */
   10673  1.5  christos 
   10674  1.5  christos bfd_boolean
   10675  1.5  christos _bfd_elf_is_function_type (unsigned int type)
   10676  1.5  christos {
   10677  1.5  christos   return (type == STT_FUNC
   10678  1.5  christos 	  || type == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
   10679  1.5  christos }
   10680  1.5  christos 
   10681  1.5  christos /* If the ELF symbol SYM might be a function in SEC, return the
   10682  1.5  christos    function size and set *CODE_OFF to the function's entry point,
   10683  1.5  christos    otherwise return zero.  */
   10684  1.5  christos 
   10685  1.5  christos bfd_size_type
   10686  1.5  christos _bfd_elf_maybe_function_sym (const asymbol *sym, asection *sec,
   10687  1.5  christos 			     bfd_vma *code_off)
   10688  1.5  christos {
   10689  1.5  christos   bfd_size_type size;
   10690  1.5  christos 
   10691  1.5  christos   if ((sym->flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_FILE | BSF_OBJECT
   10692  1.5  christos 		     | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL | BSF_RELC | BSF_SRELC)) != 0
   10693  1.5  christos       || sym->section != sec)
   10694  1.5  christos     return 0;
   10695  1.5  christos 
   10696                  *code_off = sym->value;
   10697                  size = 0;
   10698                  if (!(sym->flags & BSF_SYNTHETIC))
   10699                    size = ((elf_symbol_type *) sym)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
   10700                  if (size == 0)
   10701                    size = 1;
   10702                  return size;
   10703                }
   10704